*** empty log message ***
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006@*
56 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
57
58 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
59 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
60 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
61 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
62 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
63 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
64
65 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
66 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
67 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
68 @end ifinfo
69
70 @titlepage
71 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
72 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
73 @sp 1
74 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
75 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
76 @page
77 @tex
78 {\parskip=0pt
79 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
80 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
81 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
82 }
83 @end tex
84
85 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
86 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
87 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006
88 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
89 @sp 2
90 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
91 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
92 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
93 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
94
95 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
96 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
97 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
98 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
99 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
100 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
101
102 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
103 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
104 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
105 @page
106 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
107 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
108 software in general. We will miss him.
109 @end titlepage
110 @page
111
112 @ifnottex
113 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
114
115 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
116
117 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
118
119 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
120 @value{GDBVN}.
121
122 Copyright (C) 1988-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
123
124 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
125 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
126 software in general. We will miss him.
127
128 @menu
129 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
130 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
131
132 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
133 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
134 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
135 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
136 * Stack:: Examining the stack
137 * Source:: Examining source files
138 * Data:: Examining data
139 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
140 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
141 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
142
143 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
144
145 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
146 * Altering:: Altering execution
147 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
148 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
149 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
150 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
151 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
152 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
153 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
154 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
155 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
156 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
157 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
158
159 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
160
161 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
162 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
163 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
164 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
165 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
166 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
167 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
168 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
169 @value{GDBN}
170 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
171 how you can copy and share GDB
172 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
173 * Index:: Index
174 @end menu
175
176 @end ifnottex
177
178 @contents
179
180 @node Summary
181 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
182
183 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
184 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
185 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
186
187 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
188 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
189
190 @itemize @bullet
191 @item
192 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
193
194 @item
195 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
196
197 @item
198 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
199
200 @item
201 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
202 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
203 @end itemize
204
205 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
206 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
207 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
208
209 @cindex Modula-2
210 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
211 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
212
213 @cindex Pascal
214 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
215 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
216 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
217 syntax.
218
219 @cindex Fortran
220 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
221 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
222 underscore.
223
224 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
225 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
226
227 @menu
228 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
229 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
230 @end menu
231
232 @node Free Software
233 @unnumberedsec Free Software
234
235 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
236 General Public License
237 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
238 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
239 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
240 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
241 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
242 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
243
244 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
245 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
246 from anyone else.
247
248 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
249
250 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
251 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
252 include with the free software. Many of our most important
253 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
254 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
255 when an important free software package does not come with a free
256 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
257 gaps today.
258
259 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
260 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
261 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
262 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
263 them from the free software world.
264
265 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
266 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
267 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
268 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
269 contract to make it non-free.
270
271 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
272 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
273 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
274 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
275 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
276 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
277 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
278
279 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
280 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
281 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
282 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
283
284 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
285 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
286 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
287 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
288 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
289 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
290 community.
291
292 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
293 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
294 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
295 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
296 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
297 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
298 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
299 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
300 of the manual.
301
302 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
303 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
304 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
305 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
306 manual to replace it.
307
308 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
309 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
310 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
311 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
312 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
313 the free software community.
314
315 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
316 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
317 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
318 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
319 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
320 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
321 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
322 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
323 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
324
325 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
326 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
327 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
328 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
329 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
330 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
331 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
332 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
333
334 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
335 published by other publishers, at
336 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
337
338 @node Contributors
339 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
340
341 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
342 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
343 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
344 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
345 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
346 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
347 blow-by-blow account.
348
349 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
350
351 @quotation
352 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
353 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
354 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
355 @end quotation
356
357 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
358 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
359 releases:
360 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
361 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
362 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
363 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
364 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
365 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
366 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
367 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
368 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
369
370 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
371 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
372
373 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
374 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
375 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
376 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
377 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
378
379 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
380 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
381 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
382
383 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
384 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
385
386 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
387
388 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
389 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
390 support.
391 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
392 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
393 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
394 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
395 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
396 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
397 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
398 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
399 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
400 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
401 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
402 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
403 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
404 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
405 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
406 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
407
408 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
409
410 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
411 libraries.
412
413 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
414 about several machine instruction sets.
415
416 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
417 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
418 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
419 and RDI targets, respectively.
420
421 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
422 command-line editing and command history.
423
424 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
425 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
426
427 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
428 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
429 symbols.
430
431 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
432 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
433
434 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
435
436 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
437 processors.
438
439 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
440
441 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
442
443 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
444
445 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
446 watchpoints.
447
448 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
449
450 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
451
452 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
453 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
454
455 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
456 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
457 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
458 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
459 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
460 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
461 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
462
463 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
464 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
465
466 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
467 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
468 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
469 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
470 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
471 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
472 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
473 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
474 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
475 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
476 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
477 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
478 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
479 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
480 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
481
482 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
483 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
484
485 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
486 Hat.
487
488 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
489 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
490 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
491 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
492 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
493 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
494
495 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
496 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
497 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
498 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
499 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
500 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
501 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
502 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
503 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
504 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
505 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
506 Weigand.
507
508 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
509 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
510 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
511 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
512
513 @node Sample Session
514 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
515
516 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
517 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
518 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
519
520 @iftex
521 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
522 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
523 @end iftex
524
525 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
526 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
527
528 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
529 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
530 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
531 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
532 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
533 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
534 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
535 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
536 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
537
538 @smallexample
539 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
540 $ @b{./m4}
541 @b{define(foo,0000)}
542
543 @b{foo}
544 0000
545 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
546
547 @b{bar}
548 0000
549 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
550
551 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
552 @b{baz}
553 @b{Ctrl-d}
554 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
555 @end smallexample
556
557 @noindent
558 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
559
560 @smallexample
561 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
562 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
563 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
564 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
565 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
566 the conditions.
567 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
568 for details.
569
570 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
571 (@value{GDBP})
572 @end smallexample
573
574 @noindent
575 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
576 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
577 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
578 that examples fit in this manual.
579
580 @smallexample
581 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
582 @end smallexample
583
584 @noindent
585 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
586 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
587 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
588 @code{break} command.
589
590 @smallexample
591 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
592 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
593 @end smallexample
594
595 @noindent
596 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
597 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
598 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
599
600 @smallexample
601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
602 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
603 @b{define(foo,0000)}
604
605 @b{foo}
606 0000
607 @end smallexample
608
609 @noindent
610 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
611 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
612 context where it stops.
613
614 @smallexample
615 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
616
617 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
618 at builtin.c:879
619 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
620 @end smallexample
621
622 @noindent
623 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
624 the next line of the current function.
625
626 @smallexample
627 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
628 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
629 : nil,
630 @end smallexample
631
632 @noindent
633 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
634 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
635 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
636 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
637
638 @smallexample
639 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
640 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
641 at input.c:530
642 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
643 @end smallexample
644
645 @noindent
646 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
647 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
648 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
649 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
650 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
651 stack frame for each active subroutine.
652
653 @smallexample
654 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
655 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
656 at input.c:530
657 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
658 at builtin.c:882
659 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
660 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
661 at macro.c:71
662 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
663 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
664 @end smallexample
665
666 @noindent
667 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
668 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
669 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
670
671 @smallexample
672 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
673 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
675 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
676 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
677 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
678 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
679 : xstrdup(rq);
680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
681 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
682 @end smallexample
683
684 @noindent
685 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
686 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
687 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
688 (@code{print}) to see their values.
689
690 @smallexample
691 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
692 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
693 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
694 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
699 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
700 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
704 533 xfree(rquote);
705 534
706 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
707 : xstrdup (lq);
708 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
709 : xstrdup (rq);
710 537
711 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
712 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
713 540 @}
714 541
715 542 void
716 @end smallexample
717
718 @noindent
719 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
720 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
721
722 @smallexample
723 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
724 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
725 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
726 540 @}
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
728 $3 = 9
729 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
730 $4 = 7
731 @end smallexample
732
733 @noindent
734 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
735 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
736 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
737 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
738 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
739 assignments.
740
741 @smallexample
742 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
743 $5 = 7
744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
745 $6 = 9
746 @end smallexample
747
748 @noindent
749 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
750 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
751 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
752 example that caused trouble initially:
753
754 @smallexample
755 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
756 Continuing.
757
758 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
759
760 baz
761 0000
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
766 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
767 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
768
769 @smallexample
770 @b{Ctrl-d}
771 Program exited normally.
772 @end smallexample
773
774 @noindent
775 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
776 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
777 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
778
779 @smallexample
780 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
781 @end smallexample
782
783 @node Invocation
784 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
785
786 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
787 The essentials are:
788 @itemize @bullet
789 @item
790 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
791 @item
792 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
793 @end itemize
794
795 @menu
796 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
797 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
798 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
799 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
800 @end menu
801
802 @node Invoking GDB
803 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
804
805 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
806 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
807
808 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
809 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
810
811 The command-line options described here are designed
812 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
813 options may effectively be unavailable.
814
815 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
816 specifying an executable program:
817
818 @smallexample
819 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
820 @end smallexample
821
822 @noindent
823 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
824 specified:
825
826 @smallexample
827 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
828 @end smallexample
829
830 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
831 to debug a running process:
832
833 @smallexample
834 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
835 @end smallexample
836
837 @noindent
838 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
839 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
840
841 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
842 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
843 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
844 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
845 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
846
847 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
848 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
849 option processing.
850 @smallexample
851 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
852 @end smallexample
853 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
854 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
855
856 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
857 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
858
859 @smallexample
860 @value{GDBP} -silent
861 @end smallexample
862
863 @noindent
864 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
865 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
866
867 @noindent
868 Type
869
870 @smallexample
871 @value{GDBP} -help
872 @end smallexample
873
874 @noindent
875 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
876 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
877
878 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
879 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
880 @samp{-x} option is used.
881
882
883 @menu
884 * File Options:: Choosing files
885 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
886 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
887 @end menu
888
889 @node File Options
890 @subsection Choosing Files
891
892 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
893 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
894 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
895 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
896 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
897 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
898 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
899 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
900 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
901 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
902 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
903 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
904 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
905
906 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
907 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
908 argument and ignore it.
909
910 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
911 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
912 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
913 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
914 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
915
916 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
917 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
918 @c it.
919
920 @table @code
921 @item -symbols @var{file}
922 @itemx -s @var{file}
923 @cindex @code{--symbols}
924 @cindex @code{-s}
925 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
926
927 @item -exec @var{file}
928 @itemx -e @var{file}
929 @cindex @code{--exec}
930 @cindex @code{-e}
931 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
932 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
933
934 @item -se @var{file}
935 @cindex @code{--se}
936 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
937 file.
938
939 @item -core @var{file}
940 @itemx -c @var{file}
941 @cindex @code{--core}
942 @cindex @code{-c}
943 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
944
945 @item -pid @var{number}
946 @itemx -p @var{number}
947 @cindex @code{--pid}
948 @cindex @code{-p}
949 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
950
951 @item -command @var{file}
952 @itemx -x @var{file}
953 @cindex @code{--command}
954 @cindex @code{-x}
955 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
956 Files,, Command files}.
957
958 @item -eval-command @var{command}
959 @itemx -ex @var{command}
960 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
961 @cindex @code{-ex}
962 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
963
964 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
965 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
966
967 @smallexample
968 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
969 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
970 @end smallexample
971
972 @item -directory @var{directory}
973 @itemx -d @var{directory}
974 @cindex @code{--directory}
975 @cindex @code{-d}
976 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
977
978 @item -r
979 @itemx -readnow
980 @cindex @code{--readnow}
981 @cindex @code{-r}
982 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
983 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
984 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
985
986 @end table
987
988 @node Mode Options
989 @subsection Choosing Modes
990
991 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
992 batch mode or quiet mode.
993
994 @table @code
995 @item -nx
996 @itemx -n
997 @cindex @code{--nx}
998 @cindex @code{-n}
999 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1000 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1001 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1002 Files}.
1003
1004 @item -quiet
1005 @itemx -silent
1006 @itemx -q
1007 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1008 @cindex @code{--silent}
1009 @cindex @code{-q}
1010 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1011 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1012
1013 @item -batch
1014 @cindex @code{--batch}
1015 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1016 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1017 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1018 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1019 in the command files.
1020
1021 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1022 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1023 make this more useful, the message
1024
1025 @smallexample
1026 Program exited normally.
1027 @end smallexample
1028
1029 @noindent
1030 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1031 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1032 mode.
1033
1034 @item -batch-silent
1035 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1036 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1037 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1038 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1039 for an interactive session.
1040
1041 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1042 messages, for example.
1043
1044 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1045 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1046
1047 @item -return-child-result
1048 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1049 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1050 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1051
1052 @itemize @bullet
1053 @item
1054 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1055 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1056 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1057 @item
1058 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1059 @item
1060 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1061 the exit code will be -1.
1062 @end itemize
1063
1064 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1065 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1066 interface.
1067
1068 @item -nowindows
1069 @itemx -nw
1070 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1071 @cindex @code{-nw}
1072 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1073 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1074 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1075
1076 @item -windows
1077 @itemx -w
1078 @cindex @code{--windows}
1079 @cindex @code{-w}
1080 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1081 used if possible.
1082
1083 @item -cd @var{directory}
1084 @cindex @code{--cd}
1085 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1086 instead of the current directory.
1087
1088 @item -fullname
1089 @itemx -f
1090 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1091 @cindex @code{-f}
1092 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1093 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1094 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1095 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1096 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1097 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1098 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1099 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1100 frame.
1101
1102 @item -epoch
1103 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1104 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1105 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1106 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1107 separate window.
1108
1109 @item -annotate @var{level}
1110 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1111 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1112 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1113 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1114 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1115 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1116 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1117 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1118 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1119
1120 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1121 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1122
1123 @item --args
1124 @cindex @code{--args}
1125 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1126 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1127 This option stops option processing.
1128
1129 @item -baud @var{bps}
1130 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1131 @cindex @code{--baud}
1132 @cindex @code{-b}
1133 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1134 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1135
1136 @item -l @var{timeout}
1137 @cindex @code{-l}
1138 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1139 for remote debugging.
1140
1141 @item -tty @var{device}
1142 @itemx -t @var{device}
1143 @cindex @code{--tty}
1144 @cindex @code{-t}
1145 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1146 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1147
1148 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1149 @item -tui
1150 @cindex @code{--tui}
1151 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1152 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1153 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1154 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1155 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1156 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1157 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1158
1159 @c @item -xdb
1160 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1161 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1162 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1163 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1164 @c systems.
1165
1166 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1167 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1168 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1169 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1170 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1171 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1172
1173 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1174 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1175 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1176 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1177 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1178 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1179
1180 @item -write
1181 @cindex @code{--write}
1182 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1183 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1184 (@pxref{Patching}).
1185
1186 @item -statistics
1187 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1188 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1189 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1190
1191 @item -version
1192 @cindex @code{--version}
1193 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1194 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1195
1196 @end table
1197
1198 @node Startup
1199 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1200 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1201
1202 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1203
1204 @enumerate
1205 @item
1206 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1207 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1208
1209 @item
1210 @cindex init file
1211 Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1212 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1213 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1214 that file.
1215
1216 @item
1217 Processes command line options and operands.
1218
1219 @item
1220 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1221 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1222 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1223 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1224 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1225 @value{GDBN}.
1226
1227 @item
1228 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1229 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1230
1231 @item
1232 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1233 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1234 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1235 @end enumerate
1236
1237 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1238 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1239 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1240 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1241 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1242 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1243
1244 @cindex init file name
1245 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1246 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1247 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1248 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1249 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1250 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1251 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1252 the file to the standard name.
1253
1254
1255 @node Quitting GDB
1256 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1257 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1258 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1259
1260 @table @code
1261 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1262 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1263 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1264 @itemx q
1265 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1266 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1267 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1268 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1269 error code.
1270 @end table
1271
1272 @cindex interrupt
1273 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1274 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1275 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1276 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1277 until a time when it is safe.
1278
1279 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1280 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1281 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1282
1283 @node Shell Commands
1284 @section Shell Commands
1285
1286 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1287 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1288 just use the @code{shell} command.
1289
1290 @table @code
1291 @kindex shell
1292 @cindex shell escape
1293 @item shell @var{command string}
1294 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1295 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1296 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1297 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1298 @end table
1299
1300 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1301 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1302 @value{GDBN}:
1303
1304 @table @code
1305 @kindex make
1306 @cindex calling make
1307 @item make @var{make-args}
1308 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1309 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1310 @end table
1311
1312 @node Logging Output
1313 @section Logging Output
1314 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1315 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1316
1317 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1318 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1319
1320 @table @code
1321 @kindex set logging
1322 @item set logging on
1323 Enable logging.
1324 @item set logging off
1325 Disable logging.
1326 @cindex logging file name
1327 @item set logging file @var{file}
1328 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1329 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1330 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1331 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1332 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1333 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1334 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1335 @kindex show logging
1336 @item show logging
1337 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1338 @end table
1339
1340 @node Commands
1341 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1342
1343 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1344 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1345 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1346 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1347 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1348
1349 @menu
1350 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1351 * Completion:: Command completion
1352 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1353 @end menu
1354
1355 @node Command Syntax
1356 @section Command Syntax
1357
1358 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1359 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1360 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1361 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1362 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1363 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1364
1365 @cindex abbreviation
1366 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1367 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1368 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1369 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1370 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1371 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1372 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1373
1374 @cindex repeating commands
1375 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1376 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1377 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1378 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1379 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1380 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1381 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1382
1383 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1384 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1385 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1386
1387 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1388 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1389 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1390 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1391 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1392
1393 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1394 @cindex comment
1395 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1396 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1397 Files,,Command Files}).
1398
1399 @cindex repeating command sequences
1400 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1401 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1402 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1403 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1404 for editing.
1405
1406 @node Completion
1407 @section Command Completion
1408
1409 @cindex completion
1410 @cindex word completion
1411 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1412 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1413 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1414 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1415
1416 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1417 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1418 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1419 enter it). For example, if you type
1420
1421 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1422 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1423 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1424 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1425 @smallexample
1426 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1427 @end smallexample
1428
1429 @noindent
1430 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1431 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1432
1433 @smallexample
1434 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1435 @end smallexample
1436
1437 @noindent
1438 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1439 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1440 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1441 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1442 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1443 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1444
1445 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1446 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1447 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1448 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1449 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1450 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1451 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1452 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1453 example:
1454
1455 @smallexample
1456 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1457 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1458 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1459 make_abs_section make_function_type
1460 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1461 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1462 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1463 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1464 @end smallexample
1465
1466 @noindent
1467 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1468 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1469 command.
1470
1471 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1472 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1473 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1474 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1475 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1476
1477 @cindex quotes in commands
1478 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1479 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1480 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1481 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1482 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1483 @value{GDBN} commands.
1484
1485 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1486 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1487 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1488 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1489 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1490 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1491 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1492 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1493 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1494 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1495 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1496
1497 @smallexample
1498 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1499 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1500 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1501 @end smallexample
1502
1503 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1504 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1505 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1506 place:
1507
1508 @smallexample
1509 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1510 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1511 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1512 @end smallexample
1513
1514 @noindent
1515 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1516 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1517 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1518
1519 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1520 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1521 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1522 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1523
1524
1525 @node Help
1526 @section Getting Help
1527 @cindex online documentation
1528 @kindex help
1529
1530 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1531 using the command @code{help}.
1532
1533 @table @code
1534 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1535 @item help
1536 @itemx h
1537 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1538 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1539
1540 @smallexample
1541 (@value{GDBP}) help
1542 List of classes of commands:
1543
1544 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1545 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1546 data -- Examining data
1547 files -- Specifying and examining files
1548 internals -- Maintenance commands
1549 obscure -- Obscure features
1550 running -- Running the program
1551 stack -- Examining the stack
1552 status -- Status inquiries
1553 support -- Support facilities
1554 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1555 stopping the program
1556 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1557
1558 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1559 commands in that class.
1560 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1561 documentation.
1562 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1563 (@value{GDBP})
1564 @end smallexample
1565 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1566
1567 @item help @var{class}
1568 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1569 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1570 help display for the class @code{status}:
1571
1572 @smallexample
1573 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1574 Status inquiries.
1575
1576 List of commands:
1577
1578 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1579 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1580 info -- Generic command for showing things
1581 about the program being debugged
1582 show -- Generic command for showing things
1583 about the debugger
1584
1585 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1586 documentation.
1587 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1588 (@value{GDBP})
1589 @end smallexample
1590
1591 @item help @var{command}
1592 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1593 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1594
1595 @kindex apropos
1596 @item apropos @var{args}
1597 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1598 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1599 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1600
1601 @smallexample
1602 apropos reload
1603 @end smallexample
1604
1605 @noindent
1606 results in:
1607
1608 @smallexample
1609 @c @group
1610 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1611 multiple times in one run
1612 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1613 multiple times in one run
1614 @c @end group
1615 @end smallexample
1616
1617 @kindex complete
1618 @item complete @var{args}
1619 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1620 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1621 command you want completed. For example:
1622
1623 @smallexample
1624 complete i
1625 @end smallexample
1626
1627 @noindent results in:
1628
1629 @smallexample
1630 @group
1631 if
1632 ignore
1633 info
1634 inspect
1635 @end group
1636 @end smallexample
1637
1638 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1639 @end table
1640
1641 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1642 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1643 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1644 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1645 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1646 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1647
1648 @c @group
1649 @table @code
1650 @kindex info
1651 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1652 @item info
1653 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1654 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1655 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1656 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1657 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1658 @w{@code{help info}}.
1659
1660 @kindex set
1661 @item set
1662 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1663 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1664 @code{set prompt $}.
1665
1666 @kindex show
1667 @item show
1668 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1669 @value{GDBN} itself.
1670 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1671 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1672 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1673 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1674
1675 @kindex info set
1676 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1677 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1678 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1679 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1680 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1681 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1682 @end table
1683 @c @end group
1684
1685 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1686 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1687
1688 @table @code
1689 @kindex show version
1690 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1691 @item show version
1692 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1693 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1694 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1695 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1696 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1697 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1698 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1699 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1700 @value{GDBN}.
1701
1702 @kindex show copying
1703 @kindex info copying
1704 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1705 @item show copying
1706 @itemx info copying
1707 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1708
1709 @kindex show warranty
1710 @kindex info warranty
1711 @item show warranty
1712 @itemx info warranty
1713 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1714 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1715
1716 @end table
1717
1718 @node Running
1719 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1720
1721 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1722 debugging information when you compile it.
1723
1724 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1725 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1726 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1727 kill a child process.
1728
1729 @menu
1730 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1731 * Starting:: Starting your program
1732 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1733 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1734
1735 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1736 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1737 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1738 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1739
1740 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1741 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1742 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1743 @end menu
1744
1745 @node Compilation
1746 @section Compiling for Debugging
1747
1748 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1749 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1750 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1751 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1752 and addresses in the executable code.
1753
1754 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1755 the compiler.
1756
1757 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1758 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1759 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1760 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1761 executables containing debugging information.
1762
1763 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1764 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1765 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1766 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1767 in pushing your luck.
1768
1769 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1770 @cindex debugging optimized code
1771 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1772 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1773 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1774 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1775 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1776 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1777
1778 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1779 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1780 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1781 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1782 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1783
1784 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1785 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1786 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1787
1788 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1789 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1790 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1791 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1792 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1793 provides macro information if you specify the options
1794 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1795 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1796 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1797 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1798 @option{-g} alone.
1799
1800 @need 2000
1801 @node Starting
1802 @section Starting your Program
1803 @cindex starting
1804 @cindex running
1805
1806 @table @code
1807 @kindex run
1808 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1809 @item run
1810 @itemx r
1811 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1812 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1813 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1814 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1815 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1816
1817 @end table
1818
1819 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1820 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1821 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1822 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1823
1824 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1825 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1826 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1827 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1828 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1829 divided into four categories:
1830
1831 @table @asis
1832 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1833 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1834 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1835 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1836 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1837 the arguments.
1838 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1839 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1840 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1841
1842 @item The @emph{environment.}
1843 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1844 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1845 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1846 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1847
1848 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1849 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1850 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1851 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1852
1853 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1854 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1855 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1856 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1857 set a different device for your program.
1858 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1859
1860 @cindex pipes
1861 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1862 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1863 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1864 wrong program.
1865 @end table
1866
1867 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1868 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1869 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1870 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1871 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1872
1873 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1874 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1875 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1876 your current breakpoints.
1877
1878 @table @code
1879 @kindex start
1880 @item start
1881 @cindex run to main procedure
1882 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1883 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1884 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1885 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1886 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1887 procedure, depending on the language used.
1888
1889 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1890 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1891 the @samp{run} command.
1892
1893 @cindex elaboration phase
1894 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1895 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1896 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1897 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1898 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1899 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1900 will remain to halt execution.
1901
1902 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1903 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1904 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1905 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1906 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1907
1908 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1909 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1910 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1911 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1912 elaboration code before running your program.
1913 @end table
1914
1915 @node Arguments
1916 @section Your Program's Arguments
1917
1918 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1919 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1920 @code{run} command.
1921 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1922 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1923 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1924 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1925 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1926
1927 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1928 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1929 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1930 the program, not by the shell.
1931
1932 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1933 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1934
1935 @table @code
1936 @kindex set args
1937 @item set args
1938 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1939 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1940 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1941 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1942 it again without arguments.
1943
1944 @kindex show args
1945 @item show args
1946 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1947 @end table
1948
1949 @node Environment
1950 @section Your Program's Environment
1951
1952 @cindex environment (of your program)
1953 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1954 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1955 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1956 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1957 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1958 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1959 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1960
1961 @table @code
1962 @kindex path
1963 @item path @var{directory}
1964 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1965 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1966 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1967 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1968 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1969 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1970 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1971
1972 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1973 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1974 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1975 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1976 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1977 @var{directory} to the search path.
1978 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1979 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1980
1981 @kindex show paths
1982 @item show paths
1983 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1984 environment variable).
1985
1986 @kindex show environment
1987 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1988 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1989 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1990 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1991 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1992
1993 @kindex set environment
1994 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
1995 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1996 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1997 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1998 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1999 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2000 null value.
2001 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2002 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2003
2004 For example, this command:
2005
2006 @smallexample
2007 set env USER = foo
2008 @end smallexample
2009
2010 @noindent
2011 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2012 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2013 are not actually required.)
2014
2015 @kindex unset environment
2016 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2017 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2018 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2019 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2020 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2021 @end table
2022
2023 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2024 the shell indicated
2025 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2026 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2027 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2028 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2029 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2030 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2031 @file{.profile}.
2032
2033 @node Working Directory
2034 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2035
2036 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2037 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2038 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2039 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2040 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2041 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2042
2043 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2044 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2045 Specify Files}.
2046
2047 @table @code
2048 @kindex cd
2049 @cindex change working directory
2050 @item cd @var{directory}
2051 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2052
2053 @kindex pwd
2054 @item pwd
2055 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2056 @end table
2057
2058 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2059 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2060 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2061 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2062 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2063 current working directory of the debuggee.
2064
2065 @node Input/Output
2066 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2067
2068 @cindex redirection
2069 @cindex i/o
2070 @cindex terminal
2071 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2072 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2073 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2074 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2075 running your program.
2076
2077 @table @code
2078 @kindex info terminal
2079 @item info terminal
2080 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2081 program is using.
2082 @end table
2083
2084 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2085 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2086
2087 @smallexample
2088 run > outfile
2089 @end smallexample
2090
2091 @noindent
2092 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2093
2094 @kindex tty
2095 @cindex controlling terminal
2096 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2097 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2098 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2099 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2100 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2101
2102 @smallexample
2103 tty /dev/ttyb
2104 @end smallexample
2105
2106 @noindent
2107 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2108 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2109 that as their controlling terminal.
2110
2111 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2112 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2113 terminal.
2114
2115 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2116 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2117 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2118 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2119
2120 @cindex inferior tty
2121 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2122 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2123 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2124 program.
2125
2126 @table @code
2127 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2128 @kindex set inferior-tty
2129 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2130
2131 @item show inferior-tty
2132 @kindex show inferior-tty
2133 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2134 @end table
2135
2136 @node Attach
2137 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2138 @kindex attach
2139 @cindex attach
2140
2141 @table @code
2142 @item attach @var{process-id}
2143 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2144 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2145 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2146 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2147 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2148
2149 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2150 executing the command.
2151 @end table
2152
2153 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2154 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2155 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2156 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2157
2158 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2159 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2160 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2161 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2162 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2163 Specify Files}.
2164
2165 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2166 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2167 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2168 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2169 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2170 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2171 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2172
2173 @table @code
2174 @kindex detach
2175 @item detach
2176 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2177 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2178 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2179 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2180 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2181 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2182 executing the command.
2183 @end table
2184
2185 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2186 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2187 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2188 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2189 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2190 Messages}).
2191
2192 @node Kill Process
2193 @section Killing the Child Process
2194
2195 @table @code
2196 @kindex kill
2197 @item kill
2198 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2199 @end table
2200
2201 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2202 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2203 is running.
2204
2205 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2206 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2207 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2208 outside the debugger.
2209
2210 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2211 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2212 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2213 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2214 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2215 breakpoint settings).
2216
2217 @node Threads
2218 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2219
2220 @cindex threads of execution
2221 @cindex multiple threads
2222 @cindex switching threads
2223 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2224 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2225 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2226 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2227 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2228 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2229 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2230
2231 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2232 programs:
2233
2234 @itemize @bullet
2235 @item automatic notification of new threads
2236 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2237 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2238 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2239 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2240 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2241 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2242 messages on thread start and exit.
2243 @end itemize
2244
2245 @quotation
2246 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2247 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2248 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2249 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2250 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2251 like this:
2252
2253 @smallexample
2254 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2255 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2256 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2257 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2258 @end smallexample
2259 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2260 @c doesn't support threads"?
2261 @end quotation
2262
2263 @cindex focus of debugging
2264 @cindex current thread
2265 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2266 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2267 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2268 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2269 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2270
2271 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2272 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2273 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2274 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2275 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2276 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2277 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2278 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2279 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2280 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2281
2282 @smallexample
2283 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2284 @end smallexample
2285
2286 @noindent
2287 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2288 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2289 further qualifier.
2290
2291 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2292 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2293 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2294 @c program?
2295 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2296 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2297 @c threads ab initio?
2298
2299 @cindex thread number
2300 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2301 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2302 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2303
2304 @table @code
2305 @kindex info threads
2306 @item info threads
2307 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2308 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2309
2310 @enumerate
2311 @item
2312 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2313
2314 @item
2315 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2316
2317 @item
2318 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2319 @end enumerate
2320
2321 @noindent
2322 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2323 indicates the current thread.
2324
2325 For example,
2326 @end table
2327 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2328
2329 @smallexample
2330 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2331 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2332 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2333 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2334 at threadtest.c:68
2335 @end smallexample
2336
2337 On HP-UX systems:
2338
2339 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2340 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2341 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2342 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2343 thread in your program.
2344
2345 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2346 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2347 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2348 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2349 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2350 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2351 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2352 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2353 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2354 HP-UX, you see
2355
2356 @smallexample
2357 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2358 @end smallexample
2359
2360 @noindent
2361 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2362
2363 @table @code
2364 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2365 @item info threads
2366 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2367 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2368
2369 @enumerate
2370 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2371
2372 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2373
2374 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2375 @end enumerate
2376
2377 @noindent
2378 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2379 indicates the current thread.
2380
2381 For example,
2382 @end table
2383 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2384
2385 @smallexample
2386 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2387 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2388 at quicksort.c:137
2389 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2390 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2391 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2392 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2393 @end smallexample
2394
2395 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2396 Solaris-specific command:
2397
2398 @table @code
2399 @item maint info sol-threads
2400 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2401 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2402 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2403 @end table
2404
2405 @table @code
2406 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2407 @item thread @var{threadno}
2408 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2409 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2410 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2411 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2412 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2413
2414 @smallexample
2415 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2416 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2417 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2418 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2419 @end smallexample
2420
2421 @noindent
2422 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2423 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2424 threads.
2425
2426 @kindex thread apply
2427 @cindex apply command to several threads
2428 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2429 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2430 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2431 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2432 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2433 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2434 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2435 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2436
2437 @kindex set print thread-events
2438 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2439 @item set print thread-events
2440 @itemx set print thread-events on
2441 @itemx set print thread-events off
2442 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2443 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2444 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2445 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2446 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2447
2448 @kindex show print thread-events
2449 @item show print thread-events
2450 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2451 have started and exited.
2452 @end table
2453
2454 @cindex automatic thread selection
2455 @cindex switching threads automatically
2456 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2457 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2458 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2459 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2460 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2461 thread.
2462
2463 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2464 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2465 programs with multiple threads.
2466
2467 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2468 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2469
2470 @node Processes
2471 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Processes
2472
2473 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2474 @cindex multiple processes
2475 @cindex processes, multiple
2476 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2477 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2478 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2479 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2480 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2481 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2482 will cause it to terminate.
2483
2484 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2485 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2486 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2487 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2488 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2489 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2490 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2491 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2492 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2493 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2494
2495 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2496 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2497 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2498 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2499
2500 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2501 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2502
2503 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2504 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2505
2506 @table @code
2507 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2508 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2509 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2510 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2511 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2512
2513 @table @code
2514 @item parent
2515 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2516 unimpeded. This is the default.
2517
2518 @item child
2519 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2520 unimpeded.
2521
2522 @end table
2523
2524 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2525 @item show follow-fork-mode
2526 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2527 @end table
2528
2529 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2530 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2531 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2532
2533 @table @code
2534 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2535 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2536 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2537 retain debugger control over them both.
2538
2539 @table @code
2540 @item on
2541 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2542 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2543 independently. This is the default.
2544
2545 @item off
2546 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2547 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2548 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2549 is held suspended.
2550
2551 @end table
2552
2553 @kindex show detach-on-fork
2554 @item show detach-on-fork
2555 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2556 @end table
2557
2558 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then
2559 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2560 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2561 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2562 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2563
2564 @table @code
2565 @kindex info forks
2566 @item info forks
2567 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2568 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2569 position (program counter) of the process.
2570
2571 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2572 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2573 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2574 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2575 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2576
2577 @kindex process @var{process-id}
2578 @item process @var{process-id}
2579 Make process number @var{process-id} the current process. The
2580 argument @var{process-id} must be one that is listed in the output of
2581 @samp{info forks}.
2582
2583 @end table
2584
2585 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2586 from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2587 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2588 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2589
2590 @table @code
2591 @kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2592 @item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2593 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2594 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2595 allowed to run independently.
2596
2597 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2598 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2599 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2600 and remove it from the fork list.
2601
2602 @end table
2603
2604 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2605 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2606 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2607 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2608 the child process's @code{main}.
2609
2610 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2611 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2612
2613 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2614 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2615 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2616 argument.
2617
2618 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2619 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2620 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
2621
2622 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2623 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
2624
2625 @cindex checkpoint
2626 @cindex restart
2627 @cindex bookmark
2628 @cindex snapshot of a process
2629 @cindex rewind program state
2630
2631 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2632 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2633 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2634 later.
2635
2636 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2637 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2638 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2639 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2640 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2641
2642 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2643 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2644 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2645 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2646 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2647 start again from there.
2648
2649 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2650 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2651
2652 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2653
2654 @table @code
2655 @kindex checkpoint
2656 @item checkpoint
2657 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2658 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2659 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2660
2661 @kindex info checkpoints
2662 @item info checkpoints
2663 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2664 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2665 listed:
2666
2667 @table @code
2668 @item Checkpoint ID
2669 @item Process ID
2670 @item Code Address
2671 @item Source line, or label
2672 @end table
2673
2674 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2675 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2676 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2677 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2678 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2679 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2680 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2681
2682 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2683 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2684 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2685 the debugger.
2686
2687 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2688 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2689 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2690
2691 @end table
2692
2693 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2694 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2695 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2696 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2697 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2698 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2699 previously read data can be read again.
2700
2701 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2702 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2703 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2704 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2705 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2706 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2707
2708 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2709 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2710 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2711 different execution path this time.
2712
2713 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2714 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2715 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2716 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2717 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2718 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2719 potentially pose a problem.
2720
2721 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
2722
2723 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2724 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2725 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2726 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2727 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2728 next.
2729
2730 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2731 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2732 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2733 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2734 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2735
2736 @node Stopping
2737 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2738
2739 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2740 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2741 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2742
2743 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2744 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2745 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2746 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2747 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2748 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2749 explicitly request this information at any time.
2750
2751 @table @code
2752 @kindex info program
2753 @item info program
2754 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2755 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2756 @end table
2757
2758 @menu
2759 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2760 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2761 * Signals:: Signals
2762 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2763 @end menu
2764
2765 @node Breakpoints
2766 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
2767
2768 @cindex breakpoints
2769 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2770 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2771 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2772 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2773 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2774 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2775 program.
2776
2777 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2778 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2779 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2780 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2781 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2782 call).
2783
2784 @cindex watchpoints
2785 @cindex data breakpoints
2786 @cindex memory tracing
2787 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2788 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2789 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2790 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2791 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2792 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2793 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2794 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
2795 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2796 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2797 same commands.
2798
2799 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2800 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2801 Automatic Display}.
2802
2803 @cindex catchpoints
2804 @cindex breakpoint on events
2805 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2806 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2807 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2808 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2809 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2810 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2811 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2812
2813 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2814 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2815 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2816 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2817 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2818 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2819 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2820 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2821 enable it again.
2822
2823 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2824 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2825 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2826 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2827 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2828 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2829 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
2830
2831 @menu
2832 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2833 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2834 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2835 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2836 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2837 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2838 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2839 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2840 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2841 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2842 @end menu
2843
2844 @node Set Breaks
2845 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
2846
2847 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2848 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2849 @c
2850 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2851
2852 @kindex break
2853 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2854 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2855 @cindex latest breakpoint
2856 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2857 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2858 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2859 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2860 convenience variables.
2861
2862 @table @code
2863 @item break @var{location}
2864 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
2865 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
2866 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
2867 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
2868 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
2869
2870 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2871 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2872 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint Menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2873
2874 @item break
2875 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2876 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2877 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2878 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2879 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2880 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2881 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2882 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2883 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2884 inside loops.
2885
2886 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2887 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2888 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2889 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2890 existed when your program stopped.
2891
2892 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2893 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2894 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2895 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2896 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2897 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2898 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2899
2900 @kindex tbreak
2901 @item tbreak @var{args}
2902 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2903 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2904 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2905 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2906
2907 @kindex hbreak
2908 @cindex hardware breakpoints
2909 @item hbreak @var{args}
2910 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2911 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2912 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2913 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2914 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2915 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2916 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
2917 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2918 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2919 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2920 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2921 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2922 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2923 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
2924 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2925 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2926 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2927 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2928
2929 @kindex thbreak
2930 @item thbreak @var{args}
2931 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2932 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2933 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2934 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2935 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2936 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2937 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2938 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2939
2940 @kindex rbreak
2941 @cindex regular expression
2942 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
2943 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
2944 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2945 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2946 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2947 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2948 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2949 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2950 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2951
2952 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2953 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2954 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2955 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2956 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2957 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2958
2959 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
2960 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2961 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2962 classes.
2963
2964 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
2965 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
2966 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
2967
2968 @smallexample
2969 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
2970 @end smallexample
2971
2972 @kindex info breakpoints
2973 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2974 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2975 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2976 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2977 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2978 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
2979 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
2980 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
2981
2982 @table @emph
2983 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2984 @item Type
2985 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2986 @item Disposition
2987 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2988 @item Enabled or Disabled
2989 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2990 that are not enabled. An optional @samp{(p)} suffix marks pending
2991 breakpoints---breakpoints for which address is either not yet
2992 resolved, pending load of a shared library, or for which address was
2993 in a shared library that was since unloaded. Such breakpoint won't
2994 fire until a shared library that has the symbol or line referred by
2995 breakpoint is loaded. See below for details.
2996 @item Address
2997 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
2998 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
2999 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. A breakpoint with several locations will
3000 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3001 @item What
3002 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3003 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3004 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3005 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3006 @end table
3007
3008 @noindent
3009 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3010 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3011 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3012 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3013 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3014 valid location.
3015
3016 @noindent
3017 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3018 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3019 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3020 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3021 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3022
3023 @noindent
3024 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3025 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3026 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3027 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3028 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3029 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3030 @end table
3031
3032 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3033 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3034 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3035 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3036
3037 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3038 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3039
3040 @itemize @bullet
3041
3042 @item
3043 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3044 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3045
3046 @item
3047 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3048 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3049
3050 @item
3051 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3052 several places where that function is inlined.
3053
3054 @end itemize
3055
3056 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3057 the relevant locations.
3058
3059 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3060 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3061 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3062 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3063 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3064 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3065 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3066
3067 For example:
3068
3069 @smallexample
3070 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3071 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3072 stop only if i==1
3073 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3074 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3075 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3076 @end smallexample
3077
3078 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3079 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3080 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3081 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3082 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3083 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3084 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3085 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3086 that belong to that breakpoint.
3087
3088 @cindex pending breakpoints
3089 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3090 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3091 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3092 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3093 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3094 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3095 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3096 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3097 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3098 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3099 is not yet resolved.
3100
3101 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3102 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3103 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3104 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3105 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3106 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3107
3108 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3109 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3110 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3111 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3112
3113 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3114 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3115 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3116
3117 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3118 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3119 address specification to an address:
3120
3121 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3122 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3123 @table @code
3124 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3125 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3126 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3127
3128 @item set breakpoint pending on
3129 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3130 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3131
3132 @item set breakpoint pending off
3133 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3134 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3135 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3136
3137 @item show breakpoint pending
3138 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3139 @end table
3140
3141 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3142 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3143 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3144
3145 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3146 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3147 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3148 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3149 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3150 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3151 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3152 breakpoints.
3153
3154 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3155
3156 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3157 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3158 @table @code
3159 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3160 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3161 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3162 breakpoint must be used.
3163
3164 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3165 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3166 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3167 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3168 @end table
3169
3170
3171 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3172 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3173 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3174 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3175 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3176 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3177 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3178 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3179
3180
3181 @node Set Watchpoints
3182 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3183
3184 @cindex setting watchpoints
3185 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3186 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3187 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3188 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3189 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3190
3191 @itemize @bullet
3192 @item
3193 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3194
3195 @item
3196 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3197 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3198 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3199
3200 @item
3201 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3202 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3203 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3204 @end itemize
3205
3206 @cindex software watchpoints
3207 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3208 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3209 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3210 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3211 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3212 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3213 culprit.)
3214
3215 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3216 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3217 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3218
3219 @table @code
3220 @kindex watch
3221 @item watch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3222 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3223 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3224 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3225 to watch the value of a single variable:
3226
3227 @smallexample
3228 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3229 @end smallexample
3230
3231 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3232 clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3233 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3234 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3235 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3236 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3237
3238 @kindex rwatch
3239 @item rwatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3240 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3241 by the program.
3242
3243 @kindex awatch
3244 @item awatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3245 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3246 or written into by the program.
3247
3248 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3249 @item info watchpoints
3250 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3251 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3252 @end table
3253
3254 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3255 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3256 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3257 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3258 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3259 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3260
3261 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3262 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3263 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3264 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3265 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3266 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3267 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3268 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3269
3270 @table @code
3271 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3272 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3273 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3274
3275 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3276 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3277 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3278 @end table
3279
3280 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3281 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3282 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3283
3284 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3285
3286 @smallexample
3287 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3288 @end smallexample
3289
3290 @noindent
3291 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3292
3293 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3294 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3295 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3296 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3297 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3298 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3299 will print a message like this:
3300
3301 @smallexample
3302 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3303 @end smallexample
3304
3305 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3306 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3307 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3308 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3309 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3310 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3311 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3312 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3313
3314 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3315 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3316 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3317 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3318 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3319 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3320
3321 @smallexample
3322 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3323 @end smallexample
3324
3325 @noindent
3326 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3327
3328 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3329 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3330 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3331 expression with separately allocated resources.
3332
3333 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
3334 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
3335 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
3336 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
3337 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
3338 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
3339 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
3340 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
3341 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
3342 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
3343
3344 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3345 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3346 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3347
3348 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3349 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3350 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3351 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3352 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3353 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3354 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3355 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3356 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3357
3358 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3359 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3360 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3361 watched expression from every thread.
3362
3363 @quotation
3364 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3365 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3366 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3367 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3368 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3369 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3370 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3371 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3372 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3373 @end quotation
3374
3375 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3376
3377 @node Set Catchpoints
3378 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3379 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3380 @cindex exception handlers
3381 @cindex event handling
3382
3383 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3384 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3385 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3386
3387 @table @code
3388 @kindex catch
3389 @item catch @var{event}
3390 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3391 @table @code
3392 @item throw
3393 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3394 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3395
3396 @item catch
3397 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3398
3399 @item exception
3400 @cindex Ada exception catching
3401 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3402 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3403 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3404 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3405 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3406
3407 @item exception unhandled
3408 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3409
3410 @item assert
3411 A failed Ada assertion.
3412
3413 @item exec
3414 @cindex break on fork/exec
3415 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3416
3417 @item fork
3418 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3419
3420 @item vfork
3421 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3422
3423 @item load
3424 @itemx load @var{libname}
3425 @cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3426 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3427 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3428
3429 @item unload
3430 @itemx unload @var{libname}
3431 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3432 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3433 @end table
3434
3435 @item tcatch @var{event}
3436 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3437 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3438
3439 @end table
3440
3441 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3442
3443 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3444 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3445
3446 @itemize @bullet
3447 @item
3448 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3449 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3450 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3451 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3452 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3453 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3454 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3455 disabled within interactive calls.
3456
3457 @item
3458 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3459
3460 @item
3461 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3462 @end itemize
3463
3464 @cindex raise exceptions
3465 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3466 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3467 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3468 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3469 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3470 out where the exception was raised.
3471
3472 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3473 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3474 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3475 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3476
3477 @smallexample
3478 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3479 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3480 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3481 @end smallexample
3482
3483 @noindent
3484 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3485 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3486 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
3487
3488 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
3489 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3490 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3491 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3492 raised.
3493
3494
3495 @node Delete Breaks
3496 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
3497
3498 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3499 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3500 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3501 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3502 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3503 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3504
3505 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3506 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3507 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3508 their breakpoint numbers.
3509
3510 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3511 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3512 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3513
3514 @table @code
3515 @kindex clear
3516 @item clear
3517 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3518 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
3519 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3520 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3521
3522 @item clear @var{location}
3523 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
3524 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
3525 most useful ones are listed below:
3526
3527 @table @code
3528 @item clear @var{function}
3529 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3530 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3531
3532 @item clear @var{linenum}
3533 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3534 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3535 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3536 @end table
3537
3538 @cindex delete breakpoints
3539 @kindex delete
3540 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3541 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3542 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3543 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3544 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3545 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3546 @end table
3547
3548 @node Disabling
3549 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
3550
3551 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3552 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3553 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3554 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3555 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3556
3557 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3558 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3559 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3560 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3561 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3562
3563 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
3564 affects all of its locations.
3565
3566 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3567 states of enablement:
3568
3569 @itemize @bullet
3570 @item
3571 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3572 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3573 @item
3574 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3575 @item
3576 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3577 disabled.
3578 @item
3579 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3580 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3581 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3582 @end itemize
3583
3584 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3585 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3586
3587 @table @code
3588 @kindex disable
3589 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3590 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3591 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3592 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3593 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3594 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3595 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3596
3597 @kindex enable
3598 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3599 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3600 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3601
3602 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3603 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3604 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3605
3606 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3607 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3608 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3609 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3610 @end table
3611
3612 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3613 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3614 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3615 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3616 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3617 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3618 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3619 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3620 Stepping}.)
3621
3622 @node Conditions
3623 @subsection Break Conditions
3624 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3625 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3626
3627 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3628 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3629 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3630 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3631 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3632 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3633 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3634 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3635
3636 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3637 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3638 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3639 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3640 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3641
3642 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3643 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3644 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3645 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3646 one.
3647
3648 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3649 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3650 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3651 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3652 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3653 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3654 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3655 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3656 conditions for the
3657 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3658 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
3659
3660 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3661 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3662 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3663 with the @code{condition} command.
3664
3665 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3666 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3667 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3668 catchpoint.
3669
3670 @table @code
3671 @kindex condition
3672 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3673 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3674 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3675 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3676 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3677 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3678 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3679 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3680 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3681 prints an error message:
3682
3683 @smallexample
3684 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3685 @end smallexample
3686
3687 @noindent
3688 @value{GDBN} does
3689 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3690 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3691 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3692
3693 @item condition @var{bnum}
3694 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3695 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3696 @end table
3697
3698 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3699 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3700 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3701 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3702 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3703 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3704 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3705 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3706 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3707 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3708 your program reaches it.
3709
3710 @table @code
3711 @kindex ignore
3712 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3713 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3714 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3715 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3716 takes no action.
3717
3718 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3719 a count of zero.
3720
3721 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3722 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3723 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3724 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
3725
3726 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3727 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3728 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3729
3730 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3731 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3732 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3733 Variables}.
3734 @end table
3735
3736 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3737
3738
3739 @node Break Commands
3740 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
3741
3742 @cindex breakpoint commands
3743 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3744 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3745 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3746 enable other breakpoints.
3747
3748 @table @code
3749 @kindex commands
3750 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3751 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3752 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3753 @itemx end
3754 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3755 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3756 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3757
3758 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3759 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3760
3761 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3762 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3763 recently encountered).
3764 @end table
3765
3766 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3767 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3768
3769 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3770 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3771 that resumes execution.
3772
3773 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3774 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3775 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3776 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3777 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3778
3779 @kindex silent
3780 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3781 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3782 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3783 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3784 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3785 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3786
3787 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3788 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3789 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
3790
3791 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3792 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3793
3794 @smallexample
3795 break foo if x>0
3796 commands
3797 silent
3798 printf "x is %d\n",x
3799 cont
3800 end
3801 @end smallexample
3802
3803 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3804 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3805 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3806 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3807 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3808 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3809 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3810
3811 @smallexample
3812 break 403
3813 commands
3814 silent
3815 set x = y + 4
3816 cont
3817 end
3818 @end smallexample
3819
3820 @node Breakpoint Menus
3821 @subsection Breakpoint Menus
3822 @cindex overloading
3823 @cindex symbol overloading
3824
3825 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit a
3826 single function name
3827 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3828 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3829 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3830 a breakpoint. You can use explicit signature of the function, as in
3831 @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})}, to specify which
3832 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3833 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3834 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3835 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3836 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3837 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3838 breakpoints.
3839
3840 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3841 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3842 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3843
3844 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3845 @smallexample
3846 @group
3847 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3848 [0] cancel
3849 [1] all
3850 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3851 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3852 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3853 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3854 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3855 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3856 > 2 4 6
3857 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3858 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3859 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3860 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3861 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3862 breakpoints.
3863 (@value{GDBP})
3864 @end group
3865 @end smallexample
3866
3867 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3868 @node Error in Breakpoints
3869 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3870 @c
3871 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3872 @c
3873 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3874 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3875 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3876 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3877
3878 @smallexample
3879 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3880 The same program may be running in another process.
3881 @end smallexample
3882
3883 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3884
3885 @enumerate
3886 @item
3887 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3888
3889 @item
3890 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3891 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3892 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3893 Then start your program again.
3894
3895 @item
3896 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3897 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3898 to nonsharable executables.
3899 @end enumerate
3900 @c @end ifclear
3901
3902 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3903 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3904
3905 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3906 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3907 @smallexample
3908 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3909 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3910 @end smallexample
3911
3912 @noindent
3913 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3914 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3915 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3916
3917 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3918 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3919
3920 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
3921 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3922 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3923
3924 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3925 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3926 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3927 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3928
3929 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3930 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3931 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3932 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3933 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3934 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3935 first in the bundle.
3936
3937 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3938 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3939 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3940 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3941 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3942 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3943 is hit.
3944
3945 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3946 that's been subject to address adjustment:
3947
3948 @smallexample
3949 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3950 @end smallexample
3951
3952 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3953 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3954 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3955 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3956 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3957 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3958 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3959 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3960
3961 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3962 adjusted breakpoints:
3963
3964 @smallexample
3965 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3966 to 0x00010410.
3967 @end smallexample
3968
3969 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3970 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3971 frequently than expected.
3972
3973 @node Continuing and Stepping
3974 @section Continuing and Stepping
3975
3976 @cindex stepping
3977 @cindex continuing
3978 @cindex resuming execution
3979 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3980 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3981 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3982 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3983 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3984 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3985 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3986 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3987
3988 @table @code
3989 @kindex continue
3990 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3991 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3992 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3993 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3994 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3995 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3996 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3997 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3998 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3999 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4000
4001 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4002 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4003 @code{continue} is ignored.
4004
4005 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4006 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4007 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4008 @code{continue}.
4009 @end table
4010
4011 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4012 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4013 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4014 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4015
4016 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4017 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4018 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4019 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4020 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4021 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4022
4023 @table @code
4024 @kindex step
4025 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4026 @item step
4027 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4028 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4029 abbreviated @code{s}.
4030
4031 @quotation
4032 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4033 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4034 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4035 @c distinction here.
4036 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4037 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4038 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4039 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4040 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4041 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4042 below.
4043 @end quotation
4044
4045 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4046 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4047 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4048 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4049 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4050 called within the line.
4051
4052 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4053 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4054 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4055 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4056 was any debugging information about the routine.
4057
4058 @item step @var{count}
4059 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4060 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4061 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4062
4063 @kindex next
4064 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4065 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4066 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4067 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4068 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4069 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4070 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4071 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4072
4073 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4074
4075
4076 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4077 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4078 @c
4079 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4080 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4081 @c function are executed without stopping.
4082
4083 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4084 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4085 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4086
4087 @kindex set step-mode
4088 @item set step-mode
4089 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4090 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4091 @itemx set step-mode on
4092 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4093 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4094 information rather than stepping over it.
4095
4096 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4097 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4098 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4099
4100 @item set step-mode off
4101 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4102 debug information. This is the default.
4103
4104 @item show step-mode
4105 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4106 source line debug information.
4107
4108 @kindex finish
4109 @item finish
4110 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4111 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
4112
4113 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4114 ,Returning from a Function}).
4115
4116 @kindex until
4117 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4118 @cindex run until specified location
4119 @item until
4120 @itemx u
4121 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4122 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4123 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4124 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4125 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4126 than the address of the jump.
4127
4128 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4129 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4130 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4131 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4132 through the next iteration.
4133
4134 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4135 stack frame.
4136
4137 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4138 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4139 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4140 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4141 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4142
4143 @smallexample
4144 (@value{GDBP}) f
4145 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4146 206 expand_input();
4147 (@value{GDBP}) until
4148 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4149 @end smallexample
4150
4151 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4152 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4153 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4154 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4155 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4156 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4157 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4158
4159 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4160 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4161 argument.
4162
4163 @item until @var{location}
4164 @itemx u @var{location}
4165 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4166 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4167 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4168 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4169 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4170 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4171 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4172 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4173 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4174 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4175 invocations have returned.
4176
4177 @smallexample
4178 94 int factorial (int value)
4179 95 @{
4180 96 if (value > 1) @{
4181 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4182 98 @}
4183 99 return (value);
4184 100 @}
4185 @end smallexample
4186
4187
4188 @kindex advance @var{location}
4189 @itemx advance @var{location}
4190 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4191 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4192 @ref{Specify Location}.
4193 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4194 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4195 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4196 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4197
4198
4199 @kindex stepi
4200 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4201 @item stepi
4202 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4203 @itemx si
4204 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4205
4206 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4207 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4208 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4209 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4210
4211 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4212
4213 @need 750
4214 @kindex nexti
4215 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4216 @item nexti
4217 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4218 @itemx ni
4219 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4220 proceed until the function returns.
4221
4222 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4223 @end table
4224
4225 @node Signals
4226 @section Signals
4227 @cindex signals
4228
4229 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4230 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4231 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4232 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4233 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4234 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4235 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4236 requested an alarm).
4237
4238 @cindex fatal signals
4239 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4240 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4241 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4242 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4243 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4244 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4245
4246 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4247 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4248 signal.
4249
4250 @cindex handling signals
4251 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4252 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4253 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4254 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4255 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4256
4257 @table @code
4258 @kindex info signals
4259 @kindex info handle
4260 @item info signals
4261 @itemx info handle
4262 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4263 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4264 the defined types of signals.
4265
4266 @item info signals @var{sig}
4267 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4268
4269 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4270
4271 @kindex handle
4272 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4273 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4274 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4275 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4276 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4277 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4278 say what change to make.
4279 @end table
4280
4281 @c @group
4282 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4283 Their full names are:
4284
4285 @table @code
4286 @item nostop
4287 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4288 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4289
4290 @item stop
4291 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4292 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4293
4294 @item print
4295 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4296
4297 @item noprint
4298 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4299 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4300
4301 @item pass
4302 @itemx noignore
4303 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4304 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4305 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4306
4307 @item nopass
4308 @itemx ignore
4309 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4310 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4311 @end table
4312 @c @end group
4313
4314 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4315 program until you
4316 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4317 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4318 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4319 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4320 program sees that signal when you continue.
4321
4322 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4323 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4324 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4325 erroneous signals.
4326
4327 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4328 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4329 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4330 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4331 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4332 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4333 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4334 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4335 Program a Signal}.
4336
4337 @node Thread Stops
4338 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4339
4340 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4341 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
4342 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4343
4344 @table @code
4345 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4346 @cindex thread breakpoints
4347 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4348 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4349 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4350 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4351 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
4352 specify some source line.
4353
4354 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4355 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4356 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4357 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4358 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4359
4360 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4361 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4362 program.
4363
4364 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4365 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4366 breakpoint condition, like this:
4367
4368 @smallexample
4369 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4370 @end smallexample
4371
4372 @end table
4373
4374 @cindex stopped threads
4375 @cindex threads, stopped
4376 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4377 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4378 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4379 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4380 underfoot.
4381
4382 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4383 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4384 @cindex premature return from system calls
4385 There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
4386 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4387 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4388 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4389 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4390 stop execution.
4391
4392 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4393 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4394 style anyways.
4395
4396 For example, do not write code like this:
4397
4398 @smallexample
4399 sleep (10);
4400 @end smallexample
4401
4402 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4403 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4404
4405 Instead, write this:
4406
4407 @smallexample
4408 int unslept = 10;
4409 while (unslept > 0)
4410 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4411 @end smallexample
4412
4413 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4414 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4415 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4416 @value{GDBN}.
4417
4418 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4419 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4420 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4421 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4422
4423 @cindex continuing threads
4424 @cindex threads, continuing
4425 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4426 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4427 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4428
4429 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4430 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4431 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4432 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4433 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4434 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4435 stops.
4436
4437 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4438 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4439 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4440 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4441
4442 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
4443 thread to run.
4444
4445 @table @code
4446 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4447 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4448 @cindex lock scheduler
4449 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4450 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4451 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4452 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
4453 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
4454 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4455 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4456 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4457 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4458 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
4459 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
4460
4461 @item show scheduler-locking
4462 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4463 @end table
4464
4465
4466 @node Stack
4467 @chapter Examining the Stack
4468
4469 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4470 stopped and how it got there.
4471
4472 @cindex call stack
4473 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4474 is generated.
4475 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4476 the arguments of the call,
4477 and the local variables of the function being called.
4478 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4479 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4480 stack}.
4481
4482 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4483 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4484
4485 @cindex selected frame
4486 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4487 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4488 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4489 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4490 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4491 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4492
4493 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4494 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4495 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
4496
4497 @menu
4498 * Frames:: Stack frames
4499 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4500 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4501 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4502
4503 @end menu
4504
4505 @node Frames
4506 @section Stack Frames
4507
4508 @cindex frame, definition
4509 @cindex stack frame
4510 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4511 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4512 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4513 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4514 which the function is executing.
4515
4516 @cindex initial frame
4517 @cindex outermost frame
4518 @cindex innermost frame
4519 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4520 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4521 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4522 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4523 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4524 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4525 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4526 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4527
4528 @cindex frame pointer
4529 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4530 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4531 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4532 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4533 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4534 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4535
4536 @cindex frame number
4537 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4538 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4539 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4540 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4541 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4542
4543 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4544 @c underflow problems.
4545 @cindex frameless execution
4546 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4547 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
4548 @smallexample
4549 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4550 @end smallexample
4551 generates functions without a frame.)
4552 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4553 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4554 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4555 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4556 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4557 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4558 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4559
4560 @table @code
4561 @kindex frame@r{, command}
4562 @cindex current stack frame
4563 @item frame @var{args}
4564 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4565 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4566 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4567 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4568
4569 @kindex select-frame
4570 @cindex selecting frame silently
4571 @item select-frame
4572 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4573 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4574 @code{frame}.
4575 @end table
4576
4577 @node Backtrace
4578 @section Backtraces
4579
4580 @cindex traceback
4581 @cindex call stack traces
4582 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4583 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4584 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4585 stack.
4586
4587 @table @code
4588 @kindex backtrace
4589 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4590 @item backtrace
4591 @itemx bt
4592 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4593 frames in the stack.
4594
4595 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4596 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
4597
4598 @item backtrace @var{n}
4599 @itemx bt @var{n}
4600 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4601
4602 @item backtrace -@var{n}
4603 @itemx bt -@var{n}
4604 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4605
4606 @item backtrace full
4607 @itemx bt full
4608 @itemx bt full @var{n}
4609 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
4610 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
4611 number of frames to print, as described above.
4612 @end table
4613
4614 @kindex where
4615 @kindex info stack
4616 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4617 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4618
4619 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
4620 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
4621 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
4622 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
4623 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
4624 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
4625 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
4626 multi-threaded program.
4627
4628 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4629 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4630 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4631 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4632 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4633 line number.
4634
4635 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4636 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4637
4638 @smallexample
4639 @group
4640 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4641 at builtin.c:993
4642 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4643 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4644 at macro.c:71
4645 (More stack frames follow...)
4646 @end group
4647 @end smallexample
4648
4649 @noindent
4650 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4651 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4652 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4653
4654 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4655 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4656 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4657 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4658 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4659 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4660 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4661 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4662 such a backtrace might look like:
4663
4664 @smallexample
4665 @group
4666 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4667 at builtin.c:993
4668 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
4669 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
4670 at macro.c:71
4671 (More stack frames follow...)
4672 @end group
4673 @end smallexample
4674
4675 @noindent
4676 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
4677 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
4678
4679 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
4680 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
4681 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
4682
4683 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
4684 @cindex program entry point
4685 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
4686 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4687 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4688 @code{main}@footnote{
4689 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
4690 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
4691 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
4692 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4693 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4694 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4695
4696 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4697 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4698
4699 @table @code
4700 @item set backtrace past-main
4701 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
4702 @kindex set backtrace
4703 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4704
4705 @item set backtrace past-main off
4706 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4707 default.
4708
4709 @item show backtrace past-main
4710 @kindex show backtrace
4711 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4712
4713 @item set backtrace past-entry
4714 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
4715 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
4716 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
4717 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
4718
4719 @item set backtrace past-entry off
4720 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
4721 application. This is the default.
4722
4723 @item show backtrace past-entry
4724 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
4725
4726 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4727 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
4728 @cindex backtrace limit
4729 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4730 unlimited.
4731
4732 @item show backtrace limit
4733 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4734 @end table
4735
4736 @node Selection
4737 @section Selecting a Frame
4738
4739 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4740 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4741 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4742 of the stack frame just selected.
4743
4744 @table @code
4745 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4746 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4747 @item frame @var{n}
4748 @itemx f @var{n}
4749 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4750 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4751 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4752 @code{main}.
4753
4754 @item frame @var{addr}
4755 @itemx f @var{addr}
4756 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4757 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4758 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4759 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4760 switches between them.
4761
4762 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4763 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4764
4765 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4766 pointer and a program counter.
4767
4768 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4769 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4770
4771 @kindex up
4772 @item up @var{n}
4773 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4774 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4775 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4776
4777 @kindex down
4778 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4779 @item down @var{n}
4780 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4781 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4782 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4783 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4784 @end table
4785
4786 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4787 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4788 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4789 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4790
4791 @need 1000
4792 For example:
4793
4794 @smallexample
4795 @group
4796 (@value{GDBP}) up
4797 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4798 at env.c:10
4799 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4800 @end group
4801 @end smallexample
4802
4803 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4804 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4805 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4806 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4807 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
4808 for details.
4809
4810 @table @code
4811 @kindex down-silently
4812 @kindex up-silently
4813 @item up-silently @var{n}
4814 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4815 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4816 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4817 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4818 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4819 distracting.
4820 @end table
4821
4822 @node Frame Info
4823 @section Information About a Frame
4824
4825 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4826 stack frame.
4827
4828 @table @code
4829 @item frame
4830 @itemx f
4831 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4832 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4833 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4834 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4835 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4836
4837 @kindex info frame
4838 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4839 @item info frame
4840 @itemx info f
4841 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4842 including:
4843
4844 @itemize @bullet
4845 @item
4846 the address of the frame
4847 @item
4848 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4849 @item
4850 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4851 @item
4852 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4853 @item
4854 the address of the frame's arguments
4855 @item
4856 the address of the frame's local variables
4857 @item
4858 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4859 @item
4860 which registers were saved in the frame
4861 @end itemize
4862
4863 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4864 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4865 the usual conventions.
4866
4867 @item info frame @var{addr}
4868 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4869 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4870 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4871 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4872 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4873 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4874
4875 @kindex info args
4876 @item info args
4877 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4878
4879 @item info locals
4880 @kindex info locals
4881 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4882 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4883 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4884
4885 @kindex info catch
4886 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4887 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4888 @item info catch
4889 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4890 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4891 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4892 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4893 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
4894
4895 @end table
4896
4897
4898 @node Source
4899 @chapter Examining Source Files
4900
4901 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4902 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4903 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4904 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4905 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4906 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4907 source files by explicit command.
4908
4909 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4910 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4911 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4912
4913 @menu
4914 * List:: Printing source lines
4915 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
4916 * Edit:: Editing source files
4917 * Search:: Searching source files
4918 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4919 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4920 @end menu
4921
4922 @node List
4923 @section Printing Source Lines
4924
4925 @kindex list
4926 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4927 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4928 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4929 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
4930 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
4931
4932 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4933
4934 @table @code
4935 @item list @var{linenum}
4936 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4937 current source file.
4938
4939 @item list @var{function}
4940 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4941 @var{function}.
4942
4943 @item list
4944 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4945 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4946 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4947 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4948 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4949
4950 @item list -
4951 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4952 @end table
4953
4954 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
4955 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4956 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4957
4958 @table @code
4959 @kindex set listsize
4960 @item set listsize @var{count}
4961 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4962 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4963
4964 @kindex show listsize
4965 @item show listsize
4966 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4967 @end table
4968
4969 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4970 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4971 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4972 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4973 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4974
4975 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4976 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4977 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
4978 to specify some source line.
4979
4980 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4981
4982 @table @code
4983 @item list @var{linespec}
4984 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4985
4986 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4987 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4988 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
4989 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
4990 the same source file as the first linespec.
4991
4992 @item list ,@var{last}
4993 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4994
4995 @item list @var{first},
4996 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4997
4998 @item list +
4999 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
5000
5001 @item list -
5002 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5003
5004 @item list
5005 As described in the preceding table.
5006 @end table
5007
5008 @node Specify Location
5009 @section Specifying a Location
5010 @cindex specifying location
5011 @cindex linespec
5012
5013 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
5014 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
5015 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
5016 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
5017
5018 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
5019 @value{GDBN} understands:
5020
5021 @table @code
5022 @item @var{linenum}
5023 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
5024
5025 @item -@var{offset}
5026 @itemx +@var{offset}
5027 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
5028 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
5029 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
5030 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
5031 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
5032 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
5033 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
5034 linespec.
5035
5036 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
5037 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
5038
5039 @item @var{function}
5040 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
5041 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
5042
5043 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
5044 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
5045 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
5046 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
5047 functions in different source files.
5048
5049 @item *@var{address}
5050 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
5051 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
5052 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
5053 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
5054 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
5055 source files.
5056
5057 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
5058 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
5059 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
5060 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
5061 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
5062 of @var{address}:
5063
5064 @table @code
5065 @item @var{expression}
5066 Any expression valid in the current working language.
5067
5068 @item @var{funcaddr}
5069 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
5070 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
5071 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
5072 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
5073 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
5074 (although the Pascal form also works).
5075
5076 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
5077 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
5078
5079 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
5080 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
5081 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
5082 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
5083 functions with identical names in different source files.
5084 @end table
5085
5086 @end table
5087
5088
5089 @node Edit
5090 @section Editing Source Files
5091 @cindex editing source files
5092
5093 @kindex edit
5094 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
5095 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
5096 The editing program of your choice
5097 is invoked with the current line set to
5098 the active line in the program.
5099 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
5100 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
5101
5102 @table @code
5103 @item edit @var{location}
5104 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
5105 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
5106 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
5107 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
5108 command most commonly used:
5109
5110 @table @code
5111 @item edit @var{number}
5112 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
5113
5114 @item edit @var{function}
5115 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
5116 @end table
5117
5118 @end table
5119
5120 @subsection Choosing your Editor
5121 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5122 @footnote{
5123 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5124 following command-line syntax:
5125 @smallexample
5126 ex +@var{number} file
5127 @end smallexample
5128 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5129 the file where to start editing.}.
5130 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5131 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5132 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5133 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5134 @smallexample
5135 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5136 export EDITOR
5137 gdb @dots{}
5138 @end smallexample
5139 or in the @code{csh} shell,
5140 @smallexample
5141 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5142 gdb @dots{}
5143 @end smallexample
5144
5145 @node Search
5146 @section Searching Source Files
5147 @cindex searching source files
5148
5149 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5150 regular expression.
5151
5152 @table @code
5153 @kindex search
5154 @kindex forward-search
5155 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
5156 @itemx search @var{regexp}
5157 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5158 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5159 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5160 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5161 @code{fo}.
5162
5163 @kindex reverse-search
5164 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5165 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5166 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5167 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5168 this command as @code{rev}.
5169 @end table
5170
5171 @node Source Path
5172 @section Specifying Source Directories
5173
5174 @cindex source path
5175 @cindex directories for source files
5176 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5177 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5178 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5179 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5180 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5181 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5182 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5183
5184 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5185 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5186 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5187 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5188 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5189 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5190 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5191 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5192 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5193 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5194 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5195
5196 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5197 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5198 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5199 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5200 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5201 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5202
5203 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5204 source files.
5205
5206 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5207 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5208 each line is in the file.
5209
5210 @kindex directory
5211 @kindex dir
5212 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5213 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5214 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5215
5216 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5217 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5218
5219 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5220 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5221 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5222 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5223 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5224 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5225 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5226 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5227 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5228 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5229 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5230 name to look up the sources.
5231
5232 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5233 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5234 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5235 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5236 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5237 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5238 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5239 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5240
5241 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5242 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5243 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5244 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5245 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5246 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
5247 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5248
5249 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5250 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5251 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5252 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5253 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5254 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5255 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5256 command.
5257
5258 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5259 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5260 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5261 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5262 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5263 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5264 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
5265
5266 @table @code
5267 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5268 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5269 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5270 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5271 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5272 part of absolute file names) or
5273 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5274 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5275
5276 @kindex cdir
5277 @kindex cwd
5278 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5279 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
5280 @cindex compilation directory
5281 @cindex current directory
5282 @cindex working directory
5283 @cindex directory, current
5284 @cindex directory, compilation
5285 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5286 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5287 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5288 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5289 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5290 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5291
5292 @item directory
5293 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5294
5295 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5296 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5297
5298 @item show directories
5299 @kindex show directories
5300 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5301
5302 @anchor{set substitute-path}
5303 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5304 @kindex set substitute-path
5305 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5306 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5307 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5308
5309 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5310 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5311
5312 @smallexample
5313 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5314 @end smallexample
5315
5316 @noindent
5317 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5318 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5319 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5320
5321 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5322 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5323 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5324 the substitution.
5325
5326 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5327
5328 @smallexample
5329 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5330 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5331 @end smallexample
5332
5333 @noindent
5334 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5335 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5336 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5337 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5338
5339
5340 @item unset substitute-path [path]
5341 @kindex unset substitute-path
5342 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5343 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5344 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5345
5346 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5347
5348 @item show substitute-path [path]
5349 @kindex show substitute-path
5350 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5351 which would rewrite that path, if any.
5352
5353 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5354 rules.
5355
5356 @end table
5357
5358 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5359 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5360 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5361
5362 @enumerate
5363 @item
5364 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5365
5366 @item
5367 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5368 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5369 directories in one command.
5370 @end enumerate
5371
5372 @node Machine Code
5373 @section Source and Machine Code
5374 @cindex source line and its code address
5375
5376 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5377 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5378 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5379 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5380 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5381 well as hex.
5382
5383 @table @code
5384 @kindex info line
5385 @item info line @var{linespec}
5386 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5387 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5388 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
5389 @end table
5390
5391 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5392 the object code for the first line of function
5393 @code{m4_changequote}:
5394
5395 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5396 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5397 @smallexample
5398 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5399 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5400 @end smallexample
5401
5402 @noindent
5403 @cindex code address and its source line
5404 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5405 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5406 @smallexample
5407 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5408 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5409 @end smallexample
5410
5411 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5412 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5413 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5414 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5415 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5416 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5417 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5418 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5419 Variables}).
5420
5421 @table @code
5422 @kindex disassemble
5423 @cindex assembly instructions
5424 @cindex instructions, assembly
5425 @cindex machine instructions
5426 @cindex listing machine instructions
5427 @item disassemble
5428 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5429 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5430 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5431 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5432 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5433 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5434 @end table
5435
5436 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5437 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5438
5439 @smallexample
5440 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5441 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
5442 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
5443 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
5444 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5445 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
5446 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
5447 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
5448 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
5449 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5450 End of assembler dump.
5451 @end smallexample
5452
5453 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5454 mnemonics or other syntax.
5455
5456 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5457 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5458 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5459 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5460 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5461
5462 @table @code
5463 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
5464 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5465 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5466 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5467 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5468 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5469
5470 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5471 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5472 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5473 assemblers for x86-based targets.
5474
5475 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
5476 @item show disassembly-flavor
5477 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5478 @end table
5479
5480
5481 @node Data
5482 @chapter Examining Data
5483
5484 @cindex printing data
5485 @cindex examining data
5486 @kindex print
5487 @kindex inspect
5488 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5489 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5490 @c different window or something like that.
5491 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5492 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5493 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5494 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5495 Different Languages}).
5496
5497 @table @code
5498 @item print @var{expr}
5499 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5500 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5501 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5502 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5503 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5504 Formats}.
5505
5506 @item print
5507 @itemx print /@var{f}
5508 @cindex reprint the last value
5509 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5510 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
5511 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5512 @end table
5513
5514 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5515 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5516 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
5517
5518 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5519 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5520 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5521 Table}.
5522
5523 @menu
5524 * Expressions:: Expressions
5525 * Variables:: Program variables
5526 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5527 * Output Formats:: Output formats
5528 * Memory:: Examining memory
5529 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
5530 * Print Settings:: Print settings
5531 * Value History:: Value history
5532 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5533 * Registers:: Registers
5534 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5535 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5536 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5537 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5538 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5539 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5540 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5541 character set than GDB does
5542 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5543 @end menu
5544
5545 @node Expressions
5546 @section Expressions
5547
5548 @cindex expressions
5549 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5550 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5551 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5552 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5553 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5554 you compiled your program to include this information; see
5555 @ref{Compilation}.
5556
5557 @cindex arrays in expressions
5558 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5559 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5560 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
5561 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5562
5563 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5564 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5565 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5566 languages.
5567
5568 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5569 expressions regardless of your programming language.
5570
5571 @cindex casts, in expressions
5572 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5573 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5574 at that address in memory.
5575 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5576
5577 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5578 to programming languages:
5579
5580 @table @code
5581 @item @@
5582 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5583 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
5584
5585 @item ::
5586 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5587 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
5588
5589 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
5590 @cindex type casting memory
5591 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5592 @cindex casts, to view memory
5593 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5594 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5595 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5596 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5597 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5598 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5599 @end table
5600
5601 @node Variables
5602 @section Program Variables
5603
5604 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
5605 in your program.
5606
5607 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
5608 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
5609
5610 @itemize @bullet
5611 @item
5612 global (or file-static)
5613 @end itemize
5614
5615 @noindent or
5616
5617 @itemize @bullet
5618 @item
5619 visible according to the scope rules of the
5620 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5621 @end itemize
5622
5623 @noindent This means that in the function
5624
5625 @smallexample
5626 foo (a)
5627 int a;
5628 @{
5629 bar (a);
5630 @{
5631 int b = test ();
5632 bar (b);
5633 @}
5634 @}
5635 @end smallexample
5636
5637 @noindent
5638 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
5639 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
5640 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
5641 the block where @code{b} is declared.
5642
5643 @cindex variable name conflict
5644 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
5645 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
5646 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
5647 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
5648 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
5649 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
5650 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
5651
5652 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
5653 @ifnotinfo
5654 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
5655 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
5656 @end ifnotinfo
5657 @smallexample
5658 @var{file}::@var{variable}
5659 @var{function}::@var{variable}
5660 @end smallexample
5661
5662 @noindent
5663 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
5664 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
5665 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
5666 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
5667
5668 @smallexample
5669 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
5670 @end smallexample
5671
5672 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
5673 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
5674 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
5675 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
5676 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
5677 @c conflict?? --mew
5678
5679 @cindex wrong values
5680 @cindex variable values, wrong
5681 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
5682 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
5683 @quotation
5684 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
5685 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
5686 scope, and just before exit.
5687 @end quotation
5688 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
5689 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
5690 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
5691 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
5692 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
5693 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
5694 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
5695 variable definitions may be gone.
5696
5697 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
5698 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
5699 when compiling.
5700
5701 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
5702 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
5703 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
5704 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
5705 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
5706 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
5707 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
5708
5709 @smallexample
5710 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5711 @end smallexample
5712
5713 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
5714 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
5715 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
5716 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
5717 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
5718 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
5719 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
5720 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
5721 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
5722 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
5723 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
5724
5725 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
5726 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
5727 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
5728 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
5729
5730 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
5731 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
5732 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
5733 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
5734 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
5735 For program code
5736
5737 @smallexample
5738 char var0[] = "A";
5739 signed char var1[] = "A";
5740 @end smallexample
5741
5742 You get during debugging
5743 @smallexample
5744 (gdb) print var0
5745 $1 = "A"
5746 (gdb) print var1
5747 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
5748 @end smallexample
5749
5750 @node Arrays
5751 @section Artificial Arrays
5752
5753 @cindex artificial array
5754 @cindex arrays
5755 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
5756 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
5757 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
5758 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
5759 program.
5760
5761 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
5762 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
5763 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
5764 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
5765 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
5766 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
5767 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
5768 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
5769 example. If a program says
5770
5771 @smallexample
5772 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
5773 @end smallexample
5774
5775 @noindent
5776 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
5777
5778 @smallexample
5779 p *array@@len
5780 @end smallexample
5781
5782 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
5783 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
5784 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
5785 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
5786 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
5787
5788 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
5789 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
5790 The value need not be in memory:
5791 @smallexample
5792 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
5793 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5794 @end smallexample
5795
5796 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
5797 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
5798 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
5799 @smallexample
5800 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
5801 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5802 @end smallexample
5803
5804 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
5805 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
5806 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
5807 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
5808 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5809 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
5810 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
5811 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
5812 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
5813 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
5814
5815 @smallexample
5816 set $i = 0
5817 p dtab[$i++]->fv
5818 @key{RET}
5819 @key{RET}
5820 @dots{}
5821 @end smallexample
5822
5823 @node Output Formats
5824 @section Output Formats
5825
5826 @cindex formatted output
5827 @cindex output formats
5828 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
5829 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
5830 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
5831 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
5832 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
5833
5834 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
5835 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
5836 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
5837 letters supported are:
5838
5839 @table @code
5840 @item x
5841 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
5842 hexadecimal.
5843
5844 @item d
5845 Print as integer in signed decimal.
5846
5847 @item u
5848 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
5849
5850 @item o
5851 Print as integer in octal.
5852
5853 @item t
5854 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
5855 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
5856 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
5857 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
5858
5859 @item a
5860 @cindex unknown address, locating
5861 @cindex locate address
5862 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
5863 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
5864 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
5865
5866 @smallexample
5867 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
5868 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
5869 @end smallexample
5870
5871 @noindent
5872 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
5873 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
5874
5875 @item c
5876 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
5877 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
5878 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
5879 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
5880
5881 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
5882 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
5883 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
5884 data.
5885
5886 @item f
5887 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
5888 using typical floating point syntax.
5889
5890 @item s
5891 @cindex printing strings
5892 @cindex printing byte arrays
5893 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
5894 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
5895 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
5896 natural types.
5897
5898 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
5899 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
5900 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
5901 array.
5902 @end table
5903
5904 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
5905
5906 @smallexample
5907 p/x $pc
5908 @end smallexample
5909
5910 @noindent
5911 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
5912 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
5913
5914 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
5915 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
5916 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
5917
5918 @node Memory
5919 @section Examining Memory
5920
5921 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
5922 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
5923
5924 @cindex examining memory
5925 @table @code
5926 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
5927 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
5928 @itemx x @var{addr}
5929 @itemx x
5930 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
5931 @end table
5932
5933 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
5934 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
5935 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
5936 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
5937 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
5938
5939 @table @r
5940 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
5941 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
5942 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
5943 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
5944 @c 4.1.2.
5945
5946 @item @var{f}, the display format
5947 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
5948 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
5949 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
5950 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
5951 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
5952
5953 @item @var{u}, the unit size
5954 The unit size is any of
5955
5956 @table @code
5957 @item b
5958 Bytes.
5959 @item h
5960 Halfwords (two bytes).
5961 @item w
5962 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
5963 @item g
5964 Giant words (eight bytes).
5965 @end table
5966
5967 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
5968 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
5969 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
5970
5971 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
5972 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
5973 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
5974 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
5975 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
5976 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
5977 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
5978 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
5979 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
5980 a value from memory).
5981 @end table
5982
5983 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
5984 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
5985 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
5986 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
5987 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
5988
5989 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
5990 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
5991 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
5992 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
5993 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
5994
5995 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
5996 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
5997 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
5998 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
5999 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
6000 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
6001 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
6002 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
6003 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
6004
6005 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
6006 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
6007 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
6008 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
6009 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
6010 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
6011 for successive uses of @code{x}.
6012
6013 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
6014 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
6015 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
6016 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
6017 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
6018 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
6019 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
6020 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
6021 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
6022
6023 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
6024 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
6025 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
6026
6027 @cindex remote memory comparison
6028 @cindex verify remote memory image
6029 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
6030 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
6031 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
6032 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
6033 situations.
6034
6035 @table @code
6036 @kindex compare-sections
6037 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
6038 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
6039 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
6040 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
6041 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
6042 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
6043 remote request.
6044 @end table
6045
6046 @node Auto Display
6047 @section Automatic Display
6048 @cindex automatic display
6049 @cindex display of expressions
6050
6051 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
6052 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
6053 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
6054 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
6055 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
6056 The automatic display looks like this:
6057
6058 @smallexample
6059 2: foo = 38
6060 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
6061 @end smallexample
6062
6063 @noindent
6064 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
6065 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
6066 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
6067 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
6068 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
6069 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
6070
6071 @table @code
6072 @kindex display
6073 @item display @var{expr}
6074 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
6075 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
6076
6077 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
6078
6079 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
6080 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
6081 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
6082 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
6083 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
6084
6085 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
6086 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
6087 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
6088 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
6089 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6090 @end table
6091
6092 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
6093 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
6094 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6095
6096 @table @code
6097 @kindex delete display
6098 @kindex undisplay
6099 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
6100 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6101 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
6102
6103 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
6104 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
6105
6106 @kindex disable display
6107 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6108 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
6109 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
6110 enabled again later.
6111
6112 @kindex enable display
6113 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6114 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
6115 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
6116
6117 @item display
6118 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
6119 done when your program stops.
6120
6121 @kindex info display
6122 @item info display
6123 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
6124 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
6125 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
6126 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
6127 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
6128 @end table
6129
6130 @cindex display disabled out of scope
6131 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
6132 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
6133 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
6134 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
6135 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
6136 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
6137 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
6138 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
6139 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
6140 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
6141
6142 @node Print Settings
6143 @section Print Settings
6144
6145 @cindex format options
6146 @cindex print settings
6147 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
6148 and symbols are printed.
6149
6150 @noindent
6151 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
6152
6153 @table @code
6154 @kindex set print
6155 @item set print address
6156 @itemx set print address on
6157 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
6158 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
6159 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
6160 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
6161 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
6162 @code{set print address on}:
6163
6164 @smallexample
6165 @group
6166 (@value{GDBP}) f
6167 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
6168 at input.c:530
6169 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6170 @end group
6171 @end smallexample
6172
6173 @item set print address off
6174 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
6175 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6176
6177 @smallexample
6178 @group
6179 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6180 (@value{GDBP}) f
6181 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6182 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6183 @end group
6184 @end smallexample
6185
6186 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6187 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6188 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6189 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6190
6191 @kindex show print
6192 @item show print address
6193 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6194 @end table
6195
6196 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6197 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6198 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6199 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6200 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6201 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6202 it prints a symbolic address:
6203
6204 @table @code
6205 @item set print symbol-filename on
6206 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
6207 @cindex symbol, source file and line
6208 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6209 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6210
6211 @item set print symbol-filename off
6212 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6213 default.
6214
6215 @item show print symbol-filename
6216 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6217 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6218 @end table
6219
6220 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6221 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6222 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6223
6224 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6225 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6226
6227 @table @code
6228 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6229 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6230 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6231 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6232 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6233 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6234
6235 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
6236 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6237 symbolic address.
6238 @end table
6239
6240 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6241 @cindex pointer, finding referent
6242 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6243 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6244 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6245 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6246 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6247 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6248
6249 @smallexample
6250 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6251 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6252 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6253 @end smallexample
6254
6255 @quotation
6256 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6257 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6258 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6259 @end quotation
6260
6261 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6262
6263 @table @code
6264 @item set print array
6265 @itemx set print array on
6266 @cindex pretty print arrays
6267 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6268 but uses more space. The default is off.
6269
6270 @item set print array off
6271 Return to compressed format for arrays.
6272
6273 @item show print array
6274 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6275 arrays.
6276
6277 @cindex print array indexes
6278 @item set print array-indexes
6279 @itemx set print array-indexes on
6280 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6281 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6282 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6283
6284 @item set print array-indexes off
6285 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6286
6287 @item show print array-indexes
6288 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6289 arrays.
6290
6291 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6292 @cindex number of array elements to print
6293 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6294 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6295 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6296 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6297 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6298 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6299 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6300
6301 @item show print elements
6302 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6303 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6304
6305 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
6306 @cindex printing frame argument values
6307 @cindex print all frame argument values
6308 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
6309 @cindex do not print frame argument values
6310 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
6311 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
6312 values are:
6313
6314 @table @code
6315 @item all
6316 The values of all arguments are printed. This is the default.
6317
6318 @item scalars
6319 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
6320 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
6321 by @code{@dots{}}. Here is an example where only scalar arguments are shown:
6322
6323 @smallexample
6324 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
6325 at frame-args.c:23
6326 @end smallexample
6327
6328 @item none
6329 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
6330 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
6331
6332 @smallexample
6333 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
6334 at frame-args.c:23
6335 @end smallexample
6336 @end table
6337
6338 By default, all argument values are always printed. But this command
6339 can be useful in several cases. For instance, it can be used to reduce
6340 the amount of information printed in each frame, making the backtrace
6341 more readable. Also, this command can be used to improve performance
6342 when displaying Ada frames, because the computation of large arguments
6343 can sometimes be CPU-intensive, especiallly in large applications.
6344 Setting @code{print frame-arguments} to @code{scalars} or @code{none}
6345 avoids this computation, thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
6346
6347 @item show print frame-arguments
6348 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
6349
6350 @item set print repeats
6351 @cindex repeated array elements
6352 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6353 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6354 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6355 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6356 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6357 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6358 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6359
6360 @item show print repeats
6361 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6362 elements.
6363
6364 @item set print null-stop
6365 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6366 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6367 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6368 contain only short strings.
6369 The default is off.
6370
6371 @item show print null-stop
6372 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6373 @sc{null} character.
6374
6375 @item set print pretty on
6376 @cindex print structures in indented form
6377 @cindex indentation in structure display
6378 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6379 per line, like this:
6380
6381 @smallexample
6382 @group
6383 $1 = @{
6384 next = 0x0,
6385 flags = @{
6386 sweet = 1,
6387 sour = 1
6388 @},
6389 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6390 @}
6391 @end group
6392 @end smallexample
6393
6394 @item set print pretty off
6395 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6396
6397 @smallexample
6398 @group
6399 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6400 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6401 @end group
6402 @end smallexample
6403
6404 @noindent
6405 This is the default format.
6406
6407 @item show print pretty
6408 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6409
6410 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
6411 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6412 @cindex octal escapes in strings
6413 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6414 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6415 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6416 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6417 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6418
6419 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
6420 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6421 international character sets, and is the default.
6422
6423 @item show print sevenbit-strings
6424 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6425
6426 @item set print union on
6427 @cindex unions in structures, printing
6428 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6429 and other unions. This is the default setting.
6430
6431 @item set print union off
6432 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6433 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6434 instead.
6435
6436 @item show print union
6437 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6438 structures and other unions.
6439
6440 For example, given the declarations
6441
6442 @smallexample
6443 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6444 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6445 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6446 Bug_forms;
6447
6448 struct thing @{
6449 Species it;
6450 union @{
6451 Tree_forms tree;
6452 Bug_forms bug;
6453 @} form;
6454 @};
6455
6456 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6457 @end smallexample
6458
6459 @noindent
6460 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6461
6462 @smallexample
6463 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6464 @end smallexample
6465
6466 @noindent
6467 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6468
6469 @smallexample
6470 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6471 @end smallexample
6472
6473 @noindent
6474 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6475 and in Pascal.
6476 @end table
6477
6478 @need 1000
6479 @noindent
6480 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6481
6482 @table @code
6483 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6484 @item set print demangle
6485 @itemx set print demangle on
6486 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6487 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6488 linkage. The default is on.
6489
6490 @item show print demangle
6491 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6492
6493 @item set print asm-demangle
6494 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
6495 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6496 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
6497 The default is off.
6498
6499 @item show print asm-demangle
6500 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
6501 or demangled form.
6502
6503 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
6504 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
6505 @kindex set demangle-style
6506 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
6507 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
6508 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
6509
6510 @table @code
6511 @item auto
6512 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
6513
6514 @item gnu
6515 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
6516 This is the default.
6517
6518 @item hp
6519 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
6520
6521 @item lucid
6522 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
6523
6524 @item arm
6525 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
6526 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
6527 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
6528 require further enhancement to permit that.
6529
6530 @end table
6531 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
6532
6533 @item show demangle-style
6534 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
6535
6536 @item set print object
6537 @itemx set print object on
6538 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
6539 @cindex display derived types
6540 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
6541 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
6542 the virtual function table.
6543
6544 @item set print object off
6545 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
6546 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
6547
6548 @item show print object
6549 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
6550
6551 @item set print static-members
6552 @itemx set print static-members on
6553 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
6554 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
6555
6556 @item set print static-members off
6557 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
6558
6559 @item show print static-members
6560 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
6561
6562 @item set print pascal_static-members
6563 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
6564 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
6565 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
6566 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
6567
6568 @item set print pascal_static-members off
6569 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
6570
6571 @item show print pascal_static-members
6572 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
6573
6574 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
6575 @item set print vtbl
6576 @itemx set print vtbl on
6577 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
6578 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
6579 @cindex VTBL display
6580 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
6581 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6582 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6583
6584 @item set print vtbl off
6585 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
6586
6587 @item show print vtbl
6588 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
6589 @end table
6590
6591 @node Value History
6592 @section Value History
6593
6594 @cindex value history
6595 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
6596 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
6597 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
6598 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
6599 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
6600 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
6601 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
6602 symbol table.
6603
6604 @cindex @code{$}
6605 @cindex @code{$$}
6606 @cindex history number
6607 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
6608 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
6609 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
6610 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
6611 history number.
6612
6613 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
6614 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
6615 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
6616 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
6617 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
6618 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
6619 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
6620
6621 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
6622 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
6623
6624 @smallexample
6625 p *$
6626 @end smallexample
6627
6628 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
6629 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
6630
6631 @smallexample
6632 p *$.next
6633 @end smallexample
6634
6635 @noindent
6636 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
6637 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
6638
6639 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
6640 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
6641
6642 @smallexample
6643 print x
6644 set x=5
6645 @end smallexample
6646
6647 @noindent
6648 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
6649 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
6650
6651 @table @code
6652 @kindex show values
6653 @item show values
6654 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
6655 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
6656 values} does not change the history.
6657
6658 @item show values @var{n}
6659 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
6660
6661 @item show values +
6662 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
6663 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
6664 @end table
6665
6666 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
6667 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
6668
6669 @node Convenience Vars
6670 @section Convenience Variables
6671
6672 @cindex convenience variables
6673 @cindex user-defined variables
6674 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
6675 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
6676 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
6677 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
6678 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
6679
6680 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
6681 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
6682 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6683 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
6684 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
6685
6686 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
6687 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
6688 For example:
6689
6690 @smallexample
6691 set $foo = *object_ptr
6692 @end smallexample
6693
6694 @noindent
6695 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
6696 @code{object_ptr}.
6697
6698 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
6699 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
6700 value with another assignment at any time.
6701
6702 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
6703 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
6704 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
6705 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
6706
6707 @table @code
6708 @kindex show convenience
6709 @cindex show all user variables
6710 @item show convenience
6711 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
6712 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
6713
6714 @kindex init-if-undefined
6715 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
6716 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
6717 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
6718 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
6719 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
6720 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
6721 override default values used in a command script.
6722
6723 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
6724 any side-effects do not occur.
6725 @end table
6726
6727 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
6728 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
6729 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
6730
6731 @smallexample
6732 set $i = 0
6733 print bar[$i++]->contents
6734 @end smallexample
6735
6736 @noindent
6737 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
6738
6739 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
6740 values likely to be useful.
6741
6742 @table @code
6743 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
6744 @item $_
6745 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
6746 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
6747 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
6748 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
6749 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
6750 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
6751 to the type of @code{$__}.
6752
6753 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
6754 @item $__
6755 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
6756 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
6757 to match the format in which the data was printed.
6758
6759 @item $_exitcode
6760 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
6761 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
6762 the program being debugged terminates.
6763 @end table
6764
6765 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
6766 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
6767 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
6768
6769 @node Registers
6770 @section Registers
6771
6772 @cindex registers
6773 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
6774 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
6775 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
6776 your machine.
6777
6778 @table @code
6779 @kindex info registers
6780 @item info registers
6781 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
6782 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6783
6784 @kindex info all-registers
6785 @cindex floating point registers
6786 @item info all-registers
6787 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
6788 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6789
6790 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
6791 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
6792 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
6793 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
6794 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
6795 @end table
6796
6797 @cindex stack pointer register
6798 @cindex program counter register
6799 @cindex process status register
6800 @cindex frame pointer register
6801 @cindex standard registers
6802 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
6803 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
6804 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
6805 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
6806 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
6807 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
6808 register that contains the processor status. For example,
6809 you could print the program counter in hex with
6810
6811 @smallexample
6812 p/x $pc
6813 @end smallexample
6814
6815 @noindent
6816 or print the instruction to be executed next with
6817
6818 @smallexample
6819 x/i $pc
6820 @end smallexample
6821
6822 @noindent
6823 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
6824 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
6825 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
6826 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
6827 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
6828 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
6829 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
6830
6831 @smallexample
6832 set $sp += 4
6833 @end smallexample
6834
6835 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
6836 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
6837 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
6838 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
6839 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
6840 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
6841 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
6842
6843 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
6844 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
6845 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
6846 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
6847 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
6848 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
6849 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
6850
6851 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
6852 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
6853 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
6854 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
6855 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
6856 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
6857 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
6858 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
6859 prints the data in both formats.
6860
6861 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
6862 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
6863 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
6864 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
6865 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
6866 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
6867 registers in @code{struct} notation:
6868
6869 @smallexample
6870 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
6871 $1 = @{
6872 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
6873 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
6874 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
6875 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
6876 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
6877 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
6878 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
6879 @}
6880 @end smallexample
6881
6882 @noindent
6883 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
6884 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
6885 value to a @code{struct} member:
6886
6887 @smallexample
6888 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
6889 @end smallexample
6890
6891 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
6892 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
6893 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
6894 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
6895 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
6896 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
6897
6898 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
6899 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
6900 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
6901 frame makes no difference.
6902
6903 @node Floating Point Hardware
6904 @section Floating Point Hardware
6905 @cindex floating point
6906
6907 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
6908 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
6909
6910 @table @code
6911 @kindex info float
6912 @item info float
6913 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
6914 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
6915 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
6916 the ARM and x86 machines.
6917 @end table
6918
6919 @node Vector Unit
6920 @section Vector Unit
6921 @cindex vector unit
6922
6923 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
6924 more information about the status of the vector unit.
6925
6926 @table @code
6927 @kindex info vector
6928 @item info vector
6929 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
6930 layout vary depending on the hardware.
6931 @end table
6932
6933 @node OS Information
6934 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
6935 @cindex OS information
6936
6937 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
6938 you debug your program.
6939
6940 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
6941 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
6942 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
6943 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
6944 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
6945 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
6946 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
6947 structure.
6948
6949 @table @code
6950 @item info udot
6951 @kindex info udot
6952 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
6953 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
6954 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
6955 the @code{examine} command.
6956 @end table
6957
6958 @cindex auxiliary vector
6959 @cindex vector, auxiliary
6960 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
6961 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
6962 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
6963 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
6964 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
6965 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
6966 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
6967 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
6968 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
6969 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
6970 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
6971
6972 @table @code
6973 @kindex info auxv
6974 @item info auxv
6975 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
6976 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
6977 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
6978 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
6979 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
6980 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
6981 an unrecognized tag.
6982 @end table
6983
6984
6985 @node Memory Region Attributes
6986 @section Memory Region Attributes
6987 @cindex memory region attributes
6988
6989 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
6990 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
6991 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
6992 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
6993 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
6994 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
6995 user can override the fetched regions.
6996
6997 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
6998 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
6999 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
7000 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
7001 all memory.
7002
7003 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
7004 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
7005
7006 @table @code
7007 @kindex mem
7008 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
7009 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
7010 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
7011 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
7012 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
7013 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
7014
7015 @item mem auto
7016 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
7017 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
7018
7019 @kindex delete mem
7020 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7021 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
7022 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
7023
7024 @kindex disable mem
7025 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7026 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7027 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
7028 It may be enabled again later.
7029
7030 @kindex enable mem
7031 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7032 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7033
7034 @kindex info mem
7035 @item info mem
7036 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
7037 for each region:
7038
7039 @table @emph
7040 @item Memory Region Number
7041 @item Enabled or Disabled.
7042 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
7043 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
7044
7045 @item Lo Address
7046 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
7047
7048 @item Hi Address
7049 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
7050
7051 @item Attributes
7052 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
7053 @end table
7054 @end table
7055
7056
7057 @subsection Attributes
7058
7059 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
7060 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
7061 write accesses to a memory region.
7062
7063 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
7064 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
7065 etc.@: from accessing memory.
7066
7067 @table @code
7068 @item ro
7069 Memory is read only.
7070 @item wo
7071 Memory is write only.
7072 @item rw
7073 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
7074 @end table
7075
7076 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
7077 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
7078 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
7079 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
7080 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
7081
7082 @table @code
7083 @item 8
7084 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
7085 @item 16
7086 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
7087 @item 32
7088 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
7089 @item 64
7090 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
7091 @end table
7092
7093 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
7094 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7095 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
7096 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
7097 @c
7098 @c @table @code
7099 @c @item hwbreak
7100 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
7101 @c @item swbreak (default)
7102 @c @end table
7103
7104 @subsubsection Data Cache
7105 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
7106 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
7107 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
7108 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
7109 registers.
7110
7111 @table @code
7112 @item cache
7113 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
7114 @item nocache
7115 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
7116 @end table
7117
7118 @subsection Memory Access Checking
7119 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
7120 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
7121 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
7122 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
7123
7124 @table @code
7125 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
7126 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
7127 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
7128 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
7129 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
7130 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
7131 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
7132 The default value is @code{on}.
7133 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
7134 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
7135 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
7136 @end table
7137
7138
7139 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
7140 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7141 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
7142 @c
7143 @c @table @code
7144 @c @item verify
7145 @c @item noverify (default)
7146 @c @end table
7147
7148 @node Dump/Restore Files
7149 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
7150 @cindex dump/restore files
7151 @cindex append data to a file
7152 @cindex dump data to a file
7153 @cindex restore data from a file
7154
7155 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
7156 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
7157 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
7158 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
7159 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
7160 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
7161 files.
7162
7163 @table @code
7164
7165 @kindex dump
7166 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7167 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7168 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7169 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
7170
7171 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
7172 @table @code
7173 @item binary
7174 Raw binary form.
7175 @item ihex
7176 Intel hex format.
7177 @item srec
7178 Motorola S-record format.
7179 @item tekhex
7180 Tektronix Hex format.
7181 @end table
7182
7183 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
7184 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
7185 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
7186 form.
7187
7188 @kindex append
7189 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7190 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7191 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7192 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
7193 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
7194
7195 @kindex restore
7196 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
7197 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
7198 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
7199 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
7200 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
7201
7202 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
7203 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
7204 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
7205 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
7206 from that location.
7207
7208 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
7209 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
7210 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
7211 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
7212
7213 @end table
7214
7215 @node Core File Generation
7216 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
7217 @cindex dump core from inferior
7218
7219 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
7220 image of a running process and its process status (register values
7221 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
7222 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
7223 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
7224 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
7225 the post-mortem debugging mode.
7226
7227 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
7228 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
7229 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
7230
7231 @table @code
7232 @kindex gcore
7233 @kindex generate-core-file
7234 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
7235 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
7236 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
7237 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
7238 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
7239 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
7240
7241 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7242 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7243 @end table
7244
7245 @node Character Sets
7246 @section Character Sets
7247 @cindex character sets
7248 @cindex charset
7249 @cindex translating between character sets
7250 @cindex host character set
7251 @cindex target character set
7252
7253 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7254 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7255 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7256 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7257 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7258 @dfn{target character set}.
7259
7260 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7261 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7262 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7263 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7264 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7265 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7266 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7267 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7268 character and string literals in expressions.
7269
7270 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7271 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7272 target-charset} command, described below.
7273
7274 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7275 support:
7276
7277 @table @code
7278 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
7279 @kindex set target-charset
7280 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7281 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7282 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7283 list the target character sets it supports.
7284 @end table
7285
7286 @table @code
7287 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
7288 @kindex set host-charset
7289 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7290
7291 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7292 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7293 @code{set host-charset} command.
7294
7295 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7296 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7297 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7298 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7299 list the host character sets it supports.
7300
7301 @item set charset @var{charset}
7302 @kindex set charset
7303 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7304 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7305 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7306 for both host and target.
7307
7308
7309 @item show charset
7310 @kindex show charset
7311 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7312
7313 @itemx show host-charset
7314 @kindex show host-charset
7315 Show the name of the current host charset.
7316
7317 @itemx show target-charset
7318 @kindex show target-charset
7319 Show the name of the current target charset.
7320
7321 @end table
7322
7323 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7324 sets:
7325
7326 @table @code
7327
7328 @item ASCII
7329 @cindex ASCII character set
7330 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7331 character set.
7332
7333 @item ISO-8859-1
7334 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7335 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7336 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7337 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7338 this as its host character set.
7339
7340 @item EBCDIC-US
7341 @itemx IBM1047
7342 @cindex EBCDIC character set
7343 @cindex IBM1047 character set
7344 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7345 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7346 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7347
7348 @end table
7349
7350 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7351 @value{GDBN} is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7352 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7353
7354 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7355 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7356 @file{charset-test.c}:
7357
7358 @smallexample
7359 #include <stdio.h>
7360
7361 char ascii_hello[]
7362 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7363 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7364 char ibm1047_hello[]
7365 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7366 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7367
7368 main ()
7369 @{
7370 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7371 @}
7372 @end smallexample
7373
7374 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7375 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7376 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7377
7378 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7379
7380 @smallexample
7381 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7382 $ gdb -nw charset-test
7383 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7384 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7385 @dots{}
7386 (@value{GDBP})
7387 @end smallexample
7388
7389 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7390 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7391 strings:
7392
7393 @smallexample
7394 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7395 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7396 (@value{GDBP})
7397 @end smallexample
7398
7399 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7400 initial character set:
7401 @smallexample
7402 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7403 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7404 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7405 (@value{GDBP})
7406 @end smallexample
7407
7408 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7409 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7410 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7411 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7412 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7413
7414 @smallexample
7415 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7416 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7417 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7418 $2 = 72 'H'
7419 (@value{GDBP})
7420 @end smallexample
7421
7422 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7423 literals you use in expressions:
7424
7425 @smallexample
7426 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7427 $3 = 43 '+'
7428 (@value{GDBP})
7429 @end smallexample
7430
7431 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7432 character.
7433
7434 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7435 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7436 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7437
7438 @smallexample
7439 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7440 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7441 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7442 $5 = 200 '\310'
7443 (@value{GDBP})
7444 @end smallexample
7445
7446 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7447 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7448
7449 @smallexample
7450 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7451 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7452 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7453 @end smallexample
7454
7455 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7456 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7457 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7458 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7459 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7460
7461 @smallexample
7462 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7463 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7464 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7465 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7466 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7467 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7468 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7469 $7 = 72 '\110'
7470 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7471 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7472 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7473 $9 = 200 'H'
7474 (@value{GDBP})
7475 @end smallexample
7476
7477 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7478 string literals you use in expressions:
7479
7480 @smallexample
7481 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7482 $10 = 78 '+'
7483 (@value{GDBP})
7484 @end smallexample
7485
7486 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7487 character.
7488
7489 @node Caching Remote Data
7490 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7491 @cindex caching data of remote targets
7492
7493 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7494 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
7495 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7496 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
7497 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
7498 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
7499 volatile registers are in use.
7500
7501 @table @code
7502 @kindex set remotecache
7503 @item set remotecache on
7504 @itemx set remotecache off
7505 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
7506 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
7507
7508 @kindex show remotecache
7509 @item show remotecache
7510 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
7511
7512 @kindex info dcache
7513 @item info dcache
7514 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
7515 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
7516 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
7517 state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
7518 the data cache operation.
7519 @end table
7520
7521
7522 @node Macros
7523 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
7524
7525 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
7526 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
7527 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
7528 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
7529 where it was defined.
7530
7531 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
7532 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
7533 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
7534 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
7535
7536 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
7537 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
7538 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
7539 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
7540 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
7541 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
7542 see @ref{List}.
7543
7544 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
7545 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
7546 variable-arity macros.
7547
7548 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
7549 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
7550 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
7551
7552 @table @code
7553
7554 @kindex macro expand
7555 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
7556 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
7557 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
7558 @item macro expand @var{expression}
7559 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
7560 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
7561 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
7562 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
7563 it can be any string of tokens.
7564
7565 @kindex macro exp1
7566 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
7567 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
7568 @cindex expand macro once
7569 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
7570 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
7571 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
7572 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
7573 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
7574 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
7575 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
7576 can be any string of tokens.
7577
7578 @kindex info macro
7579 @cindex macro definition, showing
7580 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
7581 @item info macro @var{macro}
7582 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
7583 source location where that definition was established.
7584
7585 @kindex macro define
7586 @cindex user-defined macros
7587 @cindex defining macros interactively
7588 @cindex macros, user-defined
7589 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
7590 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
7591 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
7592 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
7593 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
7594 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
7595 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
7596 given in @var{arglist}.
7597
7598 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
7599 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
7600 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
7601 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
7602 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
7603
7604 @kindex macro undef
7605 @item macro undef @var{macro}
7606 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
7607 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
7608 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
7609 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
7610 debugged.
7611
7612 @kindex macro list
7613 @item macro list
7614 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} List all the macros
7615 defined using the @code{macro define} command.
7616 @end table
7617
7618 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
7619 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
7620 show our source files:
7621
7622 @smallexample
7623 $ cat sample.c
7624 #include <stdio.h>
7625 #include "sample.h"
7626
7627 #define M 42
7628 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7629
7630 main ()
7631 @{
7632 #define N 28
7633 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7634 #undef N
7635 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7636 #define N 1729
7637 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7638 @}
7639 $ cat sample.h
7640 #define Q <
7641 $
7642 @end smallexample
7643
7644 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
7645 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
7646 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
7647 information.
7648
7649 @smallexample
7650 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
7651 $
7652 @end smallexample
7653
7654 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
7655
7656 @smallexample
7657 $ gdb -nw sample
7658 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
7659 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7660 GDB is free software, @dots{}
7661 (@value{GDBP})
7662 @end smallexample
7663
7664 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
7665 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
7666 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
7667
7668 @smallexample
7669 (@value{GDBP}) list main
7670 3
7671 4 #define M 42
7672 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7673 6
7674 7 main ()
7675 8 @{
7676 9 #define N 28
7677 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7678 11 #undef N
7679 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7680 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
7681 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
7682 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7683 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
7684 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
7685 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
7686 #define Q <
7687 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
7688 expands to: (42 + 1)
7689 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
7690 expands to: once (M + 1)
7691 (@value{GDBP})
7692 @end smallexample
7693
7694 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
7695 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
7696 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
7697 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
7698
7699 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
7700 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
7701
7702 @smallexample
7703 (@value{GDBP}) break main
7704 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
7705 (@value{GDBP}) run
7706 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
7707
7708 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
7709 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7710 (@value{GDBP})
7711 @end smallexample
7712
7713 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
7714
7715 @smallexample
7716 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7717 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
7718 #define N 28
7719 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7720 expands to: 28 < 42
7721 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7722 $1 = 1
7723 (@value{GDBP})
7724 @end smallexample
7725
7726 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
7727 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
7728 thereof) in force at each point:
7729
7730 @smallexample
7731 (@value{GDBP}) next
7732 Hello, world!
7733 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7734 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7735 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
7736 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
7737 (@value{GDBP}) next
7738 We're so creative.
7739 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7740 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7741 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
7742 #define N 1729
7743 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7744 expands to: 1729 < 42
7745 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7746 $2 = 0
7747 (@value{GDBP})
7748 @end smallexample
7749
7750
7751 @node Tracepoints
7752 @chapter Tracepoints
7753 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
7754 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
7755
7756 @cindex tracepoints
7757 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
7758 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
7759 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
7760 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
7761 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
7762 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
7763 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
7764
7765 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
7766 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
7767 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
7768 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
7769 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
7770 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
7771 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
7772 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
7773 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
7774 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
7775 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
7776
7777 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
7778 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
7779 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
7780 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
7781 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
7782 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
7783 Packets}.
7784
7785 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
7786
7787 @menu
7788 * Set Tracepoints::
7789 * Analyze Collected Data::
7790 * Tracepoint Variables::
7791 @end menu
7792
7793 @node Set Tracepoints
7794 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
7795
7796 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
7797 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
7798 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
7799 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
7800 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
7801 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
7802 work on.
7803
7804 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
7805 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
7806 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
7807 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
7808 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
7809 tracepoint was hit.
7810
7811 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
7812 conditions and actions.
7813
7814 @menu
7815 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
7816 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
7817 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
7818 * Tracepoint Actions::
7819 * Listing Tracepoints::
7820 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
7821 @end menu
7822
7823 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
7824 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
7825
7826 @table @code
7827 @cindex set tracepoint
7828 @kindex trace
7829 @item trace
7830 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
7831 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
7832 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
7833 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
7834 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
7835 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
7836 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
7837 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
7838 running.
7839
7840 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
7841
7842 @smallexample
7843 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
7844
7845 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
7846
7847 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
7848
7849 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
7850
7851 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
7852 @end smallexample
7853
7854 @noindent
7855 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
7856
7857 @vindex $tpnum
7858 @cindex last tracepoint number
7859 @cindex recent tracepoint number
7860 @cindex tracepoint number
7861 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
7862 of the most recently set tracepoint.
7863
7864 @kindex delete tracepoint
7865 @cindex tracepoint deletion
7866 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7867 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
7868 default is to delete all tracepoints.
7869
7870 Examples:
7871
7872 @smallexample
7873 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
7874
7875 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
7876 @end smallexample
7877
7878 @noindent
7879 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
7880 @end table
7881
7882 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7883 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7884
7885 @table @code
7886 @kindex disable tracepoint
7887 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7888 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
7889 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
7890 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
7891 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
7892
7893 @kindex enable tracepoint
7894 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7895 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
7896 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
7897 run.
7898 @end table
7899
7900 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
7901 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
7902
7903 @table @code
7904 @kindex passcount
7905 @cindex tracepoint pass count
7906 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
7907 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
7908 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
7909 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
7910 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
7911 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
7912 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
7913 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
7914 user.
7915
7916 Examples:
7917
7918 @smallexample
7919 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
7920 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
7921
7922 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
7923 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
7924 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7925 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
7926 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
7927 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
7928 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
7929 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
7930 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
7931 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
7932 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
7933 @end smallexample
7934 @end table
7935
7936 @node Tracepoint Actions
7937 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
7938
7939 @table @code
7940 @kindex actions
7941 @cindex tracepoint actions
7942 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7943 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
7944 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
7945 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
7946 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
7947 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
7948 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
7949 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
7950 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
7951 @code{while-stepping}.
7952
7953 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
7954 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
7955 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
7956
7957 @smallexample
7958 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
7959
7960 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
7961
7962 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
7963 @end smallexample
7964
7965 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
7966 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
7967 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
7968 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
7969 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
7970 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
7971 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
7972 @code{end} command.
7973
7974 @smallexample
7975 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7976 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7977 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
7978 > collect bar,baz
7979 > collect $regs
7980 > while-stepping 12
7981 > collect $fp, $sp
7982 > end
7983 end
7984 @end smallexample
7985
7986 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
7987 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
7988 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
7989 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
7990 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
7991 special arguments are supported:
7992
7993 @table @code
7994 @item $regs
7995 collect all registers
7996
7997 @item $args
7998 collect all function arguments
7999
8000 @item $locals
8001 collect all local variables.
8002 @end table
8003
8004 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
8005 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
8006 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
8007
8008 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
8009 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
8010
8011 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
8012 @item while-stepping @var{n}
8013 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
8014 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
8015 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
8016 its own @code{end} command):
8017
8018 @smallexample
8019 > while-stepping 12
8020 > collect $regs, myglobal
8021 > end
8022 >
8023 @end smallexample
8024
8025 @noindent
8026 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
8027 @code{stepping}.
8028 @end table
8029
8030 @node Listing Tracepoints
8031 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
8032
8033 @table @code
8034 @kindex info tracepoints
8035 @kindex info tp
8036 @cindex information about tracepoints
8037 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8038 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
8039 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
8040 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
8041 shown:
8042
8043 @itemize @bullet
8044 @item
8045 its number
8046 @item
8047 whether it is enabled or disabled
8048 @item
8049 its address
8050 @item
8051 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
8052 @item
8053 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
8054 @item
8055 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
8056 @item
8057 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
8058 @end itemize
8059
8060 @smallexample
8061 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
8062 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
8063 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
8064 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
8065 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
8066 (@value{GDBP})
8067 @end smallexample
8068
8069 @noindent
8070 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
8071 @end table
8072
8073 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8074 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8075
8076 @table @code
8077 @kindex tstart
8078 @cindex start a new trace experiment
8079 @cindex collected data discarded
8080 @item tstart
8081 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
8082 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
8083 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
8084 experiment.
8085
8086 @kindex tstop
8087 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
8088 @item tstop
8089 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
8090 stops collecting data.
8091
8092 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
8093 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
8094 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
8095
8096 @kindex tstatus
8097 @cindex status of trace data collection
8098 @cindex trace experiment, status of
8099 @item tstatus
8100 This command displays the status of the current trace data
8101 collection.
8102 @end table
8103
8104 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
8105
8106 @smallexample
8107 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
8108 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8109 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
8110 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
8111 > while-stepping 11
8112 > collect $regs
8113 > end
8114 > end
8115 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8116 [time passes @dots{}]
8117 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
8118 @end smallexample
8119
8120
8121 @node Analyze Collected Data
8122 @section Using the Collected Data
8123
8124 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
8125 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
8126 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
8127 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
8128 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
8129 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
8130 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
8131 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
8132 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
8133 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
8134 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
8135 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
8136 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
8137 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
8138 the buffer will fail.
8139
8140 @menu
8141 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
8142 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
8143 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
8144 @end menu
8145
8146 @node tfind
8147 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
8148
8149 @kindex tfind
8150 @cindex select trace snapshot
8151 @cindex find trace snapshot
8152 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
8153 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
8154 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
8155 snapshot is selected.
8156
8157 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
8158
8159 @table @code
8160 @item tfind start
8161 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
8162 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
8163
8164 @item tfind none
8165 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
8166
8167 @item tfind end
8168 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
8169
8170 @item tfind
8171 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
8172
8173 @item tfind -
8174 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
8175 retracing earlier steps.
8176
8177 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
8178 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
8179 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
8180 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
8181 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
8182
8183 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
8184 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
8185 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
8186 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
8187 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
8188
8189 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8190 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
8191 addresses.
8192
8193 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8194 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
8195 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
8196
8197 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
8198 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
8199 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
8200 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
8201 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
8202 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
8203 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
8204 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
8205 @end table
8206
8207 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
8208 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
8209 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
8210 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
8211 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
8212 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
8213 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
8214 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
8215 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
8216 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
8217 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
8218 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
8219 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
8220 tracepoint as the current one.
8221
8222 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
8223 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
8224 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
8225 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
8226 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
8227
8228 @smallexample
8229 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8230 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8231 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
8232 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
8233 > tfind
8234 > end
8235
8236 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
8237 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
8238 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
8239 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
8240 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
8241 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
8242 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
8243 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
8244 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
8245 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
8246 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
8247 @end smallexample
8248
8249 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
8250 the buffer:
8251
8252 @smallexample
8253 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8254 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8255 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
8256 > tfind line
8257 > end
8258
8259 Frame 0, X = 1
8260 Frame 7, X = 2
8261 Frame 13, X = 255
8262 @end smallexample
8263
8264 @node tdump
8265 @subsection @code{tdump}
8266 @kindex tdump
8267 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
8268 @cindex tracepoint data, display
8269
8270 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
8271 the current trace snapshot.
8272
8273 @smallexample
8274 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
8275 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8276 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
8277 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
8278 > end
8279
8280 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8281
8282 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
8283 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
8284 at gdb_test.c:444
8285 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
8286
8287 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8288 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8289 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8290 d1 0x18 24
8291 d2 0x80 128
8292 d3 0x33 51
8293 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8294 d5 0x22 34
8295 d6 0xe0 224
8296 d7 0x380035 3670069
8297 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8298 a1 0x3000668 50333288
8299 a2 0x100 256
8300 a3 0x322000 3284992
8301 a4 0x3000698 50333336
8302 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8303 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8304 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8305 ps 0x0 0
8306 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8307 fpcontrol 0x0 0
8308 fpstatus 0x0 0
8309 fpiaddr 0x0 0
8310 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
8311 p1 = (void *) 0x11
8312 p2 = (void *) 0x22
8313 p3 = (void *) 0x33
8314 p4 = (void *) 0x44
8315 p5 = (void *) 0x55
8316 p6 = (void *) 0x66
8317 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
8318
8319 (@value{GDBP})
8320 @end smallexample
8321
8322 @node save-tracepoints
8323 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
8324 @kindex save-tracepoints
8325 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
8326
8327 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
8328 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
8329 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
8330 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
8331 Files}).
8332
8333 @node Tracepoint Variables
8334 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
8335 @cindex tracepoint variables
8336 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
8337
8338 @table @code
8339 @vindex $trace_frame
8340 @item (int) $trace_frame
8341 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
8342 snapshot is selected.
8343
8344 @vindex $tracepoint
8345 @item (int) $tracepoint
8346 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
8347
8348 @vindex $trace_line
8349 @item (int) $trace_line
8350 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
8351
8352 @vindex $trace_file
8353 @item (char []) $trace_file
8354 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
8355
8356 @vindex $trace_func
8357 @item (char []) $trace_func
8358 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
8359 @end table
8360
8361 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
8362 use @code{output} instead.
8363
8364 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
8365 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
8366 data.
8367
8368 @smallexample
8369 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8370
8371 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
8372 > output $trace_file
8373 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
8374 > tfind
8375 > end
8376 @end smallexample
8377
8378 @node Overlays
8379 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
8380 @cindex overlays
8381
8382 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
8383 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
8384 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
8385 use overlays.
8386
8387 @menu
8388 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
8389 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
8390 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
8391 mapped by asking the inferior.
8392 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
8393 @end menu
8394
8395 @node How Overlays Work
8396 @section How Overlays Work
8397 @cindex mapped overlays
8398 @cindex unmapped overlays
8399 @cindex load address, overlay's
8400 @cindex mapped address
8401 @cindex overlay area
8402
8403 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
8404 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
8405 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
8406 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
8407 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
8408
8409 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
8410 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
8411 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
8412 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
8413 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
8414 largest overlay as well.
8415
8416 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
8417 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
8418 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
8419 there.
8420
8421 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
8422 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
8423 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
8424
8425 @smallexample
8426 @group
8427 Data Instruction Larger
8428 Address Space Address Space Address Space
8429 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
8430 | | | | | |
8431 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
8432 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
8433 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
8434 | and heap | | | | | |
8435 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
8436 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
8437 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
8438 | | | | | |
8439 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
8440 address | | | | | |
8441 | overlay | <-' | | |
8442 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
8443 | | <---. | | load address
8444 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
8445 | | | |
8446 +-----------+ | |
8447 +-----------+
8448 | |
8449 +-----------+
8450
8451 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
8452 @end group
8453 @end smallexample
8454
8455 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
8456 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
8457 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
8458 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
8459 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
8460 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
8461 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
8462 program and the overlay area.
8463
8464 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
8465 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
8466 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
8467 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
8468 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
8469 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
8470 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
8471
8472 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
8473 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
8474 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
8475
8476 @itemize @bullet
8477
8478 @item
8479 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
8480 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
8481 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
8482 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
8483
8484 @item
8485 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
8486 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
8487 your program's performance.
8488
8489 @item
8490 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
8491 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
8492 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
8493 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
8494 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
8495 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
8496 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
8497
8498 @item
8499 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
8500 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
8501 instruction and data spaces.
8502
8503 @end itemize
8504
8505 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
8506 improved in many ways:
8507
8508 @itemize @bullet
8509
8510 @item
8511 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
8512 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
8513 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
8514 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
8515 area in the usual way.
8516
8517 @item
8518 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
8519 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
8520
8521 @item
8522 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
8523 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
8524 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
8525 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
8526 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
8527 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
8528 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
8529
8530 @end itemize
8531
8532
8533 @node Overlay Commands
8534 @section Overlay Commands
8535
8536 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
8537 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
8538 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
8539 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
8540 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
8541 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
8542
8543 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
8544 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
8545
8546 @table @code
8547 @item overlay off
8548 @kindex overlay
8549 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
8550 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
8551 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
8552 overlay support is disabled.
8553
8554 @item overlay manual
8555 @cindex manual overlay debugging
8556 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8557 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
8558 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
8559 commands described below.
8560
8561 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
8562 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
8563 @cindex map an overlay
8564 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
8565 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
8566 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
8567 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
8568 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
8569 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
8570
8571 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
8572 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
8573 @cindex unmap an overlay
8574 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
8575 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
8576 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
8577 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
8578
8579 @item overlay auto
8580 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8581 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
8582 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
8583 Overlay Debugging}.
8584
8585 @item overlay load-target
8586 @itemx overlay load
8587 @cindex reloading the overlay table
8588 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
8589 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
8590 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
8591 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
8592 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
8593
8594 @item overlay list-overlays
8595 @itemx overlay list
8596 @cindex listing mapped overlays
8597 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
8598 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
8599
8600 @end table
8601
8602 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
8603 of the function the address falls in:
8604
8605 @smallexample
8606 (@value{GDBP}) print main
8607 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
8608 @end smallexample
8609 @noindent
8610 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
8611 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
8612 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
8613 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
8614
8615 @smallexample
8616 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8617 No sections are mapped.
8618 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8619 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
8620 @end smallexample
8621 @noindent
8622 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
8623 name normally:
8624
8625 @smallexample
8626 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8627 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
8628 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
8629 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8630 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
8631 @end smallexample
8632
8633 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
8634 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
8635 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
8636 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
8637 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
8638
8639 @itemize @bullet
8640 @item
8641 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
8642 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
8643 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
8644 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
8645 @item
8646 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
8647 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
8648 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
8649 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
8650 breakpoints properly.
8651 @end itemize
8652
8653
8654 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
8655 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
8656 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
8657
8658 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
8659 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
8660 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
8661 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
8662 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
8663 current state of the overlays.
8664
8665 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
8666 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
8667
8668 @table @asis
8669
8670 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
8671 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
8672
8673 @smallexample
8674 struct
8675 @{
8676 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
8677 unsigned long vma;
8678
8679 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
8680 unsigned long size;
8681
8682 /* The overlay's load address. */
8683 unsigned long lma;
8684
8685 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
8686 zero otherwise. */
8687 unsigned long mapped;
8688 @}
8689 @end smallexample
8690
8691 @item @code{_novlys}:
8692 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
8693 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
8694
8695 @end table
8696
8697 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
8698 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
8699 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
8700 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
8701 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
8702 currently mapped.
8703
8704 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
8705 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
8706 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
8707 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
8708 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
8709 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
8710 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
8711 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
8712 are not being executed.
8713
8714 @node Overlay Sample Program
8715 @section Overlay Sample Program
8716 @cindex overlay example program
8717
8718 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
8719 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
8720 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
8721 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
8722 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
8723 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
8724 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
8725
8726 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
8727 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
8728 suite. The program consists of the following files from
8729 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
8730
8731 @table @file
8732 @item overlays.c
8733 The main program file.
8734 @item ovlymgr.c
8735 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
8736 @item foo.c
8737 @itemx bar.c
8738 @itemx baz.c
8739 @itemx grbx.c
8740 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
8741 @item d10v.ld
8742 @itemx m32r.ld
8743 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
8744 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
8745 @end table
8746
8747 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
8748 cross-compiler like this:
8749
8750 @smallexample
8751 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
8752 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
8753 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
8754 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
8755 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
8756 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
8757 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
8758 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
8759 @end smallexample
8760
8761 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
8762 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
8763 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
8764
8765
8766 @node Languages
8767 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
8768 @cindex languages
8769
8770 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
8771 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
8772 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
8773 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
8774 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
8775 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
8776
8777 @cindex working language
8778 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
8779 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
8780 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
8781 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
8782 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
8783 language}.
8784
8785 @menu
8786 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
8787 * Show:: Displaying the language
8788 * Checks:: Type and range checks
8789 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
8790 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
8791 @end menu
8792
8793 @node Setting
8794 @section Switching Between Source Languages
8795
8796 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
8797 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
8798 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
8799 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
8800 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
8801 are printed, etc.
8802
8803 In addition to the working language, every source file that
8804 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
8805 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
8806 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
8807 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
8808 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
8809 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
8810 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
8811 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
8812 Displaying the Language}.
8813
8814 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
8815 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
8816 another language. In that case, make the
8817 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
8818 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
8819 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
8820
8821 @menu
8822 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
8823 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
8824 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8825 @end menu
8826
8827 @node Filenames
8828 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
8829
8830 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
8831 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
8832
8833 @table @file
8834 @item .ada
8835 @itemx .ads
8836 @itemx .adb
8837 @itemx .a
8838 Ada source file.
8839
8840 @item .c
8841 C source file
8842
8843 @item .C
8844 @itemx .cc
8845 @itemx .cp
8846 @itemx .cpp
8847 @itemx .cxx
8848 @itemx .c++
8849 C@t{++} source file
8850
8851 @item .m
8852 Objective-C source file
8853
8854 @item .f
8855 @itemx .F
8856 Fortran source file
8857
8858 @item .mod
8859 Modula-2 source file
8860
8861 @item .s
8862 @itemx .S
8863 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
8864 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
8865 @end table
8866
8867 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
8868 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
8869
8870 @node Manually
8871 @subsection Setting the Working Language
8872
8873 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
8874 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
8875 your program.
8876
8877 @kindex set language
8878 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
8879 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
8880 a language, such as
8881 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
8882 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
8883
8884 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
8885 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
8886 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
8887 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
8888 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
8889 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
8890 command such as:
8891
8892 @smallexample
8893 print a = b + c
8894 @end smallexample
8895
8896 @noindent
8897 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
8898 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
8899 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
8900 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
8901
8902 @node Automatically
8903 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
8904
8905 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
8906 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
8907 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
8908 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
8909 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
8910 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
8911 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
8912 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
8913 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
8914
8915 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
8916 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
8917 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
8918 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
8919 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
8920
8921 @node Show
8922 @section Displaying the Language
8923
8924 The following commands help you find out which language is the
8925 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
8926
8927 @table @code
8928 @item show language
8929 @kindex show language
8930 Display the current working language. This is the
8931 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
8932 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
8933
8934 @item info frame
8935 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
8936 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
8937 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
8938 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
8939 information listed here.
8940
8941 @item info source
8942 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
8943 Display the source language of this source file.
8944 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
8945 information listed here.
8946 @end table
8947
8948 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
8949 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
8950 with a language explicitly:
8951
8952 @table @code
8953 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
8954 @kindex set extension-language
8955 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
8956 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
8957
8958 @item info extensions
8959 @kindex info extensions
8960 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
8961 @end table
8962
8963 @node Checks
8964 @section Type and Range Checking
8965
8966 @quotation
8967 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
8968 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
8969 section documents the intended facilities.
8970 @end quotation
8971 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
8972
8973 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
8974 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
8975 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
8976 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
8977 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
8978 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
8979 errors when your program is running.
8980
8981 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
8982 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
8983 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
8984 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
8985 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
8986 automatically based on your program's source language.
8987 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
8988 settings of supported languages.
8989
8990 @menu
8991 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
8992 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
8993 @end menu
8994
8995 @cindex type checking
8996 @cindex checks, type
8997 @node Type Checking
8998 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
8999
9000 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
9001 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
9002 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
9003 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
9004
9005 @smallexample
9006 1 + 2 @result{} 3
9007 @exdent but
9008 @error{} 1 + 2.3
9009 @end smallexample
9010
9011 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
9012 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
9013
9014 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
9015 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
9016 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
9017 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
9018 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
9019 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
9020 also issues a warning.
9021
9022 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
9023 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
9024 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
9025 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
9026 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
9027 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
9028
9029 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
9030 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
9031 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
9032 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
9033 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
9034 details on specific languages.
9035
9036 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
9037
9038 @kindex set check type
9039 @kindex show check type
9040 @table @code
9041 @item set check type auto
9042 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
9043 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9044 each language.
9045
9046 @item set check type on
9047 @itemx set check type off
9048 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9049 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
9050 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
9051 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
9052 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
9053
9054 @item set check type warn
9055 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
9056 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
9057 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
9058 numbers and structures.
9059
9060 @item show type
9061 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
9062 is setting it automatically.
9063 @end table
9064
9065 @cindex range checking
9066 @cindex checks, range
9067 @node Range Checking
9068 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
9069
9070 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
9071 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
9072 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
9073 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
9074 not exceed the bounds of the array.
9075
9076 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
9077 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
9078 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
9079 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
9080
9081 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
9082 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
9083 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
9084 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
9085 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
9086 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
9087
9088 @smallexample
9089 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
9090 @end smallexample
9091
9092 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
9093 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
9094 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
9095
9096 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
9097
9098 @kindex set check range
9099 @kindex show check range
9100 @table @code
9101 @item set check range auto
9102 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
9103 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9104 each language.
9105
9106 @item set check range on
9107 @itemx set check range off
9108 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9109 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
9110 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
9111 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
9112
9113 @item set check range warn
9114 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
9115 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
9116 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
9117 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
9118 systems).
9119
9120 @item show range
9121 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
9122 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
9123 @end table
9124
9125 @node Supported Languages
9126 @section Supported Languages
9127
9128 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
9129 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
9130 @c This is false ...
9131 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
9132 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
9133 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
9134 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
9135 language.
9136
9137 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
9138 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
9139 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
9140 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
9141 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
9142 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
9143 language reference or tutorial.
9144
9145 @menu
9146 * C:: C and C@t{++}
9147 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
9148 * Fortran:: Fortran
9149 * Pascal:: Pascal
9150 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
9151 * Ada:: Ada
9152 @end menu
9153
9154 @node C
9155 @subsection C and C@t{++}
9156
9157 @cindex C and C@t{++}
9158 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
9159
9160 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
9161 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
9162 together.
9163
9164 @cindex C@t{++}
9165 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
9166 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
9167 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
9168 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
9169 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
9170 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
9171 compiler (@code{aCC}).
9172
9173 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
9174 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
9175 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
9176 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
9177 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
9178 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
9179
9180 @menu
9181 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
9182 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
9183 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
9184 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
9185 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9186 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
9187 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9188 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
9189 @end menu
9190
9191 @node C Operators
9192 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
9193
9194 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
9195
9196 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9197 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9198 often defined on groups of types.
9199
9200 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
9201
9202 @itemize @bullet
9203
9204 @item
9205 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
9206 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
9207
9208 @item
9209 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
9210 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
9211
9212 @item
9213 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
9214
9215 @item
9216 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
9217
9218 @end itemize
9219
9220 @noindent
9221 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
9222 in order of increasing precedence:
9223
9224 @table @code
9225 @item ,
9226 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
9227 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
9228 expression being the last expression evaluated.
9229
9230 @item =
9231 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
9232 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
9233
9234 @item @var{op}=
9235 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
9236 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
9237 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
9238 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
9239 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
9240
9241 @item ?:
9242 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
9243 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
9244 integral type.
9245
9246 @item ||
9247 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9248
9249 @item &&
9250 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9251
9252 @item |
9253 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9254
9255 @item ^
9256 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9257
9258 @item &
9259 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9260
9261 @item ==@r{, }!=
9262 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
9263 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
9264
9265 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
9266 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
9267 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
9268 and non-zero for true.
9269
9270 @item <<@r{, }>>
9271 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
9272
9273 @item @@
9274 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9275
9276 @item +@r{, }-
9277 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
9278 pointer types.
9279
9280 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
9281 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
9282 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
9283 integral types.
9284
9285 @item ++@r{, }--
9286 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
9287 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
9288 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9289 operation takes place.
9290
9291 @item *
9292 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9293 @code{++}.
9294
9295 @item &
9296 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9297
9298 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9299 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9300 to examine the address
9301 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9302 stored.
9303
9304 @item -
9305 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9306 precedence as @code{++}.
9307
9308 @item !
9309 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9310 @code{++}.
9311
9312 @item ~
9313 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9314 @code{++}.
9315
9316
9317 @item .@r{, }->
9318 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
9319 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
9320 pointer based on the stored type information.
9321 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
9322
9323 @item .*@r{, }->*
9324 Dereferences of pointers to members.
9325
9326 @item []
9327 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
9328 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9329
9330 @item ()
9331 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9332
9333 @item ::
9334 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
9335 and @code{class} types.
9336
9337 @item ::
9338 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
9339 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
9340 above.
9341 @end table
9342
9343 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
9344 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
9345 predefined meaning.
9346
9347 @node C Constants
9348 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
9349
9350 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
9351
9352 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
9353 following ways:
9354
9355 @itemize @bullet
9356 @item
9357 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
9358 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
9359 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
9360 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
9361 @code{long} value.
9362
9363 @item
9364 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
9365 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
9366 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
9367 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
9368 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
9369 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
9370 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
9371 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
9372 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
9373 constant.
9374
9375 @item
9376 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
9377 integral equivalents.
9378
9379 @item
9380 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
9381 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
9382 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
9383 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
9384 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
9385 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
9386 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
9387 @samp{\n} for newline.
9388
9389 @item
9390 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
9391 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
9392 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
9393 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
9394 characters.
9395
9396 @item
9397 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
9398 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
9399
9400 @item
9401 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
9402 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
9403 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
9404 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
9405 @end itemize
9406
9407 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
9408 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
9409
9410 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
9411 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
9412
9413 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
9414 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
9415 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
9416 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
9417 @quotation
9418 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
9419 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
9420 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
9421 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
9422 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
9423 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
9424 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
9425 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
9426 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
9427 C@t{++} code.
9428 @end quotation
9429
9430 @enumerate
9431
9432 @cindex member functions
9433 @item
9434 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
9435
9436 @smallexample
9437 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
9438 @end smallexample
9439
9440 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
9441 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
9442 @item
9443 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
9444 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
9445 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
9446 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
9447
9448 @cindex call overloaded functions
9449 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
9450 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
9451 @item
9452 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
9453 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
9454 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
9455 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
9456 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
9457 default arguments.
9458
9459 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
9460 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
9461 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
9462 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
9463 number of function arguments.
9464
9465 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
9466 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
9467 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
9468
9469 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
9470 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
9471 @smallexample
9472 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
9473 @end smallexample
9474
9475 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
9476 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
9477
9478 @cindex reference declarations
9479 @item
9480 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
9481 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
9482 dereferenced.
9483
9484 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
9485 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
9486 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
9487 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
9488 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
9489
9490 @item
9491 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
9492 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
9493 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
9494 necessary, for example in an expression like
9495 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
9496 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
9497 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
9498 @end enumerate
9499
9500 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
9501 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
9502 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
9503 invoking user-defined operators.
9504
9505 @node C Defaults
9506 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
9507
9508 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
9509
9510 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
9511 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
9512 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9513 selects the working language.
9514
9515 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
9516 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
9517 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
9518 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
9519 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
9520 for further details.
9521
9522 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
9523 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
9524 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
9525
9526 @node C Checks
9527 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
9528
9529 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
9530
9531 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
9532 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
9533 considers two variables type equivalent if:
9534
9535 @itemize @bullet
9536 @item
9537 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
9538 enumerated tag.
9539
9540 @item
9541 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
9542 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
9543
9544 @ignore
9545 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
9546 @c FIXME--beers?
9547 @item
9548 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
9549 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
9550 compilers.)
9551 @end ignore
9552 @end itemize
9553
9554 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
9555 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
9556 that is not itself an array.
9557
9558 @node Debugging C
9559 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
9560
9561 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
9562 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
9563 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
9564 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
9565
9566 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
9567 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
9568 ,Expressions}.
9569
9570 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
9571 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
9572
9573 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
9574
9575 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
9576 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
9577
9578 @table @code
9579 @cindex break in overloaded functions
9580 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
9581 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
9582 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
9583 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint Menus}.
9584
9585 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
9586 @item rbreak @var{regex}
9587 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
9588 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
9589 classes.
9590 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
9591
9592 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
9593 @item catch throw
9594 @itemx catch catch
9595 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
9596 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
9597
9598 @cindex inheritance
9599 @item ptype @var{typename}
9600 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
9601 @var{typename}.
9602 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
9603
9604 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
9605 @item set print demangle
9606 @itemx show print demangle
9607 @itemx set print asm-demangle
9608 @itemx show print asm-demangle
9609 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
9610 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
9611 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9612
9613 @item set print object
9614 @itemx show print object
9615 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
9616 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9617
9618 @item set print vtbl
9619 @itemx show print vtbl
9620 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
9621 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9622 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9623 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9624
9625 @kindex set overload-resolution
9626 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
9627 @item set overload-resolution on
9628 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
9629 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
9630 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
9631 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
9632 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
9633 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
9634
9635 @item set overload-resolution off
9636 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
9637 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9638 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
9639 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
9640 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9641 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
9642 argument types.
9643
9644 @kindex show overload-resolution
9645 @item show overload-resolution
9646 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
9647
9648 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
9649 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
9650 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
9651 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
9652 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
9653 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
9654 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
9655 @end table
9656
9657 @node Decimal Floating Point
9658 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
9659 @cindex decimal floating point format
9660
9661 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
9662 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
9663 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
9664 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
9665
9666 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
9667 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
9668 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
9669 target.
9670
9671 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
9672 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
9673 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
9674
9675 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
9676 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
9677 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
9678
9679 @node Objective-C
9680 @subsection Objective-C
9681
9682 @cindex Objective-C
9683 This section provides information about some commands and command
9684 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
9685 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
9686 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
9687
9688 @menu
9689 * Method Names in Commands::
9690 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
9691 @end menu
9692
9693 @node Method Names in Commands
9694 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
9695
9696 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
9697 names as line specifications:
9698
9699 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
9700 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
9701 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
9702 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
9703 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
9704 @itemize
9705 @item @code{clear}
9706 @item @code{break}
9707 @item @code{info line}
9708 @item @code{jump}
9709 @item @code{list}
9710 @end itemize
9711
9712 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
9713
9714 @smallexample
9715 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
9716 @end smallexample
9717
9718 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
9719 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
9720 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
9721 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
9722 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
9723 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
9724 debugged, enter:
9725
9726 @smallexample
9727 break -[Fruit create]
9728 @end smallexample
9729
9730 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
9731 enter:
9732
9733 @smallexample
9734 list +[NSText initialize]
9735 @end smallexample
9736
9737 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
9738 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
9739 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
9740 is also possible to specify just a method name:
9741
9742 @smallexample
9743 break create
9744 @end smallexample
9745
9746 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
9747 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
9748 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
9749 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
9750 none apply.
9751
9752 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
9753 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
9754
9755 @smallexample
9756 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
9757 @end smallexample
9758
9759 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
9760 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
9761 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
9762 @kindex print-object
9763 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
9764
9765 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
9766
9767 @smallexample
9768 print -[@var{object} hash]
9769 @end smallexample
9770
9771 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
9772 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
9773 @noindent
9774 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
9775 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
9776 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
9777 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
9778 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
9779 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
9780
9781 @node Fortran
9782 @subsection Fortran
9783 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
9784
9785 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
9786 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
9787
9788 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
9789 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
9790 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
9791 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
9792 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
9793 underscore.
9794
9795 @menu
9796 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
9797 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
9798 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
9799 @end menu
9800
9801 @node Fortran Operators
9802 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
9803
9804 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
9805
9806 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9807 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
9808 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
9809
9810 @table @code
9811 @item **
9812 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
9813 of the second one.
9814
9815 @item :
9816 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
9817 represent a section of array.
9818 @end table
9819
9820 @node Fortran Defaults
9821 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
9822
9823 @cindex Fortran Defaults
9824
9825 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
9826 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
9827 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
9828 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
9829
9830 @node Special Fortran Commands
9831 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
9832
9833 @cindex Special Fortran commands
9834
9835 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
9836 such as displaying common blocks.
9837
9838 @table @code
9839 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
9840 @kindex info common
9841 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
9842 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
9843 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
9844 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
9845 printed.
9846 @end table
9847
9848 @node Pascal
9849 @subsection Pascal
9850
9851 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
9852 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
9853 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
9854 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
9855 syntax.
9856
9857 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
9858 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
9859 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
9860
9861 @node Modula-2
9862 @subsection Modula-2
9863
9864 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
9865
9866 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
9867 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
9868 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
9869 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
9870 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
9871 table.
9872
9873 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
9874 @menu
9875 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
9876 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
9877 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
9878 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
9879 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
9880 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
9881 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
9882 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
9883 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
9884 @end menu
9885
9886 @node M2 Operators
9887 @subsubsection Operators
9888 @cindex Modula-2 operators
9889
9890 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9891 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9892 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
9893 following definitions hold:
9894
9895 @itemize @bullet
9896
9897 @item
9898 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
9899 their subranges.
9900
9901 @item
9902 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
9903
9904 @item
9905 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
9906
9907 @item
9908 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
9909 @var{type}}.
9910
9911 @item
9912 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
9913
9914 @item
9915 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
9916
9917 @item
9918 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
9919 @end itemize
9920
9921 @noindent
9922 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
9923 increasing precedence:
9924
9925 @table @code
9926 @item ,
9927 Function argument or array index separator.
9928
9929 @item :=
9930 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
9931 @var{value}.
9932
9933 @item <@r{, }>
9934 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
9935 types.
9936
9937 @item <=@r{, }>=
9938 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
9939 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
9940 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
9941
9942 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
9943 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
9944 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
9945 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
9946 comment character.
9947
9948 @item IN
9949 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
9950 Same precedence as @code{<}.
9951
9952 @item OR
9953 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9954
9955 @item AND@r{, }&
9956 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9957
9958 @item @@
9959 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9960
9961 @item +@r{, }-
9962 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
9963 and difference on set types.
9964
9965 @item *
9966 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
9967 on set types.
9968
9969 @item /
9970 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
9971 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
9972
9973 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
9974 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
9975 precedence as @code{*}.
9976
9977 @item -
9978 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
9979
9980 @item ^
9981 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
9982
9983 @item NOT
9984 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
9985 @code{^}.
9986
9987 @item .
9988 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
9989 precedence as @code{^}.
9990
9991 @item []
9992 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
9993
9994 @item ()
9995 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
9996 as @code{^}.
9997
9998 @item ::@r{, }.
9999 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
10000 @end table
10001
10002 @quotation
10003 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
10004 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
10005 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
10006 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
10007 @end quotation
10008
10009
10010 @node Built-In Func/Proc
10011 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
10012 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
10013
10014 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
10015 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
10016
10017 @table @var
10018
10019 @item a
10020 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
10021
10022 @item c
10023 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
10024
10025 @item i
10026 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
10027
10028 @item m
10029 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
10030 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
10031 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
10032
10033 @item n
10034 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
10035
10036 @item r
10037 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
10038
10039 @item t
10040 represents a type.
10041
10042 @item v
10043 represents a variable.
10044
10045 @item x
10046 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
10047 explanation of the function for details.
10048 @end table
10049
10050 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
10051
10052 @table @code
10053 @item ABS(@var{n})
10054 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
10055
10056 @item CAP(@var{c})
10057 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
10058 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
10059
10060 @item CHR(@var{i})
10061 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10062
10063 @item DEC(@var{v})
10064 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10065
10066 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
10067 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10068 new value.
10069
10070 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10071 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
10072 set.
10073
10074 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
10075 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
10076
10077 @item HIGH(@var{a})
10078 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
10079
10080 @item INC(@var{v})
10081 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10082
10083 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
10084 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10085 new value.
10086
10087 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10088 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
10089 there. Returns the new set.
10090
10091 @item MAX(@var{t})
10092 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
10093
10094 @item MIN(@var{t})
10095 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
10096
10097 @item ODD(@var{i})
10098 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
10099
10100 @item ORD(@var{x})
10101 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
10102 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
10103 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
10104 integral, character and enumerated types.
10105
10106 @item SIZE(@var{x})
10107 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10108
10109 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
10110 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
10111
10112 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
10113 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10114
10115 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
10116 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10117 @end table
10118
10119 @quotation
10120 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
10121 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
10122 an error.
10123 @end quotation
10124
10125 @cindex Modula-2 constants
10126 @node M2 Constants
10127 @subsubsection Constants
10128
10129 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
10130 ways:
10131
10132 @itemize @bullet
10133
10134 @item
10135 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
10136 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
10137 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
10138 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
10139
10140 @item
10141 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
10142 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
10143 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
10144 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
10145 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
10146 digits.
10147
10148 @item
10149 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
10150 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
10151 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
10152 followed by a @samp{C}.
10153
10154 @item
10155 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
10156 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
10157 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
10158 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
10159 sequences.
10160
10161 @item
10162 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
10163
10164 @item
10165 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
10166 @code{FALSE}.
10167
10168 @item
10169 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
10170
10171 @item
10172 Set constants are not yet supported.
10173 @end itemize
10174
10175 @node M2 Types
10176 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
10177 @cindex Modula-2 types
10178
10179 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
10180 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
10181 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
10182 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
10183 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
10184 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
10185
10186 The first example contains the following section of code:
10187
10188 @smallexample
10189 VAR
10190 s: SET OF CHAR ;
10191 r: [20..40] ;
10192 @end smallexample
10193
10194 @noindent
10195 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
10196 @code{r} and @code{s}.
10197
10198 @smallexample
10199 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10200 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
10201 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10202 SET OF CHAR
10203 (@value{GDBP}) print r
10204 21
10205 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
10206 [20..40]
10207 @end smallexample
10208
10209 @noindent
10210 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
10211
10212 @smallexample
10213 VAR
10214 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
10215 @end smallexample
10216
10217 @noindent
10218 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
10219
10220 @smallexample
10221 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10222 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
10223 @end smallexample
10224
10225 @noindent
10226 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
10227 expressions using the debugger.
10228
10229 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
10230 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
10231
10232 @smallexample
10233 VAR
10234 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
10235 @end smallexample
10236
10237 @smallexample
10238 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10239 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
10240 @end smallexample
10241
10242 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
10243 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
10244 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
10245 above.
10246
10247 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
10248
10249 @smallexample
10250 TYPE
10251 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
10252 t = [blue..yellow] ;
10253 VAR
10254 s: t ;
10255 BEGIN
10256 s := blue ;
10257 @end smallexample
10258
10259 @noindent
10260 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
10261 and value of a variable.
10262
10263 @smallexample
10264 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10265 $1 = blue
10266 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
10267 type = [blue..yellow]
10268 @end smallexample
10269
10270 @noindent
10271 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
10272 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
10273 their @code{C} counterparts.
10274
10275 @smallexample
10276 VAR
10277 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10278 BEGIN
10279 s[1] := 1 ;
10280 @end smallexample
10281
10282 @smallexample
10283 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10284 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
10285 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10286 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10287 @end smallexample
10288
10289 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
10290 pointer types as shown in this example:
10291
10292 @smallexample
10293 VAR
10294 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10295 BEGIN
10296 NEW(s) ;
10297 s^[1] := 1 ;
10298 @end smallexample
10299
10300 @noindent
10301 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
10302
10303 @smallexample
10304 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10305 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10306 @end smallexample
10307
10308 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
10309 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
10310 types:
10311
10312 @smallexample
10313 TYPE
10314 foo = RECORD
10315 f1: CARDINAL ;
10316 f2: CHAR ;
10317 f3: myarray ;
10318 END ;
10319
10320 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
10321 myrange = [-2..2] ;
10322 VAR
10323 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
10324 @end smallexample
10325
10326 @noindent
10327 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
10328 below.
10329
10330 @smallexample
10331 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10332 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
10333 f1 : CARDINAL;
10334 f2 : CHAR;
10335 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
10336 END
10337 @end smallexample
10338
10339 @node M2 Defaults
10340 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
10341 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
10342
10343 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
10344 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
10345 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10346 selected the working language.
10347
10348 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
10349 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
10350 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
10351 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
10352
10353 @node Deviations
10354 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
10355 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
10356
10357 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
10358 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
10359
10360 @itemize @bullet
10361 @item
10362 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
10363 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
10364 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
10365 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
10366 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
10367 returned a pointer.)
10368
10369 @item
10370 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
10371 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
10372 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
10373 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
10374
10375 @item
10376 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
10377 argument.
10378
10379 @item
10380 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
10381 @end itemize
10382
10383 @node M2 Checks
10384 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
10385 @cindex Modula-2 checks
10386
10387 @quotation
10388 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
10389 range checking.
10390 @end quotation
10391 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
10392
10393 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
10394
10395 @itemize @bullet
10396 @item
10397 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
10398 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
10399
10400 @item
10401 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
10402 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
10403 @end itemize
10404
10405 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
10406 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
10407
10408 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
10409 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
10410
10411 @node M2 Scope
10412 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10413 @cindex scope
10414 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
10415 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
10416 @ifinfo
10417 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
10418 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
10419 @end ifinfo
10420 @iftex
10421 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
10422 @end iftex
10423
10424 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
10425 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
10426 similar syntax:
10427
10428 @smallexample
10429
10430 @var{module} . @var{id}
10431 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
10432 @end smallexample
10433
10434 @noindent
10435 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
10436 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
10437 identifier within your program, except another module.
10438
10439 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
10440 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
10441 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
10442 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
10443
10444 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
10445 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
10446 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
10447 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
10448 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
10449 @var{module}.
10450
10451 @node GDB/M2
10452 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10453
10454 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
10455 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
10456 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
10457 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
10458 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
10459 analogue in Modula-2.
10460
10461 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
10462 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
10463 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
10464 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
10465 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
10466 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
10467
10468 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
10469 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
10470 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
10471
10472 @node Ada
10473 @subsection Ada
10474 @cindex Ada
10475
10476 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
10477 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
10478 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
10479 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10480 to be difficult.
10481
10482
10483 @cindex expressions in Ada
10484 @menu
10485 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
10486 and semantics supported by Ada mode
10487 in @value{GDBN}.
10488 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
10489 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
10490 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
10491 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
10492 @end menu
10493
10494 @node Ada Mode Intro
10495 @subsubsection Introduction
10496 @cindex Ada mode, general
10497
10498 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
10499 syntax, with some extensions.
10500 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
10501
10502 @itemize @bullet
10503 @item
10504 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
10505 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
10506 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
10507 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
10508
10509 @item
10510 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
10511 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10512
10513 @item
10514 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10515 @end itemize
10516
10517 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
10518 implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
10519 packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
10520 their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
10521 @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
10522
10523 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
10524 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
10525 was translated from an Ada source file.
10526
10527 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
10528 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
10529 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
10530 middle (to allow based literals).
10531
10532 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
10533 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
10534 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
10535 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
10536 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
10537 functions to procedures elsewhere.
10538
10539 @node Omissions from Ada
10540 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
10541 @cindex Ada, omissions from
10542
10543 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
10544
10545 @itemize @bullet
10546 @item
10547 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
10548
10549 @itemize @minus
10550 @item
10551 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
10552 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
10553
10554 @item
10555 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
10556
10557 @item
10558 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
10559
10560 @item
10561 @t{'Tag}.
10562
10563 @item
10564 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
10565 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
10566
10567 @item
10568 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
10569 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
10570
10571 @item
10572 @t{'Address}.
10573 @end itemize
10574
10575 @item
10576 The names in
10577 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
10578 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
10579 not currently available.
10580
10581 @item
10582 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
10583 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
10584 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
10585 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
10586 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
10587 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
10588 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
10589 indeterminate values.
10590
10591 @item
10592 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
10593 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
10594 are not implemented.
10595
10596 @item
10597 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
10598 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
10599 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
10600 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
10601 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
10602
10603 @smallexample
10604 set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
10605 set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
10606 set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
10607 set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
10608 set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
10609 set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
10610 @end smallexample
10611
10612 Changing a
10613 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
10614 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
10615 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
10616 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
10617 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
10618 declared to have a type such as:
10619
10620 @smallexample
10621 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
10622 Id : Integer;
10623 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
10624 end record;
10625 @end smallexample
10626
10627 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
10628 assignments:
10629
10630 @smallexample
10631 set A_Rec.Len := 4
10632 set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
10633 @end smallexample
10634
10635 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
10636 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
10637 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
10638 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
10639 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
10640 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
10641 redundant component associations, although which component values are
10642 assigned in such cases is not defined.
10643
10644 @item
10645 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
10646
10647 @item
10648 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
10649 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
10650 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
10651 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
10652 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
10653 the proper resolution.
10654
10655 @item
10656 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
10657
10658 @item
10659 Entry calls are not implemented.
10660
10661 @item
10662 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
10663 formats are not supported.
10664
10665 @item
10666 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
10667 @end itemize
10668
10669 @node Additions to Ada
10670 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
10671 @cindex Ada, deviations from
10672
10673 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
10674 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
10675
10676 @itemize @bullet
10677 @item
10678 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
10679 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
10680 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
10681 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
10682 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
10683 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
10684 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
10685 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
10686
10687 @item
10688 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
10689 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
10690 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
10691
10692 @item
10693 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
10694 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
10695
10696 @item
10697 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
10698 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
10699 @end itemize
10700
10701 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
10702 additions specific to Ada:
10703
10704 @itemize @bullet
10705 @item
10706 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
10707 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
10708
10709 @smallexample
10710 set x := y + 3
10711 print A(tmp := y + 1)
10712 @end smallexample
10713
10714 @item
10715 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
10716 the value of its right-hand operand.
10717 This allows, for example,
10718 complex conditional breaks:
10719
10720 @smallexample
10721 break f
10722 condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
10723 @end smallexample
10724
10725 @item
10726 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
10727 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
10728 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
10729 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
10730 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
10731 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
10732 in strings. For example,
10733 @smallexample
10734 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
10735 @end smallexample
10736 @noindent
10737 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
10738 after each period.
10739
10740 @item
10741 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
10742 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
10743 to write
10744
10745 @smallexample
10746 print 'max(x, y)
10747 @end smallexample
10748
10749 @item
10750 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
10751 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
10752 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
10753 of 3 might print as
10754
10755 @smallexample
10756 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
10757 @end smallexample
10758
10759 @noindent
10760 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
10761 clause.
10762
10763 @item
10764 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
10765 multi-character subsequence of
10766 their names (an exact match gets preference).
10767 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
10768 in place of @t{a'length}.
10769
10770 @item
10771 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
10772 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
10773 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
10774 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
10775 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
10776 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
10777 For example,
10778 @smallexample
10779 @value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
10780 @end smallexample
10781
10782 @item
10783 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
10784 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
10785 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
10786 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
10787 object.
10788
10789 @end itemize
10790
10791 @node Stopping Before Main Program
10792 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
10793
10794 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
10795 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
10796 before reaching the main procedure.
10797 As defined in the Ada Reference
10798 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
10799 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
10800 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
10801 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
10802
10803 @node Ada Glitches
10804 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
10805 @cindex Ada, problems
10806
10807 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
10808 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
10809 @value{GDBN},
10810 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
10811 and the GNU Ada compiler.
10812
10813 @itemize @bullet
10814 @item
10815 Currently, the debugger
10816 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
10817 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
10818 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
10819 to get it printed properly.
10820
10821 @item
10822 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
10823 storage are invisible to the debugger.
10824
10825 @item
10826 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
10827 argument lists are treated as positional).
10828
10829 @item
10830 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
10831
10832 @item
10833 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
10834 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
10835 the host machine.
10836
10837 @item
10838 The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
10839
10840 @item
10841 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
10842 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
10843 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
10844 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
10845 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
10846 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
10847 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
10848 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
10849 you can usually resolve the confusion
10850 by qualifying the problematic names with package
10851 @code{Standard} explicitly.
10852 @end itemize
10853
10854 @node Unsupported Languages
10855 @section Unsupported Languages
10856
10857 @cindex unsupported languages
10858 @cindex minimal language
10859 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
10860 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
10861 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
10862 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
10863 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
10864 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
10865
10866 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
10867 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
10868 language.
10869
10870 @node Symbols
10871 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
10872
10873 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
10874 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
10875 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
10876 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
10877 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
10878 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
10879 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
10880
10881 @cindex symbol names
10882 @cindex names of symbols
10883 @cindex quoting names
10884 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
10885 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
10886 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
10887 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
10888 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
10889 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
10890 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
10891 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
10892
10893 @smallexample
10894 p 'foo.c'::x
10895 @end smallexample
10896
10897 @noindent
10898 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
10899
10900 @table @code
10901 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
10902 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
10903 @kindex set case-sensitive
10904 @item set case-sensitive on
10905 @itemx set case-sensitive off
10906 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
10907 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
10908 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
10909 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
10910 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
10911 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
10912 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
10913 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
10914 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
10915 case-insensitive matches.
10916
10917 @kindex show case-sensitive
10918 @item show case-sensitive
10919 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
10920 lookups.
10921
10922 @kindex info address
10923 @cindex address of a symbol
10924 @item info address @var{symbol}
10925 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
10926 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
10927 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
10928 is always stored.
10929
10930 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
10931 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
10932 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
10933
10934 @kindex info symbol
10935 @cindex symbol from address
10936 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
10937 @item info symbol @var{addr}
10938 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
10939 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
10940 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
10941
10942 @smallexample
10943 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
10944 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
10945 @end smallexample
10946
10947 @noindent
10948 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
10949 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
10950
10951 @kindex whatis
10952 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
10953 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
10954 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
10955 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
10956 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
10957 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
10958 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
10959 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
10960 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
10961 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
10962 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10963
10964 @kindex ptype
10965 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
10966 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
10967 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
10968 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10969
10970 For example, for this variable declaration:
10971
10972 @smallexample
10973 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
10974 @end smallexample
10975
10976 @noindent
10977 the two commands give this output:
10978
10979 @smallexample
10980 @group
10981 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
10982 type = struct complex
10983 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
10984 type = struct complex @{
10985 double real;
10986 double imag;
10987 @}
10988 @end group
10989 @end smallexample
10990
10991 @noindent
10992 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
10993 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
10994
10995 @cindex incomplete type
10996 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
10997 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
10998 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
10999 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
11000 given these declarations:
11001
11002 @smallexample
11003 struct foo;
11004 struct foo *fooptr;
11005 @end smallexample
11006
11007 @noindent
11008 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
11009
11010 @smallexample
11011 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
11012 $1 = <incomplete type>
11013 @end smallexample
11014
11015 @noindent
11016 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
11017 completely specified.
11018
11019 @kindex info types
11020 @item info types @var{regexp}
11021 @itemx info types
11022 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
11023 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
11024 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
11025 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
11026 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
11027 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
11028 name is @code{value}.
11029
11030 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
11031 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
11032 lists all source files where a type is defined.
11033
11034 @kindex info scope
11035 @cindex local variables
11036 @item info scope @var{location}
11037 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
11038 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
11039 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
11040 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
11041 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
11042
11043 @smallexample
11044 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
11045 Scope for command_line_handler:
11046 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
11047 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
11048 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
11049 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
11050 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
11051 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
11052 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
11053 @end smallexample
11054
11055 @noindent
11056 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
11057 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
11058 collect}.
11059
11060 @kindex info source
11061 @item info source
11062 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
11063 the function containing the current point of execution:
11064 @itemize @bullet
11065 @item
11066 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
11067 @item
11068 the directory it was compiled in,
11069 @item
11070 its length, in lines,
11071 @item
11072 which programming language it is written in,
11073 @item
11074 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
11075 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
11076 @item
11077 whether the debugging information includes information about
11078 preprocessor macros.
11079 @end itemize
11080
11081
11082 @kindex info sources
11083 @item info sources
11084 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
11085 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
11086 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
11087
11088 @kindex info functions
11089 @item info functions
11090 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
11091
11092 @item info functions @var{regexp}
11093 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
11094 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
11095 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
11096 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
11097 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
11098 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
11099 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
11100
11101 @kindex info variables
11102 @item info variables
11103 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
11104 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
11105
11106 @item info variables @var{regexp}
11107 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
11108 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
11109 @var{regexp}.
11110
11111 @kindex info classes
11112 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
11113 @item info classes
11114 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
11115 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
11116 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11117 expression.
11118
11119 @kindex info selectors
11120 @item info selectors
11121 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
11122 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
11123 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11124 expression.
11125
11126 @ignore
11127 This was never implemented.
11128 @kindex info methods
11129 @item info methods
11130 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
11131 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
11132 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
11133 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
11134 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
11135 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
11136 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
11137 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
11138 @end ignore
11139
11140 @cindex reloading symbols
11141 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
11142 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
11143 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
11144 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
11145 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
11146
11147 @table @code
11148 @kindex set symbol-reloading
11149 @item set symbol-reloading on
11150 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
11151 object file with a particular name is seen again.
11152
11153 @item set symbol-reloading off
11154 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
11155 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
11156 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
11157 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
11158 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
11159 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
11160 name.
11161
11162 @kindex show symbol-reloading
11163 @item show symbol-reloading
11164 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
11165 @end table
11166
11167 @cindex opaque data types
11168 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
11169 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
11170 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
11171 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
11172 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
11173 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
11174 another source file. The default is on.
11175
11176 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
11177 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
11178
11179 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
11180 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
11181 is printed as follows:
11182 @smallexample
11183 @{<no data fields>@}
11184 @end smallexample
11185
11186 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
11187 @item show opaque-type-resolution
11188 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
11189
11190 @kindex maint print symbols
11191 @cindex symbol dump
11192 @kindex maint print psymbols
11193 @cindex partial symbol dump
11194 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
11195 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
11196 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
11197 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
11198 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
11199 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
11200 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
11201 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
11202 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
11203 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
11204 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
11205 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
11206 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
11207 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
11208 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
11209 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
11210 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
11211
11212 @kindex maint info symtabs
11213 @kindex maint info psymtabs
11214 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
11215 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11216 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11217 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11218 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11219 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11220
11221 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
11222 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
11223 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
11224 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
11225 structure in more detail. For example:
11226
11227 @smallexample
11228 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
11229 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11230 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11231 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11232 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
11233 readin no
11234 fullname (null)
11235 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
11236 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
11237 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
11238 dependencies (none)
11239 @}
11240 @}
11241 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11242 (@value{GDBP})
11243 @end smallexample
11244 @noindent
11245 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
11246 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
11247 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
11248 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
11249 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
11250
11251 @smallexample
11252 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
11253 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
11254 line 1574.
11255 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11256 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11257 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11258 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11259 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
11260 dirname (null)
11261 fullname (null)
11262 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
11263 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
11264 debugformat DWARF 2
11265 @}
11266 @}
11267 (@value{GDBP})
11268 @end smallexample
11269 @end table
11270
11271
11272 @node Altering
11273 @chapter Altering Execution
11274
11275 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
11276 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
11277 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
11278 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
11279 program.
11280
11281 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
11282 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
11283 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
11284
11285 @menu
11286 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
11287 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
11288 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
11289 * Returning:: Returning from a function
11290 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
11291 * Patching:: Patching your program
11292 @end menu
11293
11294 @node Assignment
11295 @section Assignment to Variables
11296
11297 @cindex assignment
11298 @cindex setting variables
11299 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
11300 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
11301
11302 @smallexample
11303 print x=4
11304 @end smallexample
11305
11306 @noindent
11307 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
11308 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
11309 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
11310 information on operators in supported languages.
11311
11312 @kindex set variable
11313 @cindex variables, setting
11314 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
11315 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
11316 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
11317 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
11318 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
11319
11320 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
11321 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
11322 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
11323 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
11324 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
11325 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
11326 command @code{set width}:
11327
11328 @smallexample
11329 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
11330 type = double
11331 (@value{GDBP}) p width
11332 $4 = 13
11333 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
11334 Invalid syntax in expression.
11335 @end smallexample
11336
11337 @noindent
11338 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
11339 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
11340
11341 @smallexample
11342 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
11343 @end smallexample
11344
11345 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
11346 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
11347 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
11348 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
11349 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
11350 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
11351
11352 @smallexample
11353 @group
11354 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
11355 type = double
11356 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11357 $1 = 1
11358 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
11359 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11360 $2 = 1
11361 (@value{GDBP}) r
11362 The program being debugged has been started already.
11363 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
11364 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
11365 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
11366 Invalid bfd target.
11367 (@value{GDBP}) show g
11368 The current BFD target is "=4".
11369 @end group
11370 @end smallexample
11371
11372 @noindent
11373 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
11374 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
11375 @code{g}, use
11376
11377 @smallexample
11378 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
11379 @end smallexample
11380
11381 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
11382 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
11383 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
11384 same length or shorter.
11385 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
11386 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
11387
11388 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
11389 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
11390 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
11391 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
11392 and representation in memory), and
11393
11394 @smallexample
11395 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
11396 @end smallexample
11397
11398 @noindent
11399 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
11400
11401 @node Jumping
11402 @section Continuing at a Different Address
11403
11404 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
11405 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
11406 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
11407
11408 @table @code
11409 @kindex jump
11410 @item jump @var{linespec}
11411 @itemx jump @var{location}
11412 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
11413 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
11414 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
11415 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
11416 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
11417 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
11418
11419 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
11420 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
11421 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
11422 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
11423 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
11424 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
11425 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
11426 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
11427 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
11428 @end table
11429
11430 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
11431 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
11432 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
11433 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
11434 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
11435 example,
11436
11437 @smallexample
11438 set $pc = 0x485
11439 @end smallexample
11440
11441 @noindent
11442 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
11443 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
11444 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
11445
11446 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
11447 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
11448 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
11449 detail.
11450
11451 @c @group
11452 @node Signaling
11453 @section Giving your Program a Signal
11454 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
11455
11456 @table @code
11457 @kindex signal
11458 @item signal @var{signal}
11459 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
11460 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
11461 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
11462 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
11463
11464 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
11465 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
11466 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
11467 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
11468 signal.
11469
11470 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
11471 after executing the command.
11472 @end table
11473 @c @end group
11474
11475 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
11476 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
11477 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
11478 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
11479 passes the signal directly to your program.
11480
11481
11482 @node Returning
11483 @section Returning from a Function
11484
11485 @table @code
11486 @cindex returning from a function
11487 @kindex return
11488 @item return
11489 @itemx return @var{expression}
11490 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
11491 command. If you give an
11492 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
11493 value.
11494 @end table
11495
11496 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
11497 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
11498 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
11499 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
11500
11501 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
11502 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
11503 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
11504 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
11505 of functions.
11506
11507 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
11508 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
11509 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
11510 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
11511 selected stack frame returns naturally.
11512
11513 @node Calling
11514 @section Calling Program Functions
11515
11516 @table @code
11517 @cindex calling functions
11518 @cindex inferior functions, calling
11519 @item print @var{expr}
11520 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
11521 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
11522 debugged.
11523
11524 @kindex call
11525 @item call @var{expr}
11526 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
11527 returned values.
11528
11529 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
11530 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
11531 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
11532 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
11533 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
11534 value history.
11535 @end table
11536
11537 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
11538 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
11539 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
11540 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
11541
11542 @table @code
11543 @item set unwindonsignal
11544 @kindex set unwindonsignal
11545 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
11546 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
11547 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
11548 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
11549 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
11550 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
11551 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
11552 received.
11553
11554 @item show unwindonsignal
11555 @kindex show unwindonsignal
11556 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
11557 @value{GDBN}.
11558 @end table
11559
11560 @cindex weak alias functions
11561 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
11562 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
11563 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
11564 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
11565 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
11566 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
11567 function instead.
11568
11569 @node Patching
11570 @section Patching Programs
11571
11572 @cindex patching binaries
11573 @cindex writing into executables
11574 @cindex writing into corefiles
11575
11576 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
11577 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
11578 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
11579 patching your program's binary.
11580
11581 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
11582 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
11583 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
11584 repairs.
11585
11586 @table @code
11587 @kindex set write
11588 @item set write on
11589 @itemx set write off
11590 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
11591 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
11592 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
11593
11594 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
11595 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
11596 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
11597
11598 @item show write
11599 @kindex show write
11600 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
11601 as well as reading.
11602 @end table
11603
11604 @node GDB Files
11605 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
11606
11607 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
11608 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
11609 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
11610 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
11611
11612 @menu
11613 * Files:: Commands to specify files
11614 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
11615 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
11616 @end menu
11617
11618 @node Files
11619 @section Commands to Specify Files
11620
11621 @cindex symbol table
11622 @cindex core dump file
11623
11624 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
11625 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
11626 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
11627 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
11628
11629 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
11630 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
11631 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
11632 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
11633 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
11634 new files are useful.
11635
11636 @table @code
11637 @cindex executable file
11638 @kindex file
11639 @item file @var{filename}
11640 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
11641 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
11642 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
11643 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
11644 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
11645 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
11646 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
11647 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
11648
11649 @cindex unlinked object files
11650 @cindex patching object files
11651 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
11652 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
11653 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
11654 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
11655 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
11656 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
11657 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
11658 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
11659
11660 @item file
11661 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
11662 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
11663
11664 @kindex exec-file
11665 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11666 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
11667 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
11668 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
11669 discard information on the executable file.
11670
11671 @kindex symbol-file
11672 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11673 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
11674 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
11675 table and program to run from the same file.
11676
11677 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
11678 program's symbol table.
11679
11680 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
11681 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
11682 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
11683 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
11684 @value{GDBN}.
11685
11686 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
11687 executing it once.
11688
11689 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
11690 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
11691 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
11692 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
11693 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
11694 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
11695 optimized code.
11696
11697 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
11698 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
11699 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
11700 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
11701 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
11702
11703 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
11704 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
11705 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
11706 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
11707 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
11708 Warnings and Messages}.)
11709
11710 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
11711 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
11712 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
11713 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
11714 in stabs format.
11715
11716 @kindex readnow
11717 @cindex reading symbols immediately
11718 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
11719 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11720 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11721 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
11722 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
11723 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
11724 entire symbol table available.
11725
11726 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
11727 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
11728 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
11729 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
11730 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
11731 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
11732 @c files.
11733
11734 @kindex core-file
11735 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
11736 @itemx core
11737 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
11738 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
11739 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
11740 executable file itself for other parts.
11741
11742 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
11743 to be used.
11744
11745 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
11746 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
11747 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
11748 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
11749 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
11750
11751 @kindex add-symbol-file
11752 @cindex dynamic linking
11753 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
11754 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11755 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
11756 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
11757 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
11758 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
11759 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
11760 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
11761 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
11762 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
11763 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
11764 @var{address} as an expression.
11765
11766 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
11767 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
11768 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
11769 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
11770 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
11771
11772 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
11773 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
11774 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
11775 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
11776 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
11777 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
11778 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
11779 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
11780 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
11781
11782 @itemize @bullet
11783 @item
11784 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
11785 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
11786 @item
11787 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
11788 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
11789 @item
11790 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
11791 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
11792 @end itemize
11793
11794 @noindent
11795 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
11796 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
11797 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
11798 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
11799 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
11800 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
11801 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
11802 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
11803 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
11804 way.
11805
11806 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
11807
11808 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
11809 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
11810 @cindex load symbols from memory
11811 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
11812 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
11813 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
11814 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
11815 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
11816 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
11817 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
11818 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
11819 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
11820
11821 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
11822 @kindex assf
11823 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
11824 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
11825 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
11826 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
11827 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
11828 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
11829 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
11830 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
11831 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
11832 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
11833
11834 @kindex section
11835 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
11836 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
11837 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
11838 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
11839 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
11840 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
11841 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
11842 their addresses.
11843
11844 @kindex info files
11845 @kindex info target
11846 @item info files
11847 @itemx info target
11848 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
11849 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
11850 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
11851 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
11852 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
11853 current ones.
11854
11855 @kindex maint info sections
11856 @item maint info sections
11857 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
11858 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
11859 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
11860 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
11861 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
11862 may be arbitrarily combined):
11863
11864 @table @code
11865 @item ALLOBJ
11866 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
11867 @item @var{sections}
11868 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
11869 @item @var{section-flags}
11870 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
11871 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
11872 @table @code
11873 @item ALLOC
11874 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
11875 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
11876 @item LOAD
11877 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
11878 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
11879 @item RELOC
11880 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
11881 @item READONLY
11882 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
11883 @item CODE
11884 Section contains executable code only.
11885 @item DATA
11886 Section contains data only (no executable code).
11887 @item ROM
11888 Section will reside in ROM.
11889 @item CONSTRUCTOR
11890 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
11891 @item HAS_CONTENTS
11892 Section is not empty.
11893 @item NEVER_LOAD
11894 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
11895 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
11896 A notification to the linker that the section contains
11897 COFF shared library information.
11898 @item IS_COMMON
11899 Section contains common symbols.
11900 @end table
11901 @end table
11902 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
11903 @cindex read-only sections
11904 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
11905 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
11906 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
11907 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
11908 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
11909 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
11910 enhancement to debugging performance.
11911
11912 The default is off.
11913
11914 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
11915 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
11916 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
11917 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
11918
11919 @item show trust-readonly-sections
11920 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
11921 @end table
11922
11923 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
11924 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
11925 name and remembers it that way.
11926
11927 @cindex shared libraries
11928 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
11929 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
11930 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
11931
11932 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
11933 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
11934
11935 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
11936 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
11937 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
11938 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
11939 debugging a core file).
11940
11941 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
11942 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
11943
11944 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
11945 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
11946 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
11947
11948 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
11949 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
11950 particularly large or there are many of them.
11951
11952 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
11953 commands:
11954
11955 @table @code
11956 @kindex set auto-solib-add
11957 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
11958 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
11959 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
11960 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
11961 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
11962 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
11963 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
11964
11965 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
11966 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
11967 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
11968 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
11969 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
11970 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
11971 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
11972 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
11973 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
11974
11975 @kindex show auto-solib-add
11976 @item show auto-solib-add
11977 Display the current autoloading mode.
11978 @end table
11979
11980 @cindex load shared library
11981 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
11982 command:
11983
11984 @table @code
11985 @kindex info sharedlibrary
11986 @kindex info share
11987 @item info share
11988 @itemx info sharedlibrary
11989 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
11990
11991 @kindex sharedlibrary
11992 @kindex share
11993 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
11994 @itemx share @var{regex}
11995 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
11996 Unix regular expression.
11997 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
11998 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
11999 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
12000 loaded.
12001
12002 @item nosharedlibrary
12003 @kindex nosharedlibrary
12004 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
12005 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
12006 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
12007 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
12008 discarded.
12009 @end table
12010
12011 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
12012 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
12013 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
12014
12015 @table @code
12016 @item set stop-on-solib-events
12017 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
12018 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
12019 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
12020 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
12021 shared library.
12022
12023 @item show stop-on-solib-events
12024 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
12025 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
12026 library events happen.
12027 @end table
12028
12029 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
12030 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
12031 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
12032 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
12033 not.
12034
12035 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
12036 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
12037 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
12038 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
12039 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
12040
12041 @table @code
12042 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
12043 @cindex system root, alternate
12044 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
12045 @kindex set sysroot
12046 @item set sysroot @var{path}
12047 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
12048 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
12049 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
12050 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
12051 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
12052 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
12053 under @var{path}.
12054
12055 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
12056 sysroot}.
12057
12058 @cindex default system root
12059 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
12060 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
12061 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
12062 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
12063 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
12064 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
12065 location.
12066
12067 @kindex show sysroot
12068 @item show sysroot
12069 Display the current shared library prefix.
12070
12071 @kindex set solib-search-path
12072 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
12073 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
12074 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
12075 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
12076 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
12077 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
12078 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
12079 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
12080 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
12081 of shared library symbols.
12082
12083 @kindex show solib-search-path
12084 @item show solib-search-path
12085 Display the current shared library search path.
12086 @end table
12087
12088
12089 @node Separate Debug Files
12090 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
12091 @cindex separate debugging information files
12092 @cindex debugging information in separate files
12093 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
12094 @cindex debugging information directory, global
12095 @cindex global debugging information directory
12096 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
12097 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
12098
12099 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
12100 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
12101 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
12102 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
12103 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
12104 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
12105 install only when they need to debug a problem.
12106
12107 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
12108 file:
12109
12110 @itemize @bullet
12111 @item
12112 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
12113 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
12114 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
12115 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
12116 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
12117 debug link specifies a CRC32 checksum for the debug file, which
12118 @value{GDBN} uses to validate that the executable and the debug file
12119 came from the same build.
12120
12121 @item
12122 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
12123 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
12124 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
12125 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
12126 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
12127 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
12128 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
12129 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
12130 below.
12131 @end itemize
12132
12133 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
12134 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
12135
12136 @itemize @bullet
12137 @item
12138 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
12139 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
12140 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
12141 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
12142 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
12143
12144 @item
12145 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
12146 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
12147 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
12148 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
12149 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
12150 hex characters, not 10.)
12151 @end itemize
12152
12153 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
12154 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
12155 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
12156 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
12157 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
12158 debug information files, in the indicated order:
12159
12160 @itemize @minus
12161 @item
12162 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
12163 @item
12164 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
12165 @item
12166 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
12167 @item
12168 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
12169 @end itemize
12170
12171 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
12172 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
12173
12174 @table @code
12175
12176 @kindex set debug-file-directory
12177 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
12178 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12179 information files to @var{directory}.
12180
12181 @kindex show debug-file-directory
12182 @item show debug-file-directory
12183 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12184 information files.
12185
12186 @end table
12187
12188 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
12189 @cindex debug link sections
12190 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
12191 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
12192
12193 @itemize
12194 @item
12195 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
12196 a zero byte,
12197 @item
12198 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
12199 boundary within the section, and
12200 @item
12201 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
12202 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
12203 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
12204 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
12205 @end itemize
12206
12207 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
12208 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
12209 described above.
12210
12211 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
12212 @cindex build ID sections
12213 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
12214 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
12215 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
12216 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
12217 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
12218 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
12219 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
12220 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
12221 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
12222
12223 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
12224 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
12225 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
12226 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
12227 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
12228 in an ordinary executable.
12229
12230 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
12231 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
12232 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
12233 following commands:
12234
12235 @smallexample
12236 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
12237 @kbd{strip -g foo}
12238 @end smallexample
12239
12240 @noindent
12241 These commands remove the debugging
12242 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
12243 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
12244 two files:
12245
12246 @itemize @bullet
12247 @item
12248 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
12249 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
12250
12251 @smallexample
12252 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
12253 @end smallexample
12254
12255 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
12256 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
12257 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
12258 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
12259
12260 @item
12261 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
12262 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
12263 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
12264 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
12265 @end itemize
12266
12267 @noindent
12268
12269 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's for the debug
12270 link (different polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the
12271 simplest way to describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}
12272 sections is to give the complete code for a function that computes it:
12273
12274 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
12275 @smallexample
12276 unsigned long
12277 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
12278 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
12279 @{
12280 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
12281 @{
12282 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
12283 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
12284 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
12285 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
12286 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
12287 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
12288 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
12289 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
12290 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
12291 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
12292 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
12293 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
12294 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
12295 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
12296 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
12297 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
12298 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
12299 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
12300 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
12301 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
12302 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
12303 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
12304 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
12305 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
12306 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
12307 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
12308 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
12309 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
12310 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
12311 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
12312 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
12313 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
12314 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
12315 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
12316 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
12317 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
12318 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
12319 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
12320 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
12321 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
12322 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
12323 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
12324 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
12325 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
12326 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
12327 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
12328 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
12329 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
12330 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
12331 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
12332 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
12333 0x2d02ef8d
12334 @};
12335 unsigned char *end;
12336
12337 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12338 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
12339 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
12340 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12341 @}
12342 @end smallexample
12343
12344 @noindent
12345 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
12346
12347
12348 @node Symbol Errors
12349 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
12350
12351 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
12352 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
12353 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
12354 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
12355 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
12356 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
12357 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
12358 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
12359 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
12360 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12361 Messages}).
12362
12363 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
12364
12365 @table @code
12366 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
12367
12368 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
12369 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
12370 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
12371 in its outer scope blocks.
12372
12373 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
12374 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
12375 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
12376 function.
12377
12378 @item block at @var{address} out of order
12379
12380 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
12381 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
12382 do so.
12383
12384 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
12385 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
12386 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
12387 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12388 Messages}.)
12389
12390 @item bad block start address patched
12391
12392 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
12393 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
12394 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
12395
12396 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
12397 starting on the previous source line.
12398
12399 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
12400
12401 @cindex foo
12402 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
12403 larger than the size of the string table.
12404
12405 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
12406 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
12407 with this name.
12408
12409 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
12410
12411 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
12412 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
12413 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
12414
12415 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
12416 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
12417 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
12418 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
12419 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
12420 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
12421
12422 @item stub type has NULL name
12423
12424 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
12425
12426 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
12427 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
12428 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
12429 it.
12430
12431 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
12432
12433 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
12434
12435 @end table
12436
12437 @node Targets
12438 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
12439
12440 @cindex debugging target
12441 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
12442
12443 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
12444 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
12445 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
12446 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
12447 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
12448 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
12449 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
12450 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
12451
12452 @cindex target architecture
12453 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
12454 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
12455 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
12456 command.
12457
12458 @table @code
12459 @kindex set architecture
12460 @kindex show architecture
12461 @item set architecture @var{arch}
12462 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
12463 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
12464 supported architectures.
12465
12466 @item show architecture
12467 Show the current target architecture.
12468
12469 @item set processor
12470 @itemx processor
12471 @kindex set processor
12472 @kindex show processor
12473 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
12474 and @code{show architecture}.
12475 @end table
12476
12477 @menu
12478 * Active Targets:: Active targets
12479 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
12480 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
12481 @end menu
12482
12483 @node Active Targets
12484 @section Active Targets
12485
12486 @cindex stacking targets
12487 @cindex active targets
12488 @cindex multiple targets
12489
12490 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
12491 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
12492 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
12493 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
12494 a core file.
12495
12496 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
12497 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
12498 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
12499 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
12500 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
12501 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
12502 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
12503 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
12504 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
12505
12506 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
12507 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
12508 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
12509 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
12510 process target is active.
12511
12512 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
12513 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
12514 Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
12515 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
12516 Process}).
12517
12518 @node Target Commands
12519 @section Commands for Managing Targets
12520
12521 @table @code
12522 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
12523 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
12524 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
12525 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
12526 protocol of the target machine.
12527
12528 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
12529 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
12530 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
12531
12532 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
12533 after executing the command.
12534
12535 @kindex help target
12536 @item help target
12537 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
12538 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
12539 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
12540
12541 @item help target @var{name}
12542 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
12543 select it.
12544
12545 @kindex set gnutarget
12546 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
12547 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
12548 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
12549 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
12550 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
12551 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
12552
12553 @quotation
12554 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
12555 you must know the actual BFD name.
12556 @end quotation
12557
12558 @noindent
12559 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
12560
12561 @kindex show gnutarget
12562 @item show gnutarget
12563 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
12564 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
12565 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
12566 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
12567 @end table
12568
12569 @cindex common targets
12570 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
12571 configuration):
12572
12573 @table @code
12574 @kindex target
12575 @item target exec @var{program}
12576 @cindex executable file target
12577 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
12578 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
12579
12580 @item target core @var{filename}
12581 @cindex core dump file target
12582 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
12583 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
12584
12585 @item target remote @var{medium}
12586 @cindex remote target
12587 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
12588 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
12589 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
12590
12591 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
12592 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
12593
12594 @smallexample
12595 target remote /dev/ttya
12596 @end smallexample
12597
12598 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
12599 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
12600 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
12601 clobbered by the download.
12602
12603 @item target sim
12604 @cindex built-in simulator target
12605 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
12606 In general,
12607 @smallexample
12608 target sim
12609 load
12610 run
12611 @end smallexample
12612 @noindent
12613 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
12614 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
12615 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
12616 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
12617 Processors}.
12618
12619 @end table
12620
12621 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
12622
12623 @table @code
12624
12625 @item target nrom @var{dev}
12626 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
12627 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
12628
12629 @end table
12630
12631 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
12632 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
12633
12634 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
12635 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
12636 various aspects of this process.
12637
12638 @table @code
12639
12640 @item set hash
12641 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12642 @cindex hash mark while downloading
12643 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
12644 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
12645 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
12646 monitor.
12647
12648 @item show hash
12649 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12650 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
12651
12652 @item set debug monitor
12653 @kindex set debug monitor
12654 @cindex display remote monitor communications
12655 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
12656 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12657
12658 @item show debug monitor
12659 @kindex show debug monitor
12660 Show the current status of displaying communications between
12661 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12662 @end table
12663
12664 @table @code
12665
12666 @kindex load @var{filename}
12667 @item load @var{filename}
12668 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
12669 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
12670 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
12671 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
12672 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
12673 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12674
12675 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
12676 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
12677 target is @dots{}}''
12678
12679 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
12680 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
12681 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
12682 specifies a fixed address.
12683 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
12684
12685 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
12686 load programs into flash memory.
12687
12688 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
12689 @end table
12690
12691 @node Byte Order
12692 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
12693
12694 @cindex choosing target byte order
12695 @cindex target byte order
12696
12697 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
12698 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
12699 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
12700 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
12701 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
12702 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
12703
12704 @table @code
12705 @kindex set endian
12706 @item set endian big
12707 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
12708
12709 @item set endian little
12710 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
12711
12712 @item set endian auto
12713 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
12714 executable.
12715
12716 @item show endian
12717 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
12718
12719 @end table
12720
12721 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
12722 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
12723 target system.
12724
12725
12726 @node Remote Debugging
12727 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
12728 @cindex remote debugging
12729
12730 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
12731 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
12732 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
12733 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
12734 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
12735
12736 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
12737 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
12738 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
12739 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
12740 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
12741 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
12742
12743 Other remote targets may be available in your
12744 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
12745
12746 @menu
12747 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
12748 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
12749 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
12750 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
12751 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
12752 @end menu
12753
12754 @node Connecting
12755 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
12756
12757 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
12758 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
12759 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
12760 program as the first argument.
12761
12762 @cindex @code{target remote}
12763 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
12764 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
12765 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
12766 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
12767 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
12768 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
12769
12770 @table @code
12771
12772 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
12773 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
12774 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
12775 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
12776
12777 @smallexample
12778 target remote /dev/ttyb
12779 @end smallexample
12780
12781 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
12782 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
12783 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
12784 @code{target} command.
12785
12786 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
12787 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12788 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
12789 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
12790 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
12791 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
12792 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
12793 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
12794 target.
12795
12796 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
12797 @code{manyfarms}:
12798
12799 @smallexample
12800 target remote manyfarms:2828
12801 @end smallexample
12802
12803 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
12804 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
12805 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
12806 port 1234 on your local machine:
12807
12808 @smallexample
12809 target remote :1234
12810 @end smallexample
12811 @noindent
12812
12813 Note that the colon is still required here.
12814
12815 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12816 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
12817 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
12818 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
12819
12820 @smallexample
12821 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
12822 @end smallexample
12823
12824 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
12825 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
12826 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
12827 cause havoc with your debugging session.
12828
12829 @item target remote | @var{command}
12830 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
12831 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
12832 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
12833 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
12834 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
12835 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
12836 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
12837 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
12838
12839 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
12840 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
12841 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
12842
12843 @end table
12844
12845 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
12846 commands to examine and change data and to step and continue the
12847 remote program.
12848
12849 @cindex interrupting remote programs
12850 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
12851 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
12852 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
12853 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
12854 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
12855 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
12856
12857 @smallexample
12858 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
12859 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
12860 @end smallexample
12861
12862 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
12863 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
12864 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
12865 goes back to waiting.
12866
12867 @table @code
12868 @kindex detach (remote)
12869 @item detach
12870 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
12871 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
12872 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
12873 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
12874 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
12875
12876 @kindex disconnect
12877 @item disconnect
12878 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
12879 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
12880 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
12881 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
12882 another target.
12883
12884 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12885 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
12886 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
12887 @kindex monitor
12888 @item monitor @var{cmd}
12889 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
12890 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
12891 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
12892 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
12893 and implement.
12894 @end table
12895
12896 @node File Transfer
12897 @section Sending files to a remote system
12898 @cindex remote target, file transfer
12899 @cindex file transfer
12900 @cindex sending files to remote systems
12901
12902 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
12903 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
12904 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
12905 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
12906 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
12907 the only way to upload or download files.
12908
12909 Not all remote targets support these commands.
12910
12911 @table @code
12912 @kindex remote put
12913 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
12914 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
12915 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
12916
12917 @kindex remote get
12918 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
12919 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
12920 on the host system.
12921
12922 @kindex remote delete
12923 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
12924 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
12925
12926 @end table
12927
12928 @node Server
12929 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
12930
12931 @kindex gdbserver
12932 @cindex remote connection without stubs
12933 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
12934 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
12935 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
12936
12937 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
12938 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
12939 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
12940 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
12941 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
12942 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
12943 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
12944 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
12945 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
12946 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
12947 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
12948 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
12949 choice for debugging.
12950
12951 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
12952 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
12953 protocol.
12954
12955 @quotation
12956 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
12957 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
12958 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
12959 target system with the same privileges as the user running
12960 @code{gdbserver}.
12961 @end quotation
12962
12963 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
12964 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
12965
12966 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
12967 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
12968 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
12969 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
12970 system does all the symbol handling.
12971
12972 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
12973 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
12974 syntax is:
12975
12976 @smallexample
12977 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
12978 @end smallexample
12979
12980 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
12981 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
12982 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
12983 @file{/dev/com1}:
12984
12985 @smallexample
12986 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
12987 @end smallexample
12988
12989 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
12990 with it.
12991
12992 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
12993
12994 @smallexample
12995 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
12996 @end smallexample
12997
12998 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
12999 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
13000 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
13001 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
13002 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
13003 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
13004 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
13005 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
13006 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
13007 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
13008 @code{target remote} command.
13009
13010 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
13011
13012 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
13013 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
13014
13015 @smallexample
13016 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
13017 @end smallexample
13018
13019 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
13020 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
13021
13022 @pindex pidof
13023 @cindex attach to a program by name
13024 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
13025 @code{pidof} utility:
13026
13027 @smallexample
13028 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
13029 @end smallexample
13030
13031 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
13032 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
13033 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
13034
13035 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
13036 @cindex gdbserver, multiple processes
13037 @cindex multiple processes with gdbserver
13038
13039 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
13040 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
13041 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
13042 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
13043
13044 If you connect using @code{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
13045 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
13046 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
13047 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
13048 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
13049 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
13050 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
13051 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
13052 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
13053
13054 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
13055 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
13056 Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
13057 the program you want to debug.
13058
13059 @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit in multi-process mode.
13060 You can terminate it by using @code{monitor exit}
13061 (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
13062
13063 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
13064
13065 You can include @option{--debug} on the @code{gdbserver} command line.
13066 @code{gdbserver} will display extra status information about the debugging
13067 process. This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and
13068 for bug reports to the developers.
13069
13070 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
13071
13072 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
13073
13074 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
13075 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
13076 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
13077 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
13078
13079 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
13080 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
13081 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
13082 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
13083 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
13084 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
13085 programs.
13086
13087 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13088 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
13089 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
13090 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
13091 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
13092 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
13093 already on the target.
13094
13095 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
13096 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
13097 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
13098
13099 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
13100 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
13101 Here are the available commands.
13102
13103 @table @code
13104 @item monitor help
13105 List the available monitor commands.
13106
13107 @item monitor set debug 0
13108 @itemx monitor set debug 1
13109 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
13110
13111 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
13112 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
13113 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
13114 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
13115
13116 @item monitor exit
13117 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
13118 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
13119 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
13120 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
13121 of a multi-process mode debug session.
13122
13123 @end table
13124
13125 @node Remote Configuration
13126 @section Remote Configuration
13127
13128 @kindex set remote
13129 @kindex show remote
13130 This section documents the configuration options available when
13131 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
13132 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
13133 system-call-allowed}.
13134
13135 @table @code
13136 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
13137 @cindex address size for remote targets
13138 @cindex bits in remote address
13139 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
13140 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
13141 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
13142 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
13143
13144 @item show remoteaddresssize
13145 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
13146
13147 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
13148 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
13149 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
13150 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
13151 remote targets.
13152
13153 @item show remotebaud
13154 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
13155
13156 @item set remotebreak
13157 @cindex interrupt remote programs
13158 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
13159 @anchor{set remotebreak}
13160 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
13161 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
13162 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
13163 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
13164 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
13165
13166 @item show remotebreak
13167 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
13168 interrupt the remote program.
13169
13170 @item set remoteflow on
13171 @itemx set remoteflow off
13172 @kindex set remoteflow
13173 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
13174 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
13175
13176 @item show remoteflow
13177 @kindex show remoteflow
13178 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
13179
13180 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
13181 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
13182 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
13183 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
13184 @code{ascii}.
13185
13186 @item show remotelogbase
13187 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
13188 protocol.
13189
13190 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
13191 @cindex record serial communications on file
13192 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
13193 default is not to record at all.
13194
13195 @item show remotelogfile.
13196 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
13197 serial communications.
13198
13199 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
13200 @cindex timeout for serial communications
13201 @cindex remote timeout
13202 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
13203 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
13204
13205 @item show remotetimeout
13206 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
13207 responses.
13208
13209 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
13210 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
13211 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
13212 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
13213 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
13214 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
13215 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
13216 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
13217
13218 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
13219 @itemx show remote exec-file
13220 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
13221 @cindex executable file, for remote target
13222 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
13223 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
13224 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
13225 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
13226 @end table
13227
13228 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
13229 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
13230 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
13231 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
13232 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
13233 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
13234 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
13235 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
13236 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
13237
13238 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
13239 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
13240 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
13241 @value{GDBN} developers.
13242
13243 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
13244 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
13245 are:
13246
13247 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
13248 @item Command Name
13249 @tab Remote Packet
13250 @tab Related Features
13251
13252 @item @code{fetch-register}
13253 @tab @code{p}
13254 @tab @code{info registers}
13255
13256 @item @code{set-register}
13257 @tab @code{P}
13258 @tab @code{set}
13259
13260 @item @code{binary-download}
13261 @tab @code{X}
13262 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
13263
13264 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
13265 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
13266 @tab @code{info auxv}
13267
13268 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
13269 @tab @code{qSymbol}
13270 @tab Detecting multiple threads
13271
13272 @item @code{attach}
13273 @tab @code{vAttach}
13274 @tab @code{attach}
13275
13276 @item @code{verbose-resume}
13277 @tab @code{vCont}
13278 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
13279
13280 @item @code{run}
13281 @tab @code{vRun}
13282 @tab @code{run}
13283
13284 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
13285 @tab @code{Z0}
13286 @tab @code{break}
13287
13288 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
13289 @tab @code{Z1}
13290 @tab @code{hbreak}
13291
13292 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
13293 @tab @code{Z2}
13294 @tab @code{watch}
13295
13296 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
13297 @tab @code{Z3}
13298 @tab @code{rwatch}
13299
13300 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
13301 @tab @code{Z4}
13302 @tab @code{awatch}
13303
13304 @item @code{target-features}
13305 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
13306 @tab @code{set architecture}
13307
13308 @item @code{library-info}
13309 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
13310 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
13311
13312 @item @code{memory-map}
13313 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
13314 @tab @code{info mem}
13315
13316 @item @code{read-spu-object}
13317 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
13318 @tab @code{info spu}
13319
13320 @item @code{write-spu-object}
13321 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
13322 @tab @code{info spu}
13323
13324 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
13325 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
13326 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
13327
13328 @item @code{supported-packets}
13329 @tab @code{qSupported}
13330 @tab Remote communications parameters
13331
13332 @item @code{pass-signals}
13333 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
13334 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
13335
13336 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
13337 @tab @code{vFile:close}
13338 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13339
13340 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
13341 @tab @code{vFile:open}
13342 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13343
13344 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
13345 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
13346 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13347
13348 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
13349 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
13350 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13351
13352 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
13353 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
13354 @tab @code{remote delete}
13355 @end multitable
13356
13357 @node Remote Stub
13358 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
13359
13360 @cindex debugging stub, example
13361 @cindex remote stub, example
13362 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
13363 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
13364 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
13365 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
13366 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
13367 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
13368 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
13369 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
13370
13371 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
13372 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
13373 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
13374 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
13375 program, you need:
13376
13377 @enumerate
13378 @item
13379 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
13380 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
13381 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
13382
13383 @item
13384 A C subroutine library to support your program's
13385 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
13386
13387 @item
13388 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
13389 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
13390 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
13391 documentation.
13392 @end enumerate
13393
13394 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
13395 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
13396 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
13397
13398 @table @emph
13399 @item On the host,
13400 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
13401 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
13402 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13403
13404 @item On the target,
13405 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
13406 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
13407 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
13408
13409 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
13410 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
13411 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
13412 @end table
13413
13414 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
13415 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
13416 @sc{sparc} boards.
13417
13418 @cindex remote serial stub list
13419 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
13420
13421 @table @code
13422
13423 @item i386-stub.c
13424 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
13425 @cindex Intel
13426 @cindex i386
13427 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
13428
13429 @item m68k-stub.c
13430 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
13431 @cindex Motorola 680x0
13432 @cindex m680x0
13433 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
13434
13435 @item sh-stub.c
13436 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
13437 @cindex Renesas
13438 @cindex SH
13439 For Renesas SH architectures.
13440
13441 @item sparc-stub.c
13442 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
13443 @cindex Sparc
13444 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
13445
13446 @item sparcl-stub.c
13447 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
13448 @cindex Fujitsu
13449 @cindex SparcLite
13450 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
13451
13452 @end table
13453
13454 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
13455 recently added stubs.
13456
13457 @menu
13458 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
13459 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
13460 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
13461 @end menu
13462
13463 @node Stub Contents
13464 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
13465
13466 @cindex remote serial stub
13467 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
13468 subroutines:
13469
13470 @table @code
13471 @item set_debug_traps
13472 @findex set_debug_traps
13473 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
13474 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
13475 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
13476 beginning of your program.
13477
13478 @item handle_exception
13479 @findex handle_exception
13480 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
13481 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
13482 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
13483 run when a trap is triggered.
13484
13485 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
13486 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
13487 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
13488 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
13489 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
13490 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
13491 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
13492 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
13493 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
13494 machine.
13495
13496 @item breakpoint
13497 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
13498 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
13499 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
13500 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
13501 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
13502 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
13503 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
13504 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
13505 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
13506 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
13507 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
13508
13509 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
13510 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
13511 start of your debugging session.
13512 @end table
13513
13514 @node Bootstrapping
13515 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
13516
13517 @cindex remote stub, support routines
13518 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
13519 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
13520 debugging target machine.
13521
13522 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
13523 serial port.
13524
13525 @table @code
13526 @item int getDebugChar()
13527 @findex getDebugChar
13528 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
13529 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
13530 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13531
13532 @item void putDebugChar(int)
13533 @findex putDebugChar
13534 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
13535 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
13536 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13537 @end table
13538
13539 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
13540 @cindex interrupting remote targets
13541 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
13542 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
13543 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
13544 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
13545 remote system to stop.
13546
13547 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
13548 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
13549 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
13550 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
13551
13552 Other routines you need to supply are:
13553
13554 @table @code
13555 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
13556 @findex exceptionHandler
13557 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
13558 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
13559 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
13560 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
13561 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
13562 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
13563 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
13564 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
13565 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
13566 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
13567 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
13568 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
13569 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
13570
13571 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
13572 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
13573 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
13574 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
13575 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
13576
13577 @item void flush_i_cache()
13578 @findex flush_i_cache
13579 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
13580 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
13581 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
13582
13583 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
13584 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
13585 @end table
13586
13587 @noindent
13588 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
13589
13590 @table @code
13591 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
13592 @findex memset
13593 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
13594 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
13595 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
13596 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
13597 @end table
13598
13599 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
13600 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
13601 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
13602 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
13603
13604
13605 @node Debug Session
13606 @subsection Putting it All Together
13607
13608 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
13609 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
13610 steps.
13611
13612 @enumerate
13613 @item
13614 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
13615 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
13616 @display
13617 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
13618 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
13619 @end display
13620
13621 @item
13622 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
13623
13624 @smallexample
13625 set_debug_traps();
13626 breakpoint();
13627 @end smallexample
13628
13629 @item
13630 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
13631 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
13632
13633 @smallexample
13634 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
13635 @end smallexample
13636
13637 @noindent
13638 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
13639 function in your program, that function is called when
13640 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
13641 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
13642 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
13643
13644 @item
13645 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
13646 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
13647
13648 @item
13649 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
13650 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
13651
13652 @item
13653 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
13654 @c document that. FIXME.
13655 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
13656 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
13657
13658 @item
13659 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
13660 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13661
13662 @end enumerate
13663
13664 @node Configurations
13665 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
13666
13667 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
13668 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
13669 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
13670
13671 There are three major categories of configurations: native
13672 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
13673 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
13674 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
13675 are quite different from each other.
13676
13677 @menu
13678 * Native::
13679 * Embedded OS::
13680 * Embedded Processors::
13681 * Architectures::
13682 @end menu
13683
13684 @node Native
13685 @section Native
13686
13687 This section describes details specific to particular native
13688 configurations.
13689
13690 @menu
13691 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
13692 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
13693 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
13694 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
13695 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
13696 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
13697 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
13698 @end menu
13699
13700 @node HP-UX
13701 @subsection HP-UX
13702
13703 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
13704 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
13705 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
13706
13707
13708 @node BSD libkvm Interface
13709 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
13710
13711 @cindex libkvm
13712 @cindex kernel memory image
13713 @cindex kernel crash dump
13714
13715 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
13716 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
13717 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
13718 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
13719 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
13720 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
13721 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
13722 @code{kvm} target:
13723
13724 @smallexample
13725 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
13726 @end smallexample
13727
13728 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
13729 argument:
13730
13731 @smallexample
13732 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
13733 @end smallexample
13734
13735 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
13736 available:
13737
13738 @table @code
13739 @kindex kvm
13740 @item kvm pcb
13741 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
13742
13743 @item kvm proc
13744 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
13745 modern FreeBSD systems.
13746 @end table
13747
13748 @node SVR4 Process Information
13749 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
13750 @cindex /proc
13751 @cindex examine process image
13752 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
13753
13754 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
13755 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
13756 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
13757 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
13758 proc} is available to report information about the process running
13759 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
13760 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
13761 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
13762 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
13763
13764 @table @code
13765 @kindex info proc
13766 @cindex process ID
13767 @item info proc
13768 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
13769 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
13770 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
13771 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
13772 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
13773 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
13774 executable file's absolute file name.
13775
13776 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
13777 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
13778 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
13779 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
13780 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
13781 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
13782
13783 @item info proc mappings
13784 @cindex memory address space mappings
13785 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
13786 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
13787 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
13788 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
13789 memory access rights to that range.
13790
13791 @item info proc stat
13792 @itemx info proc status
13793 @cindex process detailed status information
13794 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
13795 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
13796 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
13797 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
13798 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
13799 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
13800 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
13801
13802 @item info proc all
13803 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
13804 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
13805
13806 @ignore
13807 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
13808 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
13809 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
13810 @kindex info proc times
13811 @item info proc times
13812 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
13813 its children.
13814
13815 @kindex info proc id
13816 @item info proc id
13817 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
13818 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
13819 @end ignore
13820
13821 @item set procfs-trace
13822 @kindex set procfs-trace
13823 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
13824 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
13825
13826 @item show procfs-trace
13827 @kindex show procfs-trace
13828 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
13829
13830 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
13831 @kindex set procfs-file
13832 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
13833 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
13834 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
13835 standard output.
13836
13837 @item show procfs-file
13838 @kindex show procfs-file
13839 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
13840
13841 @item proc-trace-entry
13842 @itemx proc-trace-exit
13843 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
13844 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
13845 @kindex proc-trace-entry
13846 @kindex proc-trace-exit
13847 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
13848 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
13849 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
13850 from the @code{syscall} interface.
13851
13852 @item info pidlist
13853 @kindex info pidlist
13854 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
13855 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
13856 processes and all the threads within each process.
13857
13858 @item info meminfo
13859 @kindex info meminfo
13860 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
13861 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
13862 @end table
13863
13864 @node DJGPP Native
13865 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
13866 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
13867 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
13868 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
13869
13870 @cindex DPMI
13871 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
13872 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
13873 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
13874 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
13875
13876 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
13877 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
13878 subsection describes those commands.
13879
13880 @table @code
13881 @kindex info dos
13882 @item info dos
13883 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
13884 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13885
13886 @kindex sysinfo
13887 @cindex MS-DOS system info
13888 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
13889 @item info dos sysinfo
13890 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
13891 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
13892 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
13893
13894 @cindex GDT
13895 @cindex LDT
13896 @cindex IDT
13897 @cindex segment descriptor tables
13898 @cindex descriptor tables display
13899 @item info dos gdt
13900 @itemx info dos ldt
13901 @itemx info dos idt
13902 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
13903 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
13904 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
13905 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
13906 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
13907 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
13908 rights.
13909
13910 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
13911 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
13912 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
13913 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
13914 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
13915
13916 @cindex garbled pointers
13917 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
13918 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
13919 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
13920 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
13921 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
13922 debugged program's data segment:
13923
13924 @smallexample
13925 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
13926 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
13927 @end smallexample
13928
13929 @noindent
13930 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
13931 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
13932
13933 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
13934 @item info dos pde
13935 @itemx info dos pte
13936 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
13937 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
13938 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
13939 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
13940 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
13941 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
13942 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
13943 that is currently in use.
13944
13945 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
13946 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
13947 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
13948 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
13949 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
13950 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
13951 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
13952
13953 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
13954 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
13955 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
13956 controller.
13957
13958 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
13959
13960 @cindex physical address from linear address
13961 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
13962 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
13963 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
13964 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
13965 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
13966 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
13967 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
13968
13969 @smallexample
13970 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
13971 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
13972 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
13973 @end smallexample
13974
13975 @noindent
13976 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
13977 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
13978 attributes of that page.
13979
13980 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
13981 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
13982 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
13983 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
13984 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
13985 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
13986
13987 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
13988 transfer buffer:
13989
13990 @smallexample
13991 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
13992 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
13993 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
13994 @end smallexample
13995
13996 @noindent
13997 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
13998 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
13999 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
14000 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
14001 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
14002
14003 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
14004 @end table
14005
14006 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
14007 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
14008 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
14009 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
14010
14011 @table @code
14012 @kindex set com1base
14013 @kindex set com1irq
14014 @kindex set com2base
14015 @kindex set com2irq
14016 @kindex set com3base
14017 @kindex set com3irq
14018 @kindex set com4base
14019 @kindex set com4irq
14020 @item set com1base @var{addr}
14021 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
14022 port.
14023
14024 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
14025 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
14026 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
14027
14028 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
14029 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
14030 other 3 COM ports.
14031
14032 @kindex show com1base
14033 @kindex show com1irq
14034 @kindex show com2base
14035 @kindex show com2irq
14036 @kindex show com3base
14037 @kindex show com3irq
14038 @kindex show com4base
14039 @kindex show com4irq
14040 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
14041 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
14042 lines used by the COM ports.
14043
14044 @item info serial
14045 @kindex info serial
14046 @cindex DOS serial port status
14047 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
14048 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
14049 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
14050 counts of various errors encountered so far.
14051 @end table
14052
14053
14054 @node Cygwin Native
14055 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
14056 @cindex MS Windows debugging
14057 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
14058 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
14059
14060 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
14061 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
14062 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this section.
14063 Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is described in
14064 @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
14065
14066 @table @code
14067 @kindex info w32
14068 @item info w32
14069 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
14070 information about the target system and important OS structures.
14071
14072 @item info w32 selector
14073 This command displays information returned by
14074 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
14075 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
14076 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
14077 Without argument, this command displays information
14078 about the six segment registers.
14079
14080 @kindex info dll
14081 @item info dll
14082 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
14083
14084 @kindex dll-symbols
14085 @item dll-symbols
14086 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
14087 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
14088
14089 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
14090 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
14091 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
14092 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
14093 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
14094 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
14095 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
14096 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
14097 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
14098 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
14099 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
14100
14101 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
14102 @item show cygwin-exceptions
14103 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
14104 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
14105
14106 @kindex set new-console
14107 @item set new-console @var{mode}
14108 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
14109 be started in a new console on next start.
14110 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
14111 be started in the same console as the debugger.
14112
14113 @kindex show new-console
14114 @item show new-console
14115 Displays whether a new console is used
14116 when the debuggee is started.
14117
14118 @kindex set new-group
14119 @item set new-group @var{mode}
14120 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
14121 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
14122 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
14123 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
14124
14125 @kindex show new-group
14126 @item show new-group
14127 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
14128
14129 @kindex set debugevents
14130 @item set debugevents
14131 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
14132 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
14133 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
14134 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
14135 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
14136
14137 @kindex set debugexec
14138 @item set debugexec
14139 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
14140 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
14141
14142 @kindex set debugexceptions
14143 @item set debugexceptions
14144 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
14145 debuggee seen by the debugger.
14146
14147 @kindex set debugmemory
14148 @item set debugmemory
14149 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
14150 and writes by the debugger.
14151
14152 @kindex set shell
14153 @item set shell
14154 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
14155 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
14156
14157 @kindex show shell
14158 @item show shell
14159 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
14160
14161 @end table
14162
14163 @menu
14164 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
14165 @end menu
14166
14167 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
14168 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
14169 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
14170 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
14171
14172 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
14173 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
14174 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
14175 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
14176 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
14177 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
14178 ``minimal symbols''.
14179
14180 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
14181 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
14182 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
14183 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
14184 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
14185 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
14186 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
14187 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
14188 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
14189 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
14190
14191 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
14192
14193 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
14194 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
14195 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
14196 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
14197 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
14198 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
14199 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
14200 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
14201 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
14202
14203 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
14204 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
14205 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
14206 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
14207 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
14208 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
14209
14210 @smallexample
14211 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
14212 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
14213
14214 Non-debugging symbols:
14215 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
14216 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
14217 @end smallexample
14218
14219 @smallexample
14220 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
14221 All functions matching regular expression "!":
14222
14223 Non-debugging symbols:
14224 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
14225 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
14226 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
14227 [etc...]
14228 @end smallexample
14229
14230 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
14231
14232 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
14233 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
14234 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
14235 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
14236 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
14237 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
14238 a function within a DLL without a running program.
14239
14240 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
14241 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
14242 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
14243 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
14244 problem:
14245
14246 @smallexample
14247 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
14248 $1 = 268572168
14249 @end smallexample
14250
14251 @smallexample
14252 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
14253 0x10021610: "\230y\""
14254 @end smallexample
14255
14256 And two possible solutions:
14257
14258 @smallexample
14259 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
14260 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14261 @end smallexample
14262
14263 @smallexample
14264 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
14265 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
14266 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
14267 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
14268 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
14269 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14270 @end smallexample
14271
14272 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
14273 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
14274 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
14275 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
14276 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
14277
14278 @smallexample
14279 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
14280 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
14281 @end smallexample
14282
14283 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
14284 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
14285 safe.
14286
14287 @node Hurd Native
14288 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
14289 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
14290
14291 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
14292 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
14293
14294 @table @code
14295 @item set signals
14296 @itemx set sigs
14297 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
14298 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14299 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
14300 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
14301 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
14302 @code{signals}.
14303
14304 @item show signals
14305 @itemx show sigs
14306 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
14307 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14308 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
14309
14310 @item set signal-thread
14311 @itemx set sigthread
14312 @kindex set signal-thread
14313 @kindex set sigthread
14314 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
14315 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
14316 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
14317 signal-thread}.
14318
14319 @item show signal-thread
14320 @itemx show sigthread
14321 @kindex show signal-thread
14322 @kindex show sigthread
14323 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
14324 delivered a signal.
14325
14326 @item set stopped
14327 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14328 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
14329 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
14330 continued by delivering a signal to it.
14331
14332 @item show stopped
14333 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14334 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
14335 stopped.
14336
14337 @item set exceptions
14338 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14339 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
14340 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
14341 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
14342 trapping on.
14343
14344 @item show exceptions
14345 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14346 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
14347
14348 @item set task pause
14349 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
14350 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14351 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14352 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
14353 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
14354 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
14355 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
14356 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
14357 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
14358
14359 @item show task pause
14360 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
14361 Show the current state of task suspension.
14362
14363 @item set task detach-suspend-count
14364 @cindex task suspend count
14365 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14366 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
14367 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
14368
14369 @item show task detach-suspend-count
14370 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
14371
14372 @item set task exception-port
14373 @itemx set task excp
14374 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14375 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
14376 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
14377 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
14378
14379 @item set noninvasive
14380 @cindex noninvasive task options
14381 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
14382 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
14383 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
14384 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
14385
14386 @item info send-rights
14387 @itemx info receive-rights
14388 @itemx info port-rights
14389 @itemx info port-sets
14390 @itemx info dead-names
14391 @itemx info ports
14392 @itemx info psets
14393 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14394 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14395 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14396 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14397 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14398 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
14399 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
14400 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
14401 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
14402
14403 @item set thread pause
14404 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
14405 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14406 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14407 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
14408 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
14409 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
14410 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
14411 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
14412 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
14413 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
14414 only the current thread.
14415
14416 @item show thread pause
14417 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
14418 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
14419
14420 @item set thread run
14421 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14422
14423 @item show thread run
14424 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14425
14426 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
14427 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14428 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14429 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
14430 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
14431 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
14432 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
14433
14434 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
14435 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
14436 detaching.
14437
14438 @item set thread exception-port
14439 @itemx set thread excp
14440 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
14441 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
14442 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
14443
14444 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
14445 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
14446 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
14447 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
14448
14449 @item set thread default
14450 @itemx show thread default
14451 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14452 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
14453 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
14454 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
14455 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
14456 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
14457 the non-default commands.
14458 @end table
14459
14460
14461 @node Neutrino
14462 @subsection QNX Neutrino
14463 @cindex QNX Neutrino
14464
14465 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
14466 Neutrino target:
14467
14468 @table @code
14469 @item set debug nto-debug
14470 @kindex set debug nto-debug
14471 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
14472 Neutrino support.
14473
14474 @item show debug nto-debug
14475 @kindex show debug nto-debug
14476 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
14477 @end table
14478
14479
14480 @node Embedded OS
14481 @section Embedded Operating Systems
14482
14483 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
14484 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
14485 architectures.
14486
14487 @menu
14488 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14489 @end menu
14490
14491 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
14492 various real-time operating systems.
14493
14494 @node VxWorks
14495 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14496
14497 @cindex VxWorks
14498
14499 @table @code
14500
14501 @kindex target vxworks
14502 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
14503 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
14504 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
14505
14506 @end table
14507
14508 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
14509 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
14510
14511 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
14512 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
14513 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14514 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
14515 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
14516 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
14517 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
14518
14519 @table @code
14520 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
14521 @kindex vxworks-timeout
14522 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
14523 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14524 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
14525 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
14526 of a thin network line.
14527 @end table
14528
14529 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
14530 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
14531 procedures.
14532
14533 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
14534 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
14535 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
14536 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
14537 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
14538 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
14539 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
14540 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
14541 manual.
14542 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
14543
14544 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
14545 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14546 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
14547 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
14548
14549 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14550
14551 @smallexample
14552 (vxgdb)
14553 @end smallexample
14554
14555 @menu
14556 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
14557 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
14558 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
14559 @end menu
14560
14561 @node VxWorks Connection
14562 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
14563
14564 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
14565 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
14566
14567 @smallexample
14568 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
14569 @end smallexample
14570
14571 @need 750
14572 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14573
14574 @smallexample
14575 Attaching remote machine across net...
14576 Connected to tt.
14577 @end smallexample
14578
14579 @need 1000
14580 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
14581 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
14582 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
14583 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
14584 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
14585
14586 @smallexample
14587 prog.o: No such file or directory.
14588 @end smallexample
14589
14590 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
14591 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
14592 command again.
14593
14594 @node VxWorks Download
14595 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
14596
14597 @cindex download to VxWorks
14598 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
14599 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
14600 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
14601 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
14602 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
14603 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
14604 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
14605 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
14606 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
14607 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
14608 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
14609 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
14610 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
14611 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
14612 program, type this on VxWorks:
14613
14614 @smallexample
14615 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
14616 @end smallexample
14617
14618 @noindent
14619 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14620
14621 @smallexample
14622 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
14623 (vxgdb) load prog.o
14624 @end smallexample
14625
14626 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
14627
14628 @smallexample
14629 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
14630 @end smallexample
14631
14632 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
14633 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
14634 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
14635 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
14636 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
14637 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
14638 table.)
14639
14640 @node VxWorks Attach
14641 @subsubsection Running Tasks
14642
14643 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
14644 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
14645 follows:
14646
14647 @smallexample
14648 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
14649 @end smallexample
14650
14651 @noindent
14652 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
14653 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
14654 the time of attachment.
14655
14656 @node Embedded Processors
14657 @section Embedded Processors
14658
14659 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
14660 configurations.
14661
14662 @cindex send command to simulator
14663 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
14664 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
14665
14666 @table @code
14667 @item sim @var{command}
14668 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
14669 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
14670 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
14671 acceptable commands.
14672 @end table
14673
14674
14675 @menu
14676 * ARM:: ARM RDI
14677 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
14678 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
14679 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
14680 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
14681 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
14682 * PowerPC:: PowerPC
14683 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
14684 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
14685 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
14686 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
14687 * CRIS:: CRIS
14688 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
14689 @end menu
14690
14691 @node ARM
14692 @subsection ARM
14693 @cindex ARM RDI
14694
14695 @table @code
14696 @kindex target rdi
14697 @item target rdi @var{dev}
14698 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
14699 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
14700 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
14701
14702 @kindex target rdp
14703 @item target rdp @var{dev}
14704 ARM Demon monitor.
14705
14706 @end table
14707
14708 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
14709
14710 @table @code
14711 @item set arm disassembler
14712 @kindex set arm
14713 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
14714 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
14715
14716 @item show arm disassembler
14717 @kindex show arm
14718 Show the current disassembly style.
14719
14720 @item set arm apcs32
14721 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
14722 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
14723
14724 @item show arm apcs32
14725 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
14726
14727 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
14728 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
14729 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
14730
14731 @table @code
14732 @item auto
14733 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
14734 @item softfpa
14735 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
14736 processors.
14737 @item fpa
14738 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
14739 @item softvfp
14740 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
14741 @item vfp
14742 VFP co-processor.
14743 @end table
14744
14745 @item show arm fpu
14746 Show the current type of the FPU.
14747
14748 @item set arm abi
14749 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
14750
14751 @item show arm abi
14752 Show the currently used ABI.
14753
14754 @item set debug arm
14755 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
14756 target support subsystem.
14757
14758 @item show debug arm
14759 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
14760 @end table
14761
14762 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
14763 using the RDI interface:
14764
14765 @table @code
14766 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14767 @kindex rdilogfile
14768 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
14769 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
14770 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
14771 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
14772 @file{rdi.log}.
14773
14774 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
14775 @kindex rdilogenable
14776 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
14777 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
14778 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
14779 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
14780 are logged to a file.
14781
14782 @item set rdiromatzero
14783 @kindex set rdiromatzero
14784 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
14785 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
14786 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
14787 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
14788 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
14789
14790 @item show rdiromatzero
14791 @kindex show rdiromatzero
14792 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
14793
14794 @item set rdiheartbeat
14795 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
14796 @cindex RDI heartbeat
14797 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
14798 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
14799 well as the Angel monitor.
14800
14801 @item show rdiheartbeat
14802 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
14803 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
14804 @end table
14805
14806
14807 @node M32R/D
14808 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
14809
14810 @table @code
14811 @kindex target m32r
14812 @item target m32r @var{dev}
14813 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
14814
14815 @kindex target m32rsdi
14816 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
14817 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
14818 @end table
14819
14820 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
14821
14822 @table @code
14823 @item set download-path @var{path}
14824 @kindex set download-path
14825 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
14826 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14827
14828 @item show download-path
14829 @kindex show download-path
14830 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14831
14832 @item set board-address @var{addr}
14833 @kindex set board-address
14834 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
14835 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
14836
14837 @item show board-address
14838 @kindex show board-address
14839 Show the current IP address of the target board.
14840
14841 @item set server-address @var{addr}
14842 @kindex set server-address
14843 @cindex download server address (M32R)
14844 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
14845 host machine.
14846
14847 @item show server-address
14848 @kindex show server-address
14849 Display the IP address of the download server.
14850
14851 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14852 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
14853 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
14854 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
14855 executable file is uploaded.
14856
14857 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14858 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
14859 Test the @code{upload} command.
14860 @end table
14861
14862 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
14863
14864 @table @code
14865 @item sdireset
14866 @kindex sdireset
14867 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
14868 This command resets the SDI connection.
14869
14870 @item sdistatus
14871 @kindex sdistatus
14872 This command shows the SDI connection status.
14873
14874 @item debug_chaos
14875 @kindex debug_chaos
14876 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
14877 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
14878
14879 @item use_debug_dma
14880 @kindex use_debug_dma
14881 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
14882
14883 @item use_mon_code
14884 @kindex use_mon_code
14885 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
14886
14887 @item use_ib_break
14888 @kindex use_ib_break
14889 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
14890
14891 @item use_dbt_break
14892 @kindex use_dbt_break
14893 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
14894 @end table
14895
14896 @node M68K
14897 @subsection M68k
14898
14899 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
14900 target command for the following ROM monitor.
14901
14902 @table @code
14903
14904 @kindex target dbug
14905 @item target dbug @var{dev}
14906 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
14907
14908 @end table
14909
14910 @node MIPS Embedded
14911 @subsection MIPS Embedded
14912
14913 @cindex MIPS boards
14914 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
14915 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
14916 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
14917
14918 @need 1000
14919 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
14920
14921 @table @code
14922 @item target mips @var{port}
14923 @kindex target mips @var{port}
14924 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
14925 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
14926 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
14927 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
14928 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
14929 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
14930
14931 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
14932 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
14933 debugger:
14934
14935 @smallexample
14936 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
14937 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
14938 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
14939 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
14940 (@value{GDBP}) run
14941 @end smallexample
14942
14943 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
14944 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
14945 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
14946 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
14947 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
14948
14949 @item target pmon @var{port}
14950 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
14951 PMON ROM monitor.
14952
14953 @item target ddb @var{port}
14954 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
14955 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
14956
14957 @item target lsi @var{port}
14958 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
14959 LSI variant of PMON.
14960
14961 @kindex target r3900
14962 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
14963 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
14964
14965 @kindex target array
14966 @item target array @var{dev}
14967 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
14968
14969 @end table
14970
14971
14972 @noindent
14973 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
14974
14975 @table @code
14976 @item set mipsfpu double
14977 @itemx set mipsfpu single
14978 @itemx set mipsfpu none
14979 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
14980 @itemx show mipsfpu
14981 @kindex set mipsfpu
14982 @kindex show mipsfpu
14983 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
14984 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
14985 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
14986 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
14987 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
14988 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
14989 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
14990 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
14991 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
14992 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
14993 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
14994 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
14995 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
14996
14997 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
14998 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
14999 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
15000
15001 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
15002 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
15003
15004 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
15005 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
15006 @itemx show timeout
15007 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
15008 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
15009 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
15010 @kindex set timeout
15011 @kindex show timeout
15012 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
15013 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
15014 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
15015 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
15016 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
15017 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
15018 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
15019 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
15020 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
15021 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
15022
15023 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
15024 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
15025 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
15026 to run before stopping.
15027
15028 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
15029 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
15030 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
15031 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
15032 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
15033 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
15034
15035 @item show syn-garbage-limit
15036 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
15037 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
15038 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
15039
15040 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
15041 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
15042 @cindex remote monitor prompt
15043 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
15044 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
15045 @table @asis
15046 @item pmon target
15047 @samp{PMON}
15048 @item ddb target
15049 @samp{NEC010}
15050 @item lsi target
15051 @samp{PMON>}
15052 @end table
15053
15054 @item show monitor-prompt
15055 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
15056 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
15057 remote monitor.
15058
15059 @item set monitor-warnings
15060 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
15061 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
15062 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
15063 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
15064 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
15065
15066 @item show monitor-warnings
15067 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
15068 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
15069
15070 @item pmon @var{command}
15071 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
15072 @cindex send PMON command
15073 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
15074 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
15075 @end table
15076
15077 @node OpenRISC 1000
15078 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
15079 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
15080
15081 @cindex or1k boards
15082 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
15083 about platform and commands.
15084
15085 @table @code
15086
15087 @kindex target jtag
15088 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
15089
15090 Connects to remote JTAG server.
15091 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
15092 connected via parallel port to the board.
15093
15094 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
15095
15096 @kindex or1ksim
15097 @item or1ksim @var{command}
15098 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
15099 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
15100
15101 @kindex info or1k spr
15102 @item info or1k spr
15103 Displays spr groups.
15104
15105 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
15106 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
15107 Displays register names in selected group.
15108
15109 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
15110 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
15111 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
15112 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
15113 Shows information about specified spr register.
15114
15115 @kindex spr
15116 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
15117 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
15118 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
15119 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
15120 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
15121 @end table
15122
15123 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
15124 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
15125 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
15126 triggers can be set using:
15127 @table @code
15128 @item $LEA/$LDATA
15129 Load effective address/data
15130 @item $SEA/$SDATA
15131 Store effective address/data
15132 @item $AEA/$ADATA
15133 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
15134 @item $FETCH
15135 Fetch data
15136 @end table
15137
15138 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
15139 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
15140
15141 @code{htrace} commands:
15142 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
15143 @table @code
15144 @kindex hwatch
15145 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
15146 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
15147 or Data. For example:
15148
15149 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15150
15151 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15152
15153 @kindex htrace
15154 @item htrace info
15155 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
15156
15157 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
15158 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
15159
15160 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
15161 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
15162
15163 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
15164 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
15165
15166 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
15167 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
15168 triggered.
15169
15170 @item htrace enable
15171 @itemx htrace disable
15172 Enables/disables the HW trace.
15173
15174 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
15175 Clears currently recorded trace data.
15176
15177 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
15178 will be written there.
15179
15180 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
15181 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
15182
15183 @item htrace mode continuous
15184 Set continuous trace mode.
15185
15186 @item htrace mode suspend
15187 Set suspend trace mode.
15188
15189 @end table
15190
15191 @node PowerPC
15192 @subsection PowerPC
15193
15194 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
15195
15196 @table @code
15197 @kindex set powerpc
15198 @item set powerpc soft-float
15199 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
15200 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
15201 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
15202 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15203
15204 @item set powerpc vector-abi
15205 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
15206 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
15207 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
15208 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
15209 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
15210 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
15211 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15212
15213 @kindex target dink32
15214 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
15215 DINK32 ROM monitor.
15216
15217 @kindex target ppcbug
15218 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
15219 @kindex target ppcbug1
15220 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
15221 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
15222
15223 @kindex target sds
15224 @item target sds @var{dev}
15225 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
15226 @end table
15227
15228 @cindex SDS protocol
15229 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
15230 by @value{GDBN}:
15231
15232 @table @code
15233 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
15234 @kindex set sdstimeout
15235 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
15236 default is 2 seconds.
15237
15238 @item show sdstimeout
15239 @kindex show sdstimeout
15240 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
15241
15242 @item sds @var{command}
15243 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
15244 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
15245 @end table
15246
15247
15248 @node PA
15249 @subsection HP PA Embedded
15250
15251 @table @code
15252
15253 @kindex target op50n
15254 @item target op50n @var{dev}
15255 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
15256
15257 @kindex target w89k
15258 @item target w89k @var{dev}
15259 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
15260
15261 @end table
15262
15263 @node Sparclet
15264 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
15265
15266 @cindex Sparclet
15267
15268 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
15269 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
15270 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15271 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
15272 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
15273
15274 @table @code
15275 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
15276 @kindex remotetimeout
15277 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
15278 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15279 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
15280 @end table
15281
15282 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
15283 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
15284 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
15285 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
15286 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
15287
15288 @smallexample
15289 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
15290 @end smallexample
15291
15292 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
15293
15294 @smallexample
15295 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
15296 @end smallexample
15297
15298 @cindex running, on Sparclet
15299 Once you have set
15300 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15301 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
15302 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
15303
15304 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15305
15306 @smallexample
15307 (gdbslet)
15308 @end smallexample
15309
15310 @menu
15311 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
15312 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
15313 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
15314 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
15315 @end menu
15316
15317 @node Sparclet File
15318 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
15319
15320 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
15321
15322 @smallexample
15323 (gdbslet) file prog
15324 @end smallexample
15325
15326 @need 1000
15327 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
15328 @value{GDBN} locates
15329 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
15330 path.
15331 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
15332 files will be searched as well.
15333 @value{GDBN} locates
15334 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
15335 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
15336 If it fails
15337 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
15338
15339 @smallexample
15340 prog: No such file or directory.
15341 @end smallexample
15342
15343 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
15344 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
15345 @code{target} command again.
15346
15347 @node Sparclet Connection
15348 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
15349
15350 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
15351 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
15352
15353 @smallexample
15354 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
15355 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
15356 main () at ../prog.c:3
15357 @end smallexample
15358
15359 @need 750
15360 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15361
15362 @smallexample
15363 Connected to ttya.
15364 @end smallexample
15365
15366 @node Sparclet Download
15367 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
15368
15369 @cindex download to Sparclet
15370 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
15371 you can use the @value{GDBN}
15372 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
15373 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
15374 command.
15375 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
15376 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
15377 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
15378 of each of the file's sections.
15379 For instance, if the program
15380 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
15381 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15382
15383 @smallexample
15384 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
15385 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
15386 @end smallexample
15387
15388 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
15389 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
15390 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
15391
15392 @node Sparclet Execution
15393 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
15394
15395 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
15396 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
15397 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
15398 manual for the list of commands.
15399
15400 @smallexample
15401 (gdbslet) b main
15402 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
15403 (gdbslet) run
15404 Starting program: prog
15405 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
15406 3 char *symarg = 0;
15407 (gdbslet) step
15408 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
15409 (gdbslet)
15410 @end smallexample
15411
15412 @node Sparclite
15413 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
15414
15415 @table @code
15416
15417 @kindex target sparclite
15418 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
15419 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
15420 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
15421 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
15422 remote protocol.
15423
15424 @end table
15425
15426 @node Z8000
15427 @subsection Zilog Z8000
15428
15429 @cindex Z8000
15430 @cindex simulator, Z8000
15431 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
15432
15433 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
15434 a Z8000 simulator.
15435
15436 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
15437 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
15438 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
15439 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
15440
15441 @table @code
15442 @item target sim @var{args}
15443 @kindex sim
15444 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
15445 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
15446 options, specify them via @var{args}.
15447 @end table
15448
15449 @noindent
15450 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
15451 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
15452 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
15453 to run your program, and so on.
15454
15455 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
15456 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
15457 additional items of information as specially named registers:
15458
15459 @table @code
15460
15461 @item cycles
15462 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
15463
15464 @item insts
15465 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
15466
15467 @item time
15468 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
15469
15470 @end table
15471
15472 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
15473 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
15474 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
15475 simulated clock ticks.
15476
15477 @node AVR
15478 @subsection Atmel AVR
15479 @cindex AVR
15480
15481 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
15482 following AVR-specific commands:
15483
15484 @table @code
15485 @item info io_registers
15486 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
15487 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
15488 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
15489 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
15490 @end table
15491
15492 @node CRIS
15493 @subsection CRIS
15494 @cindex CRIS
15495
15496 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
15497 following CRIS-specific commands:
15498
15499 @table @code
15500 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
15501 @cindex CRIS version
15502 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
15503 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
15504 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
15505
15506 @item show cris-version
15507 Show the current CRIS version.
15508
15509 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
15510 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
15511 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
15512 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
15513 @code{R59}.
15514
15515 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
15516 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
15517
15518 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
15519 @cindex CRIS mode
15520 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
15521 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
15522 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
15523
15524 @item show cris-mode
15525 Show the current CRIS mode.
15526 @end table
15527
15528 @node Super-H
15529 @subsection Renesas Super-H
15530 @cindex Super-H
15531
15532 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
15533 commands:
15534
15535 @table @code
15536 @item regs
15537 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
15538 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
15539 @end table
15540
15541
15542 @node Architectures
15543 @section Architectures
15544
15545 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
15546 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
15547
15548 @menu
15549 * i386::
15550 * A29K::
15551 * Alpha::
15552 * MIPS::
15553 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
15554 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
15555 @end menu
15556
15557 @node i386
15558 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
15559
15560 @table @code
15561 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
15562 @kindex set struct-convention
15563 @cindex struct return convention
15564 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
15565 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
15566 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
15567 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
15568 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
15569 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
15570 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
15571 be returned in a register.
15572
15573 @item show struct-convention
15574 @kindex show struct-convention
15575 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
15576 from functions.
15577 @end table
15578
15579 @node A29K
15580 @subsection A29K
15581
15582 @table @code
15583
15584 @kindex set rstack_high_address
15585 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
15586 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
15587 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
15588 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
15589 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
15590 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
15591 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
15592 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
15593 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
15594 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
15595 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
15596 hexadecimal.
15597
15598 @kindex show rstack_high_address
15599 @item show rstack_high_address
15600 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
15601 processors.
15602
15603 @end table
15604
15605 @node Alpha
15606 @subsection Alpha
15607
15608 See the following section.
15609
15610 @node MIPS
15611 @subsection MIPS
15612
15613 @cindex stack on Alpha
15614 @cindex stack on MIPS
15615 @cindex Alpha stack
15616 @cindex MIPS stack
15617 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
15618 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
15619 find the beginning of a function.
15620
15621 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
15622 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
15623 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
15624 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
15625 commands:
15626
15627 @table @code
15628 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
15629 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
15630 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
15631 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
15632 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
15633 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
15634 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
15635 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
15636
15637 @item show heuristic-fence-post
15638 Display the current limit.
15639 @end table
15640
15641 @noindent
15642 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
15643 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
15644
15645 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
15646 programs:
15647
15648 @table @code
15649 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
15650 @kindex set mips abi
15651 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
15652 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
15653 values of @var{arg} are:
15654
15655 @table @samp
15656 @item auto
15657 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
15658 default).
15659 @item o32
15660 @item o64
15661 @item n32
15662 @item n64
15663 @item eabi32
15664 @item eabi64
15665 @item auto
15666 @end table
15667
15668 @item show mips abi
15669 @kindex show mips abi
15670 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
15671
15672 @item set mipsfpu
15673 @itemx show mipsfpu
15674 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
15675
15676 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
15677 @kindex set mips mask-address
15678 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
15679 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
15680 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
15681 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
15682 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
15683
15684 @item show mips mask-address
15685 @kindex show mips mask-address
15686 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
15687 not.
15688
15689 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15690 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15691 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
15692 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
15693 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
15694 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
15695
15696 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15697 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15698 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
15699
15700 @item set debug mips
15701 @kindex set debug mips
15702 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
15703 target code in @value{GDBN}.
15704
15705 @item show debug mips
15706 @kindex show debug mips
15707 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
15708 @end table
15709
15710
15711 @node HPPA
15712 @subsection HPPA
15713 @cindex HPPA support
15714
15715 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
15716 following special commands:
15717
15718 @table @code
15719 @item set debug hppa
15720 @kindex set debug hppa
15721 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
15722 messages are to be displayed.
15723
15724 @item show debug hppa
15725 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
15726
15727 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
15728 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
15729 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
15730 given @var{address}.
15731
15732 @end table
15733
15734
15735 @node SPU
15736 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
15737 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
15738 @cindex SPU
15739
15740 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
15741 it provides the following special commands:
15742
15743 @table @code
15744 @item info spu event
15745 @kindex info spu
15746 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
15747 and pending event status.
15748
15749 @item info spu signal
15750 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
15751 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
15752 notification channels.
15753
15754 @item info spu mailbox
15755 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
15756 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
15757 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
15758
15759 @item info spu dma
15760 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
15761 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
15762 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
15763
15764 @item info spu proxydma
15765 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
15766 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
15767 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
15768
15769 @end table
15770
15771
15772 @node Controlling GDB
15773 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
15774
15775 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
15776 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
15777 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
15778 described here.
15779
15780 @menu
15781 * Prompt:: Prompt
15782 * Editing:: Command editing
15783 * Command History:: Command history
15784 * Screen Size:: Screen size
15785 * Numbers:: Numbers
15786 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
15787 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
15788 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
15789 @end menu
15790
15791 @node Prompt
15792 @section Prompt
15793
15794 @cindex prompt
15795
15796 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
15797 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
15798 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
15799 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
15800 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
15801 which one you are talking to.
15802
15803 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
15804 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
15805 or a prompt that does not.
15806
15807 @table @code
15808 @kindex set prompt
15809 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
15810 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
15811
15812 @kindex show prompt
15813 @item show prompt
15814 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
15815 @end table
15816
15817 @node Editing
15818 @section Command Editing
15819 @cindex readline
15820 @cindex command line editing
15821
15822 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
15823 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
15824 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
15825 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
15826 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
15827 debugging sessions.
15828
15829 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
15830 command @code{set}.
15831
15832 @table @code
15833 @kindex set editing
15834 @cindex editing
15835 @item set editing
15836 @itemx set editing on
15837 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
15838
15839 @item set editing off
15840 Disable command line editing.
15841
15842 @kindex show editing
15843 @item show editing
15844 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
15845 @end table
15846
15847 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
15848 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
15849 encouraged to read that chapter.
15850
15851 @node Command History
15852 @section Command History
15853 @cindex command history
15854
15855 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
15856 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
15857 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
15858 history facility.
15859
15860 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
15861 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
15862 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
15863
15864 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
15865 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
15866 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
15867 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
15868 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
15869 pressed on a line by itself.
15870
15871 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
15872 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
15873 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
15874 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
15875
15876 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
15877 history.
15878
15879 @table @code
15880 @cindex history substitution
15881 @cindex history file
15882 @kindex set history filename
15883 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
15884 @item set history filename @var{fname}
15885 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
15886 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
15887 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
15888 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
15889 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
15890 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
15891 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
15892 is not set.
15893
15894 @cindex save command history
15895 @kindex set history save
15896 @item set history save
15897 @itemx set history save on
15898 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
15899 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
15900
15901 @item set history save off
15902 Stop recording command history in a file.
15903
15904 @cindex history size
15905 @kindex set history size
15906 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
15907 @item set history size @var{size}
15908 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
15909 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
15910 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
15911 @end table
15912
15913 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
15914 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
15915
15916 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
15917 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
15918 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
15919 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
15920 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
15921 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
15922 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
15923 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
15924
15925 The commands to control history expansion are:
15926
15927 @table @code
15928 @item set history expansion on
15929 @itemx set history expansion
15930 @kindex set history expansion
15931 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
15932
15933 @item set history expansion off
15934 Disable history expansion.
15935
15936 @c @group
15937 @kindex show history
15938 @item show history
15939 @itemx show history filename
15940 @itemx show history save
15941 @itemx show history size
15942 @itemx show history expansion
15943 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
15944 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
15945 @c @end group
15946 @end table
15947
15948 @table @code
15949 @kindex show commands
15950 @cindex show last commands
15951 @cindex display command history
15952 @item show commands
15953 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
15954
15955 @item show commands @var{n}
15956 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
15957
15958 @item show commands +
15959 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
15960 @end table
15961
15962 @node Screen Size
15963 @section Screen Size
15964 @cindex size of screen
15965 @cindex pauses in output
15966
15967 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
15968 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
15969 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
15970 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
15971 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
15972 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
15973 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
15974 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
15975
15976 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
15977 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
15978 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
15979 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
15980 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
15981 width} commands:
15982
15983 @table @code
15984 @kindex set height
15985 @kindex set width
15986 @kindex show width
15987 @kindex show height
15988 @item set height @var{lpp}
15989 @itemx show height
15990 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
15991 @itemx show width
15992 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
15993 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
15994 commands display the current settings.
15995
15996 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
15997 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
15998 file or to an editor buffer.
15999
16000 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
16001 from wrapping its output.
16002
16003 @item set pagination on
16004 @itemx set pagination off
16005 @kindex set pagination
16006 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
16007 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
16008
16009 @item show pagination
16010 @kindex show pagination
16011 Show the current pagination mode.
16012 @end table
16013
16014 @node Numbers
16015 @section Numbers
16016 @cindex number representation
16017 @cindex entering numbers
16018
16019 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
16020 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
16021 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
16022 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
16023 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
16024 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
16025 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
16026 both input and output with the commands described below.
16027
16028 @table @code
16029 @kindex set input-radix
16030 @item set input-radix @var{base}
16031 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
16032 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
16033 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
16034 example, any of
16035
16036 @smallexample
16037 set input-radix 012
16038 set input-radix 10.
16039 set input-radix 0xa
16040 @end smallexample
16041
16042 @noindent
16043 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
16044 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
16045 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
16046 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
16047 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
16048 change the radix.
16049
16050 @kindex set output-radix
16051 @item set output-radix @var{base}
16052 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
16053 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
16054 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
16055
16056 @kindex show input-radix
16057 @item show input-radix
16058 Display the current default base for numeric input.
16059
16060 @kindex show output-radix
16061 @item show output-radix
16062 Display the current default base for numeric display.
16063
16064 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
16065 @itemx show radix
16066 @kindex set radix
16067 @kindex show radix
16068 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
16069 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
16070 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
16071 default value of 10.
16072
16073 @end table
16074
16075 @node ABI
16076 @section Configuring the Current ABI
16077
16078 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
16079 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
16080 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
16081 current ABI.
16082
16083 @cindex OS ABI
16084 @kindex set osabi
16085 @kindex show osabi
16086
16087 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
16088 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
16089 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
16090 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
16091 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
16092 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
16093 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
16094 platform provides.
16095
16096 @table @code
16097 @item show osabi
16098 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
16099
16100 @item set osabi
16101 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
16102
16103 @item set osabi @var{abi}
16104 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
16105 @end table
16106
16107 @cindex float promotion
16108
16109 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
16110 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
16111 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
16112 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
16113 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
16114 @code{double} and then passed.
16115
16116 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
16117 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
16118 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
16119
16120 @table @code
16121 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
16122 @item set coerce-float-to-double
16123 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
16124 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
16125 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
16126
16127 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
16128 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
16129 functions.
16130
16131 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
16132 @item show coerce-float-to-double
16133 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
16134 @end table
16135
16136 @kindex set cp-abi
16137 @kindex show cp-abi
16138 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
16139 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
16140 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
16141 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
16142 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
16143 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
16144 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
16145 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
16146 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
16147 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
16148 ``auto''.
16149
16150 @table @code
16151 @item show cp-abi
16152 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
16153
16154 @item set cp-abi
16155 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
16156
16157 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
16158 @itemx set cp-abi auto
16159 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
16160 @end table
16161
16162 @node Messages/Warnings
16163 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
16164
16165 @cindex verbose operation
16166 @cindex optional warnings
16167 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
16168 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
16169 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
16170 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
16171
16172 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
16173 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
16174 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
16175
16176 @table @code
16177 @kindex set verbose
16178 @item set verbose on
16179 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16180
16181 @item set verbose off
16182 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16183
16184 @kindex show verbose
16185 @item show verbose
16186 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
16187 @end table
16188
16189 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
16190 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
16191 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
16192 Symbol Files}).
16193
16194 @table @code
16195
16196 @kindex set complaints
16197 @item set complaints @var{limit}
16198 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
16199 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
16200 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
16201 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
16202
16203 @kindex show complaints
16204 @item show complaints
16205 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
16206
16207 @end table
16208
16209 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
16210 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
16211 you try to run a program which is already running:
16212
16213 @smallexample
16214 (@value{GDBP}) run
16215 The program being debugged has been started already.
16216 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
16217 @end smallexample
16218
16219 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
16220 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
16221
16222 @table @code
16223
16224 @kindex set confirm
16225 @cindex flinching
16226 @cindex confirmation
16227 @cindex stupid questions
16228 @item set confirm off
16229 Disables confirmation requests.
16230
16231 @item set confirm on
16232 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
16233
16234 @kindex show confirm
16235 @item show confirm
16236 Displays state of confirmation requests.
16237
16238 @end table
16239
16240 @cindex command tracing
16241 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
16242 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
16243 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
16244 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
16245
16246 @table @code
16247 @kindex set trace-commands
16248 @cindex command scripts, debugging
16249 @item set trace-commands on
16250 Enable command tracing.
16251 @item set trace-commands off
16252 Disable command tracing.
16253 @item show trace-commands
16254 Display the current state of command tracing.
16255 @end table
16256
16257 @node Debugging Output
16258 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
16259 @cindex optional debugging messages
16260
16261 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
16262 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
16263 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
16264 section documents those commands.
16265
16266 @table @code
16267 @kindex set exec-done-display
16268 @item set exec-done-display
16269 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
16270 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
16271 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
16272 @kindex show exec-done-display
16273 @item show exec-done-display
16274 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
16275 notification.
16276 @kindex set debug
16277 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
16278 @cindex architecture debugging info
16279 @item set debug arch
16280 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
16281 @kindex show debug
16282 @item show debug arch
16283 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
16284 @item set debug aix-thread
16285 @cindex AIX threads
16286 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
16287 module.
16288 @item show debug aix-thread
16289 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
16290 @item set debug event
16291 @cindex event debugging info
16292 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
16293 default is off.
16294 @item show debug event
16295 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
16296 info.
16297 @item set debug expression
16298 @cindex expression debugging info
16299 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
16300 expression parsing. The default is off.
16301 @item show debug expression
16302 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
16303 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
16304 @item set debug frame
16305 @cindex frame debugging info
16306 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
16307 default is off.
16308 @item show debug frame
16309 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
16310 info.
16311 @item set debug infrun
16312 @cindex inferior debugging info
16313 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
16314 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
16315 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
16316 @item show debug infrun
16317 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
16318 @item set debug lin-lwp
16319 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
16320 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
16321 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
16322 @item show debug lin-lwp
16323 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
16324 @item set debug observer
16325 @cindex observer debugging info
16326 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
16327 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
16328 @item show debug observer
16329 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
16330 @item set debug overload
16331 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
16332 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
16333 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
16334 is off.
16335 @item show debug overload
16336 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
16337 debugging info.
16338 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
16339 @cindex serial connections, debugging
16340 @cindex debug remote protocol
16341 @cindex remote protocol debugging
16342 @cindex display remote packets
16343 @item set debug remote
16344 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
16345 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
16346 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
16347 @item show debug remote
16348 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
16349 @item set debug serial
16350 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
16351 default is off.
16352 @item show debug serial
16353 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
16354 info.
16355 @item set debug solib-frv
16356 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
16357 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
16358 @item show debug solib-frv
16359 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
16360 messages.
16361 @item set debug target
16362 @cindex target debugging info
16363 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
16364 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
16365 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
16366 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
16367 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
16368 @item show debug target
16369 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
16370 info.
16371 @item set debugvarobj
16372 @cindex variable object debugging info
16373 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
16374 info. The default is off.
16375 @item show debugvarobj
16376 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
16377 debugging info.
16378 @item set debug xml
16379 @cindex XML parser debugging
16380 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
16381 @item show debug xml
16382 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
16383 @end table
16384
16385 @node Sequences
16386 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
16387
16388 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
16389 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
16390 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
16391 files.
16392
16393 @menu
16394 * Define:: How to define your own commands
16395 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
16396 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
16397 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
16398 @end menu
16399
16400 @node Define
16401 @section User-defined Commands
16402
16403 @cindex user-defined command
16404 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
16405 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
16406 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
16407 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
16408 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
16409 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
16410
16411 @smallexample
16412 define adder
16413 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16414 end
16415 @end smallexample
16416
16417 @noindent
16418 To execute the command use:
16419
16420 @smallexample
16421 adder 1 2 3
16422 @end smallexample
16423
16424 @noindent
16425 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
16426 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
16427 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
16428 functions calls.
16429
16430 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
16431 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
16432 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
16433 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
16434
16435 @smallexample
16436 define adder
16437 if $argc == 2
16438 print $arg0 + $arg1
16439 end
16440 if $argc == 3
16441 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16442 end
16443 end
16444 @end smallexample
16445
16446 @table @code
16447
16448 @kindex define
16449 @item define @var{commandname}
16450 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
16451 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
16452
16453 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
16454 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
16455 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16456
16457 @kindex document
16458 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
16459 @item document @var{commandname}
16460 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
16461 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
16462 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
16463 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
16464 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
16465 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
16466
16467 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
16468 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
16469 does not change the documentation.
16470
16471 @kindex dont-repeat
16472 @cindex don't repeat command
16473 @item dont-repeat
16474 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
16475 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
16476 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
16477
16478 @kindex help user-defined
16479 @item help user-defined
16480 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
16481 (if any) for each.
16482
16483 @kindex show user
16484 @item show user
16485 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
16486 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
16487 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
16488 definitions for all user-defined commands.
16489
16490 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
16491 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
16492 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
16493 @item show max-user-call-depth
16494 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
16495 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
16496 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
16497 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
16498 @end table
16499
16500 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
16501 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
16502
16503 When user-defined commands are executed, the
16504 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
16505 stops execution of the user-defined command.
16506
16507 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
16508 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
16509 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
16510 messages when used in a user-defined command.
16511
16512 @node Hooks
16513 @section User-defined Command Hooks
16514 @cindex command hooks
16515 @cindex hooks, for commands
16516 @cindex hooks, pre-command
16517
16518 @kindex hook
16519 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
16520 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
16521 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
16522 before that command.
16523
16524 @cindex hooks, post-command
16525 @kindex hookpost
16526 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
16527 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
16528 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
16529 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
16530 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
16531
16532 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
16533 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
16534
16535 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
16536 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
16537
16538 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
16539 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
16540 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
16541 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
16542 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
16543
16544 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
16545 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
16546 you could define:
16547
16548 @smallexample
16549 define hook-stop
16550 handle SIGALRM nopass
16551 end
16552
16553 define hook-run
16554 handle SIGALRM pass
16555 end
16556
16557 define hook-continue
16558 handle SIGALRM pass
16559 end
16560 @end smallexample
16561
16562 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
16563 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
16564 you could define:
16565
16566 @smallexample
16567 define hook-echo
16568 echo <<<---
16569 end
16570
16571 define hookpost-echo
16572 echo --->>>\n
16573 end
16574
16575 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
16576 <<<---Hello World--->>>
16577 (@value{GDBP})
16578
16579 @end smallexample
16580
16581 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
16582 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
16583 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
16584 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
16585 @c or not?
16586 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
16587 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
16588 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
16589
16590 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
16591 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
16592
16593 @node Command Files
16594 @section Command Files
16595
16596 @cindex command files
16597 @cindex scripting commands
16598 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
16599 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
16600 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
16601 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
16602 terminal.
16603
16604 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
16605 command:
16606
16607 @table @code
16608 @kindex source
16609 @cindex execute commands from a file
16610 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
16611 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
16612 @end table
16613
16614 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
16615 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
16616 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
16617 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
16618 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
16619
16620 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
16621 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
16622
16623 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
16624 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
16625 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
16626
16627 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
16628 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
16629 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
16630 when called from command files.
16631
16632 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
16633 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
16634 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
16635 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
16636 the next command.
16637
16638 @smallexample
16639 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
16640 @end smallexample
16641
16642 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
16643 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
16644 would be directed to @file{log}.
16645
16646 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
16647 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
16648 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
16649 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
16650 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
16651 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
16652 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
16653 conditionally, etc.
16654
16655 @table @code
16656 @kindex if
16657 @kindex else
16658 @item if
16659 @itemx else
16660 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
16661 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
16662 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
16663 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
16664 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
16665 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
16666 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16667
16668 @kindex while
16669 @item while
16670 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
16671 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
16672 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
16673 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
16674 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
16675 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
16676
16677 @kindex loop_break
16678 @item loop_break
16679 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
16680 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
16681 line.
16682
16683 @kindex loop_continue
16684 @item loop_continue
16685 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
16686 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
16687 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
16688 the controlling expression.
16689
16690 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
16691 @item end
16692 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
16693 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
16694 @end table
16695
16696
16697 @node Output
16698 @section Commands for Controlled Output
16699
16700 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
16701 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
16702 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
16703 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
16704 want.
16705
16706 @table @code
16707 @kindex echo
16708 @item echo @var{text}
16709 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
16710 @c because it is not in ANSI.
16711 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
16712 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
16713 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
16714 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
16715 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
16716 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
16717 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
16718 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
16719 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
16720
16721 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
16722 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
16723
16724 @smallexample
16725 echo This is some text\n\
16726 which is continued\n\
16727 onto several lines.\n
16728 @end smallexample
16729
16730 produces the same output as
16731
16732 @smallexample
16733 echo This is some text\n
16734 echo which is continued\n
16735 echo onto several lines.\n
16736 @end smallexample
16737
16738 @kindex output
16739 @item output @var{expression}
16740 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
16741 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
16742 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
16743 on expressions.
16744
16745 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
16746 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
16747 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
16748 Formats}, for more information.
16749
16750 @kindex printf
16751 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
16752 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
16753 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
16754 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
16755 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
16756 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
16757 executing the code below:
16758
16759 @smallexample
16760 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
16761 @end smallexample
16762
16763 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
16764 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
16765 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
16766 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
16767 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
16768 printed.
16769
16770 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
16771
16772 @smallexample
16773 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
16774 @end smallexample
16775
16776 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
16777 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
16778 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
16779
16780 @itemize @bullet
16781 @item
16782 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
16783
16784 @item
16785 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
16786 width.
16787
16788 @item
16789 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
16790 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
16791
16792 @item
16793 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
16794 supported.
16795
16796 @item
16797 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
16798
16799 @item
16800 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
16801 @end itemize
16802
16803 @noindent
16804 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
16805 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
16806 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
16807 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
16808
16809 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
16810 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
16811 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
16812 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
16813 supported.
16814
16815 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
16816 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
16817 together with a floating point specifier.
16818 letters:
16819
16820 @itemize @bullet
16821 @item
16822 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
16823
16824 @item
16825 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
16826
16827 @item
16828 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
16829 @end itemize
16830
16831 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
16832 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
16833 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
16834
16835 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
16836 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
16837
16838 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
16839 @smallexample
16840 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
16841 @end smallexample
16842
16843 @end table
16844
16845 @node Interpreters
16846 @chapter Command Interpreters
16847 @cindex command interpreters
16848
16849 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
16850 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
16851 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
16852
16853 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
16854 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
16855 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
16856 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
16857
16858 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
16859 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
16860 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
16861 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
16862
16863 @table @code
16864 @item console
16865 @cindex console interpreter
16866 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
16867 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
16868 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
16869
16870 @item mi
16871 @cindex mi interpreter
16872 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
16873 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
16874 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
16875 Interface}.
16876
16877 @item mi2
16878 @cindex mi2 interpreter
16879 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
16880
16881 @item mi1
16882 @cindex mi1 interpreter
16883 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
16884
16885 @end table
16886
16887 @cindex invoke another interpreter
16888 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
16889 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
16890 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
16891 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
16892 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
16893 the IDE inoperable!
16894
16895 @kindex interpreter-exec
16896 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
16897 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
16898 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
16899 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
16900
16901 @smallexample
16902 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
16903 @end smallexample
16904
16905 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
16906 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
16907
16908 @node TUI
16909 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
16910 @cindex TUI
16911 @cindex Text User Interface
16912
16913 @menu
16914 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
16915 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
16916 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
16917 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
16918 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
16919 @end menu
16920
16921 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
16922 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
16923 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
16924 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
16925 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
16926 is available.
16927
16928 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
16929 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
16930 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
16931 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
16932 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
16933 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
16934
16935 @node TUI Overview
16936 @section TUI Overview
16937
16938 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
16939
16940 @table @emph
16941 @item command
16942 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
16943 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
16944 managed using readline.
16945
16946 @item source
16947 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
16948 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
16949
16950 @item assembly
16951 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
16952
16953 @item register
16954 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
16955 when their values change.
16956 @end table
16957
16958 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
16959 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
16960 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
16961 indicates the breakpoint type:
16962
16963 @table @code
16964 @item B
16965 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16966
16967 @item b
16968 Breakpoint which was never hit.
16969
16970 @item H
16971 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16972
16973 @item h
16974 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
16975 @end table
16976
16977 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
16978
16979 @table @code
16980 @item +
16981 Breakpoint is enabled.
16982
16983 @item -
16984 Breakpoint is disabled.
16985 @end table
16986
16987 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
16988 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
16989 changes.
16990
16991 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
16992 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
16993 layouts:
16994
16995 @itemize @bullet
16996 @item
16997 source only,
16998
16999 @item
17000 assembly only,
17001
17002 @item
17003 source and assembly,
17004
17005 @item
17006 source and registers, or
17007
17008 @item
17009 assembly and registers.
17010 @end itemize
17011
17012 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
17013
17014 @table @emph
17015 @item target
17016 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
17017 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
17018
17019 @item process
17020 Gives the current process or thread number.
17021 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
17022
17023 @item function
17024 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
17025 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
17026 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
17027 the string @code{??} is displayed.
17028
17029 @item line
17030 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
17031 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
17032
17033 @item pc
17034 Indicates the current program counter address.
17035 @end table
17036
17037 @node TUI Keys
17038 @section TUI Key Bindings
17039 @cindex TUI key bindings
17040
17041 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
17042 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
17043 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
17044
17045 @table @kbd
17046 @kindex C-x C-a
17047 @item C-x C-a
17048 @kindex C-x a
17049 @itemx C-x a
17050 @kindex C-x A
17051 @itemx C-x A
17052 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
17053 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
17054 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
17055 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
17056 The screen is then refreshed.
17057
17058 @kindex C-x 1
17059 @item C-x 1
17060 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
17061 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
17062 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
17063
17064 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
17065
17066 @kindex C-x 2
17067 @item C-x 2
17068 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
17069 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
17070 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
17071 previous layout and the new one.
17072
17073 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
17074
17075 @kindex C-x o
17076 @item C-x o
17077 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
17078 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
17079 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
17080
17081 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
17082
17083 @kindex C-x s
17084 @item C-x s
17085 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
17086 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
17087 @end table
17088
17089 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
17090
17091 @table @asis
17092 @kindex PgUp
17093 @item @key{PgUp}
17094 Scroll the active window one page up.
17095
17096 @kindex PgDn
17097 @item @key{PgDn}
17098 Scroll the active window one page down.
17099
17100 @kindex Up
17101 @item @key{Up}
17102 Scroll the active window one line up.
17103
17104 @kindex Down
17105 @item @key{Down}
17106 Scroll the active window one line down.
17107
17108 @kindex Left
17109 @item @key{Left}
17110 Scroll the active window one column left.
17111
17112 @kindex Right
17113 @item @key{Right}
17114 Scroll the active window one column right.
17115
17116 @kindex C-L
17117 @item @kbd{C-L}
17118 Refresh the screen.
17119 @end table
17120
17121 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
17122 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
17123 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
17124 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
17125 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
17126
17127 @node TUI Single Key Mode
17128 @section TUI Single Key Mode
17129 @cindex TUI single key mode
17130
17131 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
17132 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
17133 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
17134
17135 @table @kbd
17136 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17137 @item c
17138 continue
17139
17140 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17141 @item d
17142 down
17143
17144 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17145 @item f
17146 finish
17147
17148 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17149 @item n
17150 next
17151
17152 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17153 @item q
17154 exit the SingleKey mode.
17155
17156 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17157 @item r
17158 run
17159
17160 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17161 @item s
17162 step
17163
17164 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17165 @item u
17166 up
17167
17168 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17169 @item v
17170 info locals
17171
17172 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17173 @item w
17174 where
17175 @end table
17176
17177 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
17178 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
17179 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
17180 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
17181 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
17182 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
17183
17184
17185 @node TUI Commands
17186 @section TUI-specific Commands
17187 @cindex TUI commands
17188
17189 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
17190 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
17191 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
17192 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
17193
17194 @table @code
17195 @item info win
17196 @kindex info win
17197 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
17198
17199 @item layout next
17200 @kindex layout
17201 Display the next layout.
17202
17203 @item layout prev
17204 Display the previous layout.
17205
17206 @item layout src
17207 Display the source window only.
17208
17209 @item layout asm
17210 Display the assembly window only.
17211
17212 @item layout split
17213 Display the source and assembly window.
17214
17215 @item layout regs
17216 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
17217
17218 @item focus next
17219 @kindex focus
17220 Make the next window active for scrolling.
17221
17222 @item focus prev
17223 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
17224
17225 @item focus src
17226 Make the source window active for scrolling.
17227
17228 @item focus asm
17229 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
17230
17231 @item focus regs
17232 Make the register window active for scrolling.
17233
17234 @item focus cmd
17235 Make the command window active for scrolling.
17236
17237 @item refresh
17238 @kindex refresh
17239 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
17240
17241 @item tui reg float
17242 @kindex tui reg
17243 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
17244
17245 @item tui reg general
17246 Show the general registers in the register window.
17247
17248 @item tui reg next
17249 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
17250 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
17251 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
17252 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
17253
17254 @item tui reg system
17255 Show the system registers in the register window.
17256
17257 @item update
17258 @kindex update
17259 Update the source window and the current execution point.
17260
17261 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
17262 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
17263 @kindex winheight
17264 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
17265 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
17266 decrease it.
17267
17268 @item tabset @var{nchars}
17269 @kindex tabset
17270 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
17271 @end table
17272
17273 @node TUI Configuration
17274 @section TUI Configuration Variables
17275 @cindex TUI configuration variables
17276
17277 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
17278
17279 @table @code
17280 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
17281 @kindex set tui border-kind
17282 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
17283 The possible values are the following:
17284 @table @code
17285 @item space
17286 Use a space character to draw the border.
17287
17288 @item ascii
17289 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
17290
17291 @item acs
17292 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
17293 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
17294 @end table
17295
17296 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
17297 @kindex set tui border-mode
17298 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
17299 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
17300 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
17301 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
17302 @table @code
17303 @item normal
17304 Use normal attributes to display the border.
17305
17306 @item standout
17307 Use standout mode.
17308
17309 @item reverse
17310 Use reverse video mode.
17311
17312 @item half
17313 Use half bright mode.
17314
17315 @item half-standout
17316 Use half bright and standout mode.
17317
17318 @item bold
17319 Use extra bright or bold mode.
17320
17321 @item bold-standout
17322 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
17323 @end table
17324 @end table
17325
17326 @node Emacs
17327 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
17328
17329 @cindex Emacs
17330 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
17331 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
17332 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
17333 @value{GDBN}.
17334
17335 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
17336 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
17337 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
17338 created Emacs buffer.
17339 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
17340
17341 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
17342 things:
17343
17344 @itemize @bullet
17345 @item
17346 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
17347 the GUD buffer.
17348
17349 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
17350 and output done by the program you are debugging.
17351
17352 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
17353 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
17354 in this way.
17355
17356 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
17357 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
17358 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
17359 stop.
17360
17361 @item
17362 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
17363
17364 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
17365 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
17366 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
17367 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
17368 and the source.
17369
17370 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
17371 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
17372 @end itemize
17373
17374 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
17375 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
17376 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
17377 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
17378
17379 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
17380 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
17381 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
17382 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
17383 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
17384 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
17385 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
17386 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
17387 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
17388
17389 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
17390 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
17391 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
17392 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
17393
17394 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
17395 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
17396 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
17397 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
17398 one you want.
17399
17400 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
17401 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
17402
17403 @table @kbd
17404 @item C-h m
17405 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
17406
17407 @item C-c C-s
17408 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
17409 update the display window to show the current file and location.
17410
17411 @item C-c C-n
17412 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
17413 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
17414 to show the current file and location.
17415
17416 @item C-c C-i
17417 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
17418 display window accordingly.
17419
17420 @item C-c C-f
17421 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
17422 @code{finish} command.
17423
17424 @item C-c C-r
17425 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
17426 command.
17427
17428 @item C-c <
17429 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
17430 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
17431 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
17432
17433 @item C-c >
17434 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
17435 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
17436 @end table
17437
17438 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
17439 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
17440
17441 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
17442 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
17443 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
17444 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
17445 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
17446 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
17447 speedbar displays watch expressions.
17448
17449 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
17450 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
17451 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
17452 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
17453 frame.
17454
17455 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
17456 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
17457 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
17458 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
17459 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
17460 to correspond properly with the code.
17461
17462 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
17463 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
17464 Emacs Manual}).
17465
17466 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
17467 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
17468 @ignore
17469 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
17470 @kindex Epoch
17471 @kindex inspect
17472
17473 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
17474 called the @code{epoch}
17475 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
17476 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
17477 each value is printed in its own window.
17478 @end ignore
17479
17480
17481 @node GDB/MI
17482 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
17483
17484 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
17485
17486 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
17487 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
17488 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
17489 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
17490 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
17491 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
17492
17493 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
17494 in the form of a reference manual.
17495
17496 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
17497 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
17498 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
17499
17500 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
17501
17502 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
17503 This chapter uses the following notation:
17504
17505 @itemize @bullet
17506 @item
17507 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
17508
17509 @item
17510 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
17511 it may or may not be given.
17512
17513 @item
17514 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17515 may repeat zero or more times.
17516
17517 @item
17518 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17519 may repeat one or more times.
17520
17521 @item
17522 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
17523 @end itemize
17524
17525 @ignore
17526 @heading Dependencies
17527 @end ignore
17528
17529 @menu
17530 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
17531 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
17532 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
17533 * GDB/MI Output Records::
17534 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
17535 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
17536 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
17537 * GDB/MI Program Context::
17538 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
17539 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
17540 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
17541 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
17542 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
17543 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
17544 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
17545 * GDB/MI File Commands::
17546 @ignore
17547 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
17548 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
17549 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
17550 @end ignore
17551 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
17552 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
17553 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
17554 @end menu
17555
17556 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17557 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
17558 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
17559
17560 @menu
17561 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
17562 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
17563 @end menu
17564
17565 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
17566 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
17567
17568 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
17569 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
17570 @table @code
17571 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
17572 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
17573
17574 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
17575 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
17576 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
17577
17578 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
17579 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
17580 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
17581
17582 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17583 "any sequence of digits"
17584
17585 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
17586 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
17587
17588 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
17589 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
17590
17591 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
17592 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
17593
17594 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
17595 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
17596 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
17597
17598 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
17599 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
17600
17601 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17602 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17603 @end table
17604
17605 @noindent
17606 Notes:
17607
17608 @itemize @bullet
17609 @item
17610 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
17611 output is described below.
17612
17613 @item
17614 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
17615 finishes.
17616
17617 @item
17618 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
17619 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
17620 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
17621 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
17622 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
17623 @end itemize
17624
17625 Pragmatics:
17626
17627 @itemize @bullet
17628 @item
17629 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
17630
17631 @item
17632 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
17633 @end itemize
17634
17635 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
17636 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
17637
17638 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
17639 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
17640 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
17641 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
17642 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
17643 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
17644
17645 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
17646 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
17647 @var{token}.
17648
17649 @table @code
17650 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
17651 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
17652
17653 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
17654 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17655
17656 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
17657 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
17658
17659 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
17660 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
17661
17662 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
17663 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
17664
17665 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
17666 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
17667
17668 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
17669 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
17670
17671 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
17672 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17673
17674 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
17675 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
17676
17677 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
17678 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
17679 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
17680
17681 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
17682 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
17683
17684 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
17685 @code{ @var{string} }
17686
17687 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
17688 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
17689
17690 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
17691 @code{@var{c-string}}
17692
17693 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
17694 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
17695
17696 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
17697 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
17698 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
17699
17700 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
17701 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
17702
17703 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
17704 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
17705
17706 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
17707 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
17708
17709 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
17710 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
17711
17712 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17713 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17714
17715 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17716 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
17717 @end table
17718
17719 @noindent
17720 Notes:
17721
17722 @itemize @bullet
17723 @item
17724 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
17725
17726 @item
17727 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
17728 command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
17729 @var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
17730 original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
17731
17732 @item
17733 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17734 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
17735 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
17736 prefixed by @samp{+}.
17737
17738 @item
17739 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17740 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
17741 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
17742 @samp{*}.
17743
17744 @item
17745 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17746 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
17747 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
17748 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
17749
17750 @item
17751 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17752 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
17753 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
17754 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
17755
17756 @item
17757 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17758 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
17759 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
17760
17761 @item
17762 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17763 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
17764 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
17765 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
17766
17767 @item
17768 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17769 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
17770 @var{values}.
17771
17772
17773 @end itemize
17774
17775 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
17776 details about the various output records.
17777
17778 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17779 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
17780 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
17781
17782 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
17783 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
17784
17785 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
17786 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
17787 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
17788 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
17789 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
17790 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
17791
17792 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
17793 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
17794 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
17795
17796 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17797 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
17798 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
17799 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
17800
17801 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
17802 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
17803
17804 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
17805 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
17806 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
17807 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
17808 might change.
17809
17810 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
17811 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
17812 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
17813 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
17814
17815 @itemize @bullet
17816 @item
17817 New MI commands may be added.
17818
17819 @item
17820 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
17821
17822 @item
17823 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
17824 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
17825
17826 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
17827 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
17828
17829 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
17830 @c resolve inconsistencies.
17831 @end itemize
17832
17833 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
17834 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
17835 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
17836 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
17837 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
17838
17839 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
17840 @c version?
17841
17842 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
17843 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
17844 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
17845 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}. There is also the mailing list
17846 @email{dmi-discuss@@lists.freestandards.org}, hosted by the Free Standards
17847 Group, which has the aim of creating a more general MI protocol
17848 called Debugger Machine Interface (DMI) that will become a standard
17849 for all debuggers, not just @value{GDBN}.
17850 @cindex mailing lists
17851
17852 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17853 @node GDB/MI Output Records
17854 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
17855
17856 @menu
17857 * GDB/MI Result Records::
17858 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
17859 * GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
17860 @end menu
17861
17862 @node GDB/MI Result Records
17863 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
17864
17865 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17866 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
17867 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
17868 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
17869
17870 @table @code
17871 @findex ^done
17872 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
17873 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
17874 values.
17875
17876 @item "^running"
17877 @findex ^running
17878 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
17879 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
17880 running.
17881
17882 @item "^connected"
17883 @findex ^connected
17884 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
17885
17886 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
17887 @findex ^error
17888 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
17889 error message.
17890
17891 @item "^exit"
17892 @findex ^exit
17893 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
17894
17895 @end table
17896
17897 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
17898 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
17899
17900 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
17901 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17902 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
17903 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
17904 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
17905
17906 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
17907 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
17908 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
17909 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
17910 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
17911
17912 @table @code
17913 @item "~" @var{string-output}
17914 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
17915 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
17916
17917 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
17918 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
17919 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
17920 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
17921
17922 @item "&" @var{string-output}
17923 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
17924 internals.
17925 @end table
17926
17927 @node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
17928 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
17929
17930 @cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17931 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
17932 @dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
17933 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
17934 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
17935 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
17936
17937 The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
17938 In particular, the @var{exec-async-output} records.
17939
17940 @table @code
17941 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
17942 @end table
17943
17944 @var{reason} can be one of the following:
17945
17946 @table @code
17947 @item breakpoint-hit
17948 A breakpoint was reached.
17949 @item watchpoint-trigger
17950 A watchpoint was triggered.
17951 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
17952 A read watchpoint was triggered.
17953 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
17954 An access watchpoint was triggered.
17955 @item function-finished
17956 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17957 @item location-reached
17958 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17959 @item watchpoint-scope
17960 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
17961 @item end-stepping-range
17962 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
17963 similar CLI command was accomplished.
17964 @item exited-signalled
17965 The inferior exited because of a signal.
17966 @item exited
17967 The inferior exited.
17968 @item exited-normally
17969 The inferior exited normally.
17970 @item signal-received
17971 A signal was received by the inferior.
17972 @end table
17973
17974
17975 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17976 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
17977 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
17978 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
17979
17980 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
17981 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
17982 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
17983 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
17984
17985 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
17986 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
17987
17988 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
17989
17990 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
17991 information of the breakpoint.
17992
17993 @smallexample
17994 -> -break-insert main
17995 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
17996 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
17997 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
17998 <- (gdb)
17999 @end smallexample
18000
18001 @subheading Program Execution
18002
18003 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
18004 reason that execution stopped.
18005
18006 @smallexample
18007 -> -exec-run
18008 <- ^running
18009 <- (gdb)
18010 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
18011 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
18012 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
18013 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
18014 <- (gdb)
18015 -> -exec-continue
18016 <- ^running
18017 <- (gdb)
18018 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
18019 <- (gdb)
18020 @end smallexample
18021
18022 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
18023
18024 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
18025
18026 @smallexample
18027 -> (gdb)
18028 <- -gdb-exit
18029 <- ^exit
18030 @end smallexample
18031
18032 @subheading A Bad Command
18033
18034 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
18035
18036 @smallexample
18037 -> -rubbish
18038 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
18039 <- (gdb)
18040 @end smallexample
18041
18042
18043 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18044 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
18045 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
18046
18047 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
18048 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
18049
18050 @subheading Motivation
18051
18052 The motivation for this collection of commands.
18053
18054 @subheading Introduction
18055
18056 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
18057
18058 @subheading Commands
18059
18060 For each command in the block, the following is described:
18061
18062 @subsubheading Synopsis
18063
18064 @smallexample
18065 -command @var{args}@dots{}
18066 @end smallexample
18067
18068 @subsubheading Result
18069
18070 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18071
18072 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
18073
18074 @subsubheading Example
18075
18076 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
18077 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
18078
18079
18080 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18081 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
18082 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
18083
18084 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
18085 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
18086 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
18087 breakpoints.
18088
18089 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
18090 @findex -break-after
18091
18092 @subsubheading Synopsis
18093
18094 @smallexample
18095 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
18096 @end smallexample
18097
18098 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
18099 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
18100 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
18101 @samp{-break-list} command below.
18102
18103 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18104
18105 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
18106
18107 @subsubheading Example
18108
18109 @smallexample
18110 (gdb)
18111 -break-insert main
18112 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",
18113 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
18114 (gdb)
18115 -break-after 1 3
18116 ~
18117 ^done
18118 (gdb)
18119 -break-list
18120 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18121 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18122 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18123 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18124 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18125 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18126 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18127 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18128 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18129 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18130 (gdb)
18131 @end smallexample
18132
18133 @ignore
18134 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
18135 @findex -break-catch
18136
18137 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
18138 @findex -break-commands
18139 @end ignore
18140
18141
18142 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
18143 @findex -break-condition
18144
18145 @subsubheading Synopsis
18146
18147 @smallexample
18148 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
18149 @end smallexample
18150
18151 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
18152 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
18153 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
18154 command below).
18155
18156 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18157
18158 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
18159
18160 @subsubheading Example
18161
18162 @smallexample
18163 (gdb)
18164 -break-condition 1 1
18165 ^done
18166 (gdb)
18167 -break-list
18168 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18169 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18170 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18171 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18172 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18173 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18174 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18175 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18176 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18177 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18178 (gdb)
18179 @end smallexample
18180
18181 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
18182 @findex -break-delete
18183
18184 @subsubheading Synopsis
18185
18186 @smallexample
18187 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18188 @end smallexample
18189
18190 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
18191 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
18192
18193 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18194
18195 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
18196
18197 @subsubheading Example
18198
18199 @smallexample
18200 (gdb)
18201 -break-delete 1
18202 ^done
18203 (gdb)
18204 -break-list
18205 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18206 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18207 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18208 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18209 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18210 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18211 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18212 body=[]@}
18213 (gdb)
18214 @end smallexample
18215
18216 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
18217 @findex -break-disable
18218
18219 @subsubheading Synopsis
18220
18221 @smallexample
18222 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18223 @end smallexample
18224
18225 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
18226 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
18227
18228 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18229
18230 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
18231
18232 @subsubheading Example
18233
18234 @smallexample
18235 (gdb)
18236 -break-disable 2
18237 ^done
18238 (gdb)
18239 -break-list
18240 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18241 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18242 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18243 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18244 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18245 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18246 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18247 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
18248 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18249 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18250 (gdb)
18251 @end smallexample
18252
18253 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
18254 @findex -break-enable
18255
18256 @subsubheading Synopsis
18257
18258 @smallexample
18259 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18260 @end smallexample
18261
18262 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
18263
18264 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18265
18266 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
18267
18268 @subsubheading Example
18269
18270 @smallexample
18271 (gdb)
18272 -break-enable 2
18273 ^done
18274 (gdb)
18275 -break-list
18276 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18277 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18278 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18279 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18280 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18281 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18282 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18283 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18284 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18285 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18286 (gdb)
18287 @end smallexample
18288
18289 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
18290 @findex -break-info
18291
18292 @subsubheading Synopsis
18293
18294 @smallexample
18295 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
18296 @end smallexample
18297
18298 @c REDUNDANT???
18299 Get information about a single breakpoint.
18300
18301 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18302
18303 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
18304
18305 @subsubheading Example
18306 N.A.
18307
18308 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
18309 @findex -break-insert
18310
18311 @subsubheading Synopsis
18312
18313 @smallexample
18314 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ]
18315 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
18316 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
18317 @end smallexample
18318
18319 @noindent
18320 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
18321
18322 @itemize @bullet
18323 @item function
18324 @c @item +offset
18325 @c @item -offset
18326 @c @item linenum
18327 @item filename:linenum
18328 @item filename:function
18329 @item *address
18330 @end itemize
18331
18332 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
18333
18334 @table @samp
18335 @item -t
18336 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
18337 @item -h
18338 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
18339 @item -c @var{condition}
18340 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
18341 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
18342 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
18343 @item -f
18344 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
18345 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
18346 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
18347 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
18348 cannot be parsed.
18349 @end table
18350
18351 @subsubheading Result
18352
18353 The result is in the form:
18354
18355 @smallexample
18356 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
18357 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
18358 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
18359 times="@var{times}"@}
18360 @end smallexample
18361
18362 @noindent
18363 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
18364 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
18365 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
18366 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
18367 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
18368 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
18369 which use the same output).
18370
18371 Note: this format is open to change.
18372 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
18373
18374 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18375
18376 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
18377 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
18378
18379 @subsubheading Example
18380
18381 @smallexample
18382 (gdb)
18383 -break-insert main
18384 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
18385 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
18386 (gdb)
18387 -break-insert -t foo
18388 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
18389 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
18390 (gdb)
18391 -break-list
18392 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18393 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18394 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18395 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18396 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18397 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18398 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18399 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18400 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
18401 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
18402 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
18403 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
18404 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
18405 (gdb)
18406 -break-insert -r foo.*
18407 ~int foo(int, int);
18408 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
18409 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
18410 (gdb)
18411 @end smallexample
18412
18413 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
18414 @findex -break-list
18415
18416 @subsubheading Synopsis
18417
18418 @smallexample
18419 -break-list
18420 @end smallexample
18421
18422 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
18423
18424 @table @samp
18425 @item Number
18426 number of the breakpoint
18427 @item Type
18428 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
18429 @item Disposition
18430 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
18431 or @samp{nokeep}
18432 @item Enabled
18433 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
18434 @item Address
18435 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
18436 @item What
18437 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
18438 name, line number
18439 @item Times
18440 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
18441 @end table
18442
18443 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
18444 @code{body} field is an empty list.
18445
18446 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18447
18448 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
18449
18450 @subsubheading Example
18451
18452 @smallexample
18453 (gdb)
18454 -break-list
18455 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18456 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18457 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18458 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18459 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18460 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18461 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18462 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18463 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
18464 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18465 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18466 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
18467 (gdb)
18468 @end smallexample
18469
18470 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
18471
18472 @smallexample
18473 (gdb)
18474 -break-list
18475 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18476 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18477 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18478 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18479 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18480 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18481 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18482 body=[]@}
18483 (gdb)
18484 @end smallexample
18485
18486 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
18487 @findex -break-watch
18488
18489 @subsubheading Synopsis
18490
18491 @smallexample
18492 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
18493 @end smallexample
18494
18495 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
18496 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
18497 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
18498 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
18499 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
18500 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
18501 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
18502 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
18503
18504 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
18505 breakpoints inserted.
18506
18507 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18508
18509 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
18510 @samp{rwatch}.
18511
18512 @subsubheading Example
18513
18514 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
18515
18516 @smallexample
18517 (gdb)
18518 -break-watch x
18519 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
18520 (gdb)
18521 -exec-continue
18522 ^running
18523 (gdb)
18524 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
18525 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
18526 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18527 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
18528 (gdb)
18529 @end smallexample
18530
18531 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
18532 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
18533 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
18534
18535 @smallexample
18536 (gdb)
18537 -break-watch C
18538 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
18539 (gdb)
18540 -exec-continue
18541 ^running
18542 (gdb)
18543 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
18544 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18545 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18546 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18547 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18548 (gdb)
18549 -exec-continue
18550 ^running
18551 (gdb)
18552 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
18553 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18554 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18555 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18556 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18557 (gdb)
18558 @end smallexample
18559
18560 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
18561 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
18562 deleted.
18563
18564 @smallexample
18565 (gdb)
18566 -break-watch C
18567 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
18568 (gdb)
18569 -break-list
18570 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18571 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18572 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18573 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18574 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18575 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18576 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18577 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18578 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18579 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18580 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
18581 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18582 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
18583 (gdb)
18584 -exec-continue
18585 ^running
18586 (gdb)
18587 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
18588 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18589 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18590 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18591 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18592 (gdb)
18593 -break-list
18594 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18595 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18596 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18597 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18598 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18599 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18600 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18601 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18602 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18603 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18604 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
18605 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18606 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
18607 (gdb)
18608 -exec-continue
18609 ^running
18610 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
18611 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18612 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18613 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18614 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18615 (gdb)
18616 -break-list
18617 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18618 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18619 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18620 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18621 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18622 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18623 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18624 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18625 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18626 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18627 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
18628 times="1"@}]@}
18629 (gdb)
18630 @end smallexample
18631
18632 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18633 @node GDB/MI Program Context
18634 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
18635
18636 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
18637 @findex -exec-arguments
18638
18639
18640 @subsubheading Synopsis
18641
18642 @smallexample
18643 -exec-arguments @var{args}
18644 @end smallexample
18645
18646 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
18647 @samp{-exec-run}.
18648
18649 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18650
18651 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
18652
18653 @subsubheading Example
18654
18655 @c FIXME!
18656 Don't have one around.
18657
18658
18659 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
18660 @findex -exec-show-arguments
18661
18662 @subsubheading Synopsis
18663
18664 @smallexample
18665 -exec-show-arguments
18666 @end smallexample
18667
18668 Print the arguments of the program.
18669
18670 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18671
18672 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
18673
18674 @subsubheading Example
18675 N.A.
18676
18677
18678 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
18679 @findex -environment-cd
18680
18681 @subsubheading Synopsis
18682
18683 @smallexample
18684 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
18685 @end smallexample
18686
18687 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
18688
18689 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18690
18691 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
18692
18693 @subsubheading Example
18694
18695 @smallexample
18696 (gdb)
18697 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18698 ^done
18699 (gdb)
18700 @end smallexample
18701
18702
18703 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
18704 @findex -environment-directory
18705
18706 @subsubheading Synopsis
18707
18708 @smallexample
18709 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18710 @end smallexample
18711
18712 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
18713 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
18714 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
18715 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18716 occurs as normal.
18717 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18718 multiple directories in a single command
18719 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18720 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18721 If blanks are needed as
18722 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18723 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18724 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18725 character must not be used
18726 in any directory name.
18727 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
18728
18729 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18730
18731 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
18732
18733 @subsubheading Example
18734
18735 @smallexample
18736 (gdb)
18737 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18738 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18739 (gdb)
18740 -environment-directory ""
18741 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18742 (gdb)
18743 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
18744 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
18745 (gdb)
18746 -environment-directory -r
18747 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
18748 (gdb)
18749 @end smallexample
18750
18751
18752 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
18753 @findex -environment-path
18754
18755 @subsubheading Synopsis
18756
18757 @smallexample
18758 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18759 @end smallexample
18760
18761 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
18762 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
18763 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
18764 supplied in addition to the
18765 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18766 occurs as normal.
18767 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18768 multiple directories in a single command
18769 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18770 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18771 If blanks are needed as
18772 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18773 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18774 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18775 character must not be used
18776 in any directory name.
18777 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
18778
18779
18780 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18781
18782 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
18783
18784 @subsubheading Example
18785
18786 @smallexample
18787 (gdb)
18788 -environment-path
18789 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
18790 (gdb)
18791 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
18792 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
18793 (gdb)
18794 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
18795 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
18796 (gdb)
18797 @end smallexample
18798
18799
18800 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
18801 @findex -environment-pwd
18802
18803 @subsubheading Synopsis
18804
18805 @smallexample
18806 -environment-pwd
18807 @end smallexample
18808
18809 Show the current working directory.
18810
18811 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18812
18813 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
18814
18815 @subsubheading Example
18816
18817 @smallexample
18818 (gdb)
18819 -environment-pwd
18820 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
18821 (gdb)
18822 @end smallexample
18823
18824 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18825 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
18826 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
18827
18828
18829 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
18830 @findex -thread-info
18831
18832 @subsubheading Synopsis
18833
18834 @smallexample
18835 -thread-info
18836 @end smallexample
18837
18838 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18839
18840 No equivalent.
18841
18842 @subsubheading Example
18843 N.A.
18844
18845
18846 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
18847 @findex -thread-list-all-threads
18848
18849 @subsubheading Synopsis
18850
18851 @smallexample
18852 -thread-list-all-threads
18853 @end smallexample
18854
18855 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18856
18857 The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
18858
18859 @subsubheading Example
18860 N.A.
18861
18862
18863 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
18864 @findex -thread-list-ids
18865
18866 @subsubheading Synopsis
18867
18868 @smallexample
18869 -thread-list-ids
18870 @end smallexample
18871
18872 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
18873 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
18874
18875 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18876
18877 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
18878
18879 @subsubheading Example
18880
18881 No threads present, besides the main process:
18882
18883 @smallexample
18884 (gdb)
18885 -thread-list-ids
18886 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
18887 (gdb)
18888 @end smallexample
18889
18890
18891 Several threads:
18892
18893 @smallexample
18894 (gdb)
18895 -thread-list-ids
18896 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18897 number-of-threads="3"
18898 (gdb)
18899 @end smallexample
18900
18901
18902 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
18903 @findex -thread-select
18904
18905 @subsubheading Synopsis
18906
18907 @smallexample
18908 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
18909 @end smallexample
18910
18911 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
18912 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
18913
18914 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18915
18916 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
18917
18918 @subsubheading Example
18919
18920 @smallexample
18921 (gdb)
18922 -exec-next
18923 ^running
18924 (gdb)
18925 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
18926 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
18927 (gdb)
18928 -thread-list-ids
18929 ^done,
18930 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18931 number-of-threads="3"
18932 (gdb)
18933 -thread-select 3
18934 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
18935 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
18936 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
18937 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
18938 (gdb)
18939 @end smallexample
18940
18941 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18942 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
18943 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
18944
18945 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
18946 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
18947 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
18948 other cases.
18949
18950 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
18951 @findex -exec-continue
18952
18953 @subsubheading Synopsis
18954
18955 @smallexample
18956 -exec-continue
18957 @end smallexample
18958
18959 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
18960 encountered, or until the inferior exits.
18961
18962 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18963
18964 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
18965
18966 @subsubheading Example
18967
18968 @smallexample
18969 -exec-continue
18970 ^running
18971 (gdb)
18972 @@Hello world
18973 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
18974 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="13"@}
18975 (gdb)
18976 @end smallexample
18977
18978
18979 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
18980 @findex -exec-finish
18981
18982 @subsubheading Synopsis
18983
18984 @smallexample
18985 -exec-finish
18986 @end smallexample
18987
18988 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
18989 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
18990
18991 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18992
18993 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
18994
18995 @subsubheading Example
18996
18997 Function returning @code{void}.
18998
18999 @smallexample
19000 -exec-finish
19001 ^running
19002 (gdb)
19003 @@hello from foo
19004 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19005 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
19006 (gdb)
19007 @end smallexample
19008
19009 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
19010 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
19011 value itself.
19012
19013 @smallexample
19014 -exec-finish
19015 ^running
19016 (gdb)
19017 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
19018 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
19019 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19020 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
19021 (gdb)
19022 @end smallexample
19023
19024
19025 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
19026 @findex -exec-interrupt
19027
19028 @subsubheading Synopsis
19029
19030 @smallexample
19031 -exec-interrupt
19032 @end smallexample
19033
19034 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
19035 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
19036 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
19037 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
19038 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
19039
19040 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19041
19042 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
19043
19044 @subsubheading Example
19045
19046 @smallexample
19047 (gdb)
19048 111-exec-continue
19049 111^running
19050
19051 (gdb)
19052 222-exec-interrupt
19053 222^done
19054 (gdb)
19055 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
19056 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19057 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
19058 (gdb)
19059
19060 (gdb)
19061 -exec-interrupt
19062 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
19063 (gdb)
19064 @end smallexample
19065
19066
19067 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
19068 @findex -exec-next
19069
19070 @subsubheading Synopsis
19071
19072 @smallexample
19073 -exec-next
19074 @end smallexample
19075
19076 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19077 of the next source line is reached.
19078
19079 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19080
19081 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
19082
19083 @subsubheading Example
19084
19085 @smallexample
19086 -exec-next
19087 ^running
19088 (gdb)
19089 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
19090 (gdb)
19091 @end smallexample
19092
19093
19094 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
19095 @findex -exec-next-instruction
19096
19097 @subsubheading Synopsis
19098
19099 @smallexample
19100 -exec-next-instruction
19101 @end smallexample
19102
19103 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
19104 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
19105 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
19106 printed as well.
19107
19108 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19109
19110 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
19111
19112 @subsubheading Example
19113
19114 @smallexample
19115 (gdb)
19116 -exec-next-instruction
19117 ^running
19118
19119 (gdb)
19120 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19121 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
19122 (gdb)
19123 @end smallexample
19124
19125
19126 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
19127 @findex -exec-return
19128
19129 @subsubheading Synopsis
19130
19131 @smallexample
19132 -exec-return
19133 @end smallexample
19134
19135 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
19136 Displays the new current frame.
19137
19138 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19139
19140 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
19141
19142 @subsubheading Example
19143
19144 @smallexample
19145 (gdb)
19146 200-break-insert callee4
19147 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
19148 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19149 (gdb)
19150 000-exec-run
19151 000^running
19152 (gdb)
19153 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
19154 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
19155 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19156 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19157 (gdb)
19158 205-break-delete
19159 205^done
19160 (gdb)
19161 111-exec-return
19162 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
19163 args=[@{name="strarg",
19164 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
19165 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19166 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
19167 (gdb)
19168 @end smallexample
19169
19170
19171 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
19172 @findex -exec-run
19173
19174 @subsubheading Synopsis
19175
19176 @smallexample
19177 -exec-run
19178 @end smallexample
19179
19180 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
19181 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
19182 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
19183 the program has exited exceptionally.
19184
19185 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19186
19187 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
19188
19189 @subsubheading Examples
19190
19191 @smallexample
19192 (gdb)
19193 -break-insert main
19194 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19195 (gdb)
19196 -exec-run
19197 ^running
19198 (gdb)
19199 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
19200 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
19201 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19202 (gdb)
19203 @end smallexample
19204
19205 @noindent
19206 Program exited normally:
19207
19208 @smallexample
19209 (gdb)
19210 -exec-run
19211 ^running
19212 (gdb)
19213 x = 55
19214 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
19215 (gdb)
19216 @end smallexample
19217
19218 @noindent
19219 Program exited exceptionally:
19220
19221 @smallexample
19222 (gdb)
19223 -exec-run
19224 ^running
19225 (gdb)
19226 x = 55
19227 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
19228 (gdb)
19229 @end smallexample
19230
19231 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
19232 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
19233
19234 @smallexample
19235 (gdb)
19236 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
19237 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
19238 @end smallexample
19239
19240
19241 @c @subheading -exec-signal
19242
19243
19244 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
19245 @findex -exec-step
19246
19247 @subsubheading Synopsis
19248
19249 @smallexample
19250 -exec-step
19251 @end smallexample
19252
19253 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19254 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
19255 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
19256 function.
19257
19258 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19259
19260 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
19261
19262 @subsubheading Example
19263
19264 Stepping into a function:
19265
19266 @smallexample
19267 -exec-step
19268 ^running
19269 (gdb)
19270 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19271 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
19272 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
19273 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
19274 (gdb)
19275 @end smallexample
19276
19277 Regular stepping:
19278
19279 @smallexample
19280 -exec-step
19281 ^running
19282 (gdb)
19283 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
19284 (gdb)
19285 @end smallexample
19286
19287
19288 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
19289 @findex -exec-step-instruction
19290
19291 @subsubheading Synopsis
19292
19293 @smallexample
19294 -exec-step-instruction
19295 @end smallexample
19296
19297 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
19298 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
19299 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
19300 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
19301 well.
19302
19303 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19304
19305 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
19306
19307 @subsubheading Example
19308
19309 @smallexample
19310 (gdb)
19311 -exec-step-instruction
19312 ^running
19313
19314 (gdb)
19315 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19316 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19317 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19318 (gdb)
19319 -exec-step-instruction
19320 ^running
19321
19322 (gdb)
19323 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19324 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19325 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19326 (gdb)
19327 @end smallexample
19328
19329
19330 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
19331 @findex -exec-until
19332
19333 @subsubheading Synopsis
19334
19335 @smallexample
19336 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
19337 @end smallexample
19338
19339 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
19340 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
19341 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
19342 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
19343
19344 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19345
19346 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
19347
19348 @subsubheading Example
19349
19350 @smallexample
19351 (gdb)
19352 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
19353 ^running
19354 (gdb)
19355 x = 55
19356 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19357 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
19358 (gdb)
19359 @end smallexample
19360
19361 @ignore
19362 @subheading -file-clear
19363 Is this going away????
19364 @end ignore
19365
19366 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19367 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
19368 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
19369
19370
19371 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
19372 @findex -stack-info-frame
19373
19374 @subsubheading Synopsis
19375
19376 @smallexample
19377 -stack-info-frame
19378 @end smallexample
19379
19380 Get info on the selected frame.
19381
19382 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19383
19384 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
19385 (without arguments).
19386
19387 @subsubheading Example
19388
19389 @smallexample
19390 (gdb)
19391 -stack-info-frame
19392 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19393 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19394 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
19395 (gdb)
19396 @end smallexample
19397
19398 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
19399 @findex -stack-info-depth
19400
19401 @subsubheading Synopsis
19402
19403 @smallexample
19404 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
19405 @end smallexample
19406
19407 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
19408 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
19409
19410 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19411
19412 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
19413
19414 @subsubheading Example
19415
19416 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
19417
19418 @smallexample
19419 (gdb)
19420 -stack-info-depth
19421 ^done,depth="12"
19422 (gdb)
19423 -stack-info-depth 4
19424 ^done,depth="4"
19425 (gdb)
19426 -stack-info-depth 12
19427 ^done,depth="12"
19428 (gdb)
19429 -stack-info-depth 11
19430 ^done,depth="11"
19431 (gdb)
19432 -stack-info-depth 13
19433 ^done,depth="12"
19434 (gdb)
19435 @end smallexample
19436
19437 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
19438 @findex -stack-list-arguments
19439
19440 @subsubheading Synopsis
19441
19442 @smallexample
19443 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
19444 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19445 @end smallexample
19446
19447 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
19448 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
19449 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
19450 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
19451 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
19452 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
19453 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
19454 which case only existing frames will be returned.
19455
19456 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
19457 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
19458 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
19459
19460 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19461
19462 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
19463 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
19464 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
19465
19466 @subsubheading Example
19467
19468 @smallexample
19469 (gdb)
19470 -stack-list-frames
19471 ^done,
19472 stack=[
19473 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19474 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19475 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
19476 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19477 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19478 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
19479 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
19480 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19481 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
19482 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
19483 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19484 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
19485 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
19486 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19487 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
19488 (gdb)
19489 -stack-list-arguments 0
19490 ^done,
19491 stack-args=[
19492 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19493 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
19494 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
19495 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
19496 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19497 (gdb)
19498 -stack-list-arguments 1
19499 ^done,
19500 stack-args=[
19501 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19502 frame=@{level="1",
19503 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19504 frame=@{level="2",args=[
19505 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19506 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19507 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
19508 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19509 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
19510 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
19511 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19512 (gdb)
19513 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
19514 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
19515 (gdb)
19516 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
19517 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
19518 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19519 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
19520 (gdb)
19521 @end smallexample
19522
19523 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
19524
19525
19526 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
19527 @findex -stack-list-frames
19528
19529 @subsubheading Synopsis
19530
19531 @smallexample
19532 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19533 @end smallexample
19534
19535 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
19536 following info:
19537
19538 @table @samp
19539 @item @var{level}
19540 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
19541 @item @var{addr}
19542 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
19543 @item @var{func}
19544 Function name.
19545 @item @var{file}
19546 File name of the source file where the function lives.
19547 @item @var{line}
19548 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
19549 @end table
19550
19551 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
19552 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
19553 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
19554 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
19555 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
19556 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
19557 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
19558
19559 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19560
19561 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
19562
19563 @subsubheading Example
19564
19565 Full stack backtrace:
19566
19567 @smallexample
19568 (gdb)
19569 -stack-list-frames
19570 ^done,stack=
19571 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
19572 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
19573 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19574 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19575 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19576 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19577 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19578 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19579 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19580 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19581 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19582 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19583 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19584 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19585 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19586 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19587 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19588 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19589 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19590 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19591 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19592 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19593 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
19594 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
19595 (gdb)
19596 @end smallexample
19597
19598 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
19599
19600 @smallexample
19601 (gdb)
19602 -stack-list-frames 3 5
19603 ^done,stack=
19604 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19605 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19606 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19607 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19608 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19609 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19610 (gdb)
19611 @end smallexample
19612
19613 Show a single frame:
19614
19615 @smallexample
19616 (gdb)
19617 -stack-list-frames 3 3
19618 ^done,stack=
19619 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19620 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19621 (gdb)
19622 @end smallexample
19623
19624
19625 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
19626 @findex -stack-list-locals
19627
19628 @subsubheading Synopsis
19629
19630 @smallexample
19631 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
19632 @end smallexample
19633
19634 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
19635 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
19636 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
19637 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
19638 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
19639 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
19640 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
19641 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
19642 more detail.
19643
19644 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19645
19646 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
19647
19648 @subsubheading Example
19649
19650 @smallexample
19651 (gdb)
19652 -stack-list-locals 0
19653 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
19654 (gdb)
19655 -stack-list-locals --all-values
19656 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
19657 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
19658 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
19659 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
19660 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
19661 (gdb)
19662 @end smallexample
19663
19664
19665 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
19666 @findex -stack-select-frame
19667
19668 @subsubheading Synopsis
19669
19670 @smallexample
19671 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
19672 @end smallexample
19673
19674 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
19675 the stack.
19676
19677 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19678
19679 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
19680 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
19681
19682 @subsubheading Example
19683
19684 @smallexample
19685 (gdb)
19686 -stack-select-frame 2
19687 ^done
19688 (gdb)
19689 @end smallexample
19690
19691 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19692 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
19693 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
19694
19695 @ignore
19696
19697 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19698
19699 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
19700 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
19701 used by @code{Insight}.
19702
19703 The two main reasons for that are:
19704
19705 @enumerate 1
19706 @item
19707 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
19708
19709 @item
19710 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
19711 now).
19712 @end enumerate
19713
19714 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
19715 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
19716 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
19717 hints about their use.
19718
19719 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
19720 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
19721 least, the following operations:
19722
19723 @itemize @bullet
19724 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
19725 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
19726 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
19727 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
19728 @end itemize
19729
19730 @end ignore
19731
19732 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
19733
19734 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19735
19736 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
19737 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
19738 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
19739 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
19740 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
19741 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
19742 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
19743 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
19744 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
19745 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
19746 object, or to change display format.
19747
19748 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
19749 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
19750 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
19751 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
19752 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
19753 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
19754 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
19755 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
19756 child will be created.
19757
19758 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
19759 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
19760 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
19761 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
19762 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
19763
19764 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
19765 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
19766 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
19767 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
19768 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
19769 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
19770 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
19771 variables that frontend has created.
19772
19773 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
19774 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
19775 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
19776 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
19777 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
19778 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
19779 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
19780 implicitly updated.
19781
19782 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
19783 access this functionality:
19784
19785 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
19786 @item @strong{Operation}
19787 @tab @strong{Description}
19788
19789 @item @code{-var-create}
19790 @tab create a variable object
19791 @item @code{-var-delete}
19792 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
19793 @item @code{-var-set-format}
19794 @tab set the display format of this variable
19795 @item @code{-var-show-format}
19796 @tab show the display format of this variable
19797 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
19798 @tab tells how many children this object has
19799 @item @code{-var-list-children}
19800 @tab return a list of the object's children
19801 @item @code{-var-info-type}
19802 @tab show the type of this variable object
19803 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
19804 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
19805 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
19806 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
19807 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
19808 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
19809 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
19810 @tab get the value of this variable
19811 @item @code{-var-assign}
19812 @tab set the value of this variable
19813 @item @code{-var-update}
19814 @tab update the variable and its children
19815 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
19816 @tab set frozeness attribute
19817 @end multitable
19818
19819 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
19820 how it can be used.
19821
19822 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
19823
19824 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
19825 @findex -var-create
19826
19827 @subsubheading Synopsis
19828
19829 @smallexample
19830 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
19831 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
19832 @end smallexample
19833
19834 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
19835 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
19836 register.
19837
19838 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
19839 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
19840 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
19841 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
19842 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
19843
19844 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
19845 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
19846 frame should be used.
19847
19848 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
19849 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
19850
19851 @itemize @bullet
19852 @item
19853 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
19854
19855 @item
19856 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
19857
19858 @item
19859 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
19860 @end itemize
19861
19862 @subsubheading Result
19863
19864 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
19865 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
19866 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
19867
19868 @smallexample
19869 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
19870 @end smallexample
19871
19872
19873 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
19874 @findex -var-delete
19875
19876 @subsubheading Synopsis
19877
19878 @smallexample
19879 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
19880 @end smallexample
19881
19882 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
19883 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
19884
19885 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
19886
19887
19888 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
19889 @findex -var-set-format
19890
19891 @subsubheading Synopsis
19892
19893 @smallexample
19894 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
19895 @end smallexample
19896
19897 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
19898 @var{format-spec}.
19899
19900 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
19901
19902 @smallexample
19903 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
19904 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
19905 @end smallexample
19906
19907 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
19908 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
19909 for pointers, etc.).
19910
19911 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
19912 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
19913
19914 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
19915 @findex -var-show-format
19916
19917 @subsubheading Synopsis
19918
19919 @smallexample
19920 -var-show-format @var{name}
19921 @end smallexample
19922
19923 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
19924
19925 @smallexample
19926 @var{format} @expansion{}
19927 @var{format-spec}
19928 @end smallexample
19929
19930
19931 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
19932 @findex -var-info-num-children
19933
19934 @subsubheading Synopsis
19935
19936 @smallexample
19937 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
19938 @end smallexample
19939
19940 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
19941
19942 @smallexample
19943 numchild=@var{n}
19944 @end smallexample
19945
19946
19947 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
19948 @findex -var-list-children
19949
19950 @subsubheading Synopsis
19951
19952 @smallexample
19953 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
19954 @end smallexample
19955 @anchor{-var-list-children}
19956
19957 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
19958 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
19959 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
19960 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
19961 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
19962 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
19963 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
19964 and unions.
19965
19966 @subsubheading Example
19967
19968 @smallexample
19969 (gdb)
19970 -var-list-children n
19971 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19972 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19973 (gdb)
19974 -var-list-children --all-values n
19975 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19976 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19977 @end smallexample
19978
19979
19980 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
19981 @findex -var-info-type
19982
19983 @subsubheading Synopsis
19984
19985 @smallexample
19986 -var-info-type @var{name}
19987 @end smallexample
19988
19989 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
19990 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
19991 @value{GDBN} CLI:
19992
19993 @smallexample
19994 type=@var{typename}
19995 @end smallexample
19996
19997
19998 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
19999 @findex -var-info-expression
20000
20001 @subsubheading Synopsis
20002
20003 @smallexample
20004 -var-info-expression @var{name}
20005 @end smallexample
20006
20007 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
20008 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
20009 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
20010
20011 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
20012 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
20013
20014 @smallexample
20015 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
20016 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
20017 @end smallexample
20018
20019 @noindent
20020 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
20021
20022 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
20023 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
20024 is of limited use.
20025
20026 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
20027 @findex -var-info-path-expression
20028
20029 @subsubheading Synopsis
20030
20031 @smallexample
20032 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
20033 @end smallexample
20034
20035 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
20036 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
20037 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
20038 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
20039 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
20040 watchpoint from a variable object.
20041
20042 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
20043 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
20044 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
20045 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
20046 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
20047 @smallexample
20048 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
20049 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
20050 @end smallexample
20051
20052 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
20053 @findex -var-show-attributes
20054
20055 @subsubheading Synopsis
20056
20057 @smallexample
20058 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
20059 @end smallexample
20060
20061 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
20062
20063 @smallexample
20064 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
20065 @end smallexample
20066
20067 @noindent
20068 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
20069
20070 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
20071 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
20072
20073 @subsubheading Synopsis
20074
20075 @smallexample
20076 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
20077 @end smallexample
20078
20079 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
20080 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the
20081 string can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
20082
20083 @smallexample
20084 value=@var{value}
20085 @end smallexample
20086
20087 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
20088 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
20089
20090 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
20091 @findex -var-assign
20092
20093 @subsubheading Synopsis
20094
20095 @smallexample
20096 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
20097 @end smallexample
20098
20099 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
20100 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
20101 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
20102 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
20103
20104 @subsubheading Example
20105
20106 @smallexample
20107 (gdb)
20108 -var-assign var1 3
20109 ^done,value="3"
20110 (gdb)
20111 -var-update *
20112 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
20113 (gdb)
20114 @end smallexample
20115
20116 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
20117 @findex -var-update
20118
20119 @subsubheading Synopsis
20120
20121 @smallexample
20122 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
20123 @end smallexample
20124
20125 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
20126 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
20127 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
20128 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
20129 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
20130 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
20131 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
20132 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
20133 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
20134 names are printed. The possible values of this options are the same
20135 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
20136 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
20137 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
20138
20139
20140 @subsubheading Example
20141
20142 @smallexample
20143 (gdb)
20144 -var-assign var1 3
20145 ^done,value="3"
20146 (gdb)
20147 -var-update --all-values var1
20148 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
20149 type_changed="false"@}]
20150 (gdb)
20151 @end smallexample
20152
20153 @anchor{-var-update}
20154 The field in_scope may take three values:
20155
20156 @table @code
20157 @item "true"
20158 The variable object's current value is valid.
20159
20160 @item "false"
20161 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
20162 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
20163 scope.
20164
20165 @item "invalid"
20166 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
20167 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
20168 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
20169 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
20170 objects.
20171 @end table
20172
20173 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
20174 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
20175
20176 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
20177 @findex -var-set-frozen
20178 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
20179
20180 @subsubheading Synopsis
20181
20182 @smallexample
20183 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
20184 @end smallexample
20185
20186 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
20187 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
20188 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
20189 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
20190 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
20191 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
20192 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
20193 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
20194 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
20195 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
20196 @code{-var-update} does.
20197
20198 @subsubheading Example
20199
20200 @smallexample
20201 (gdb)
20202 -var-set-frozen V 1
20203 ^done
20204 (gdb)
20205 @end smallexample
20206
20207
20208 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20209 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
20210 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
20211
20212 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
20213 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
20214 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
20215 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
20216
20217 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
20218 @c @subheading -data-assign
20219 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
20220 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
20221 @c set variable
20222 @c @subsubheading Example
20223 @c N.A.
20224
20225 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
20226 @findex -data-disassemble
20227
20228 @subsubheading Synopsis
20229
20230 @smallexample
20231 -data-disassemble
20232 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
20233 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
20234 -- @var{mode}
20235 @end smallexample
20236
20237 @noindent
20238 Where:
20239
20240 @table @samp
20241 @item @var{start-addr}
20242 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
20243 @item @var{end-addr}
20244 is the end address
20245 @item @var{filename}
20246 is the name of the file to disassemble
20247 @item @var{linenum}
20248 is the line number to disassemble around
20249 @item @var{lines}
20250 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
20251 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
20252 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
20253 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
20254 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
20255 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
20256 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
20257 are displayed.
20258 @item @var{mode}
20259 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
20260 disassembly).
20261 @end table
20262
20263 @subsubheading Result
20264
20265 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
20266
20267 @itemize @bullet
20268 @item Address
20269 @item Func-name
20270 @item Offset
20271 @item Instruction
20272 @end itemize
20273
20274 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
20275 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
20276
20277 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20278
20279 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
20280
20281 @subsubheading Example
20282
20283 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
20284
20285 @smallexample
20286 (gdb)
20287 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
20288 ^done,
20289 asm_insns=[
20290 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20291 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20292 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20293 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20294 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
20295 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
20296 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
20297 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20298 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
20299 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
20300 (gdb)
20301 @end smallexample
20302
20303 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
20304 @code{main}.
20305
20306 @smallexample
20307 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
20308 ^done,asm_insns=[
20309 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20310 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20311 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20312 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20313 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20314 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20315 [@dots{}]
20316 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
20317 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
20318 (gdb)
20319 @end smallexample
20320
20321 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
20322
20323 @smallexample
20324 (gdb)
20325 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
20326 ^done,asm_insns=[
20327 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20328 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20329 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20330 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20331 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20332 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
20333 (gdb)
20334 @end smallexample
20335
20336 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
20337
20338 @smallexample
20339 (gdb)
20340 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
20341 ^done,asm_insns=[
20342 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
20343 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20344 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20345 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20346 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
20347 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
20348 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20349 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20350 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20351 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20352 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20353 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
20354 (gdb)
20355 @end smallexample
20356
20357
20358 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
20359 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
20360
20361 @subsubheading Synopsis
20362
20363 @smallexample
20364 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
20365 @end smallexample
20366
20367 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
20368 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
20369 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
20370
20371 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20372
20373 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
20374 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
20375 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
20376
20377 @subsubheading Example
20378
20379 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
20380 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
20381 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
20382 output.
20383
20384 @smallexample
20385 211-data-evaluate-expression A
20386 211^done,value="1"
20387 (gdb)
20388 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
20389 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
20390 (gdb)
20391 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
20392 411^done,value="4"
20393 (gdb)
20394 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
20395 511^done,value="4"
20396 (gdb)
20397 @end smallexample
20398
20399
20400 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
20401 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
20402
20403 @subsubheading Synopsis
20404
20405 @smallexample
20406 -data-list-changed-registers
20407 @end smallexample
20408
20409 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
20410
20411 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20412
20413 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
20414 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
20415
20416 @subsubheading Example
20417
20418 On a PPC MBX board:
20419
20420 @smallexample
20421 (gdb)
20422 -exec-continue
20423 ^running
20424
20425 (gdb)
20426 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
20427 args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="5"@}
20428 (gdb)
20429 -data-list-changed-registers
20430 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
20431 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
20432 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
20433 (gdb)
20434 @end smallexample
20435
20436
20437 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
20438 @findex -data-list-register-names
20439
20440 @subsubheading Synopsis
20441
20442 @smallexample
20443 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
20444 @end smallexample
20445
20446 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
20447 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
20448 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
20449 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
20450 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
20451 include empty register names.
20452
20453 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20454
20455 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
20456 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
20457 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
20458
20459 @subsubheading Example
20460
20461 For the PPC MBX board:
20462 @smallexample
20463 (gdb)
20464 -data-list-register-names
20465 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
20466 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
20467 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
20468 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
20469 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
20470 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
20471 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
20472 (gdb)
20473 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
20474 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
20475 (gdb)
20476 @end smallexample
20477
20478 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
20479 @findex -data-list-register-values
20480
20481 @subsubheading Synopsis
20482
20483 @smallexample
20484 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
20485 @end smallexample
20486
20487 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
20488 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
20489 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
20490 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
20491
20492 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
20493
20494 @table @code
20495 @item x
20496 Hexadecimal
20497 @item o
20498 Octal
20499 @item t
20500 Binary
20501 @item d
20502 Decimal
20503 @item r
20504 Raw
20505 @item N
20506 Natural
20507 @end table
20508
20509 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20510
20511 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
20512 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
20513
20514 @subsubheading Example
20515
20516 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
20517 don't appear in the actual output):
20518
20519 @smallexample
20520 (gdb)
20521 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
20522 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20523 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
20524 (gdb)
20525 -data-list-register-values x
20526 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
20527 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20528 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
20529 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
20530 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
20531 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
20532 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
20533 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
20534 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
20535 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20536 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
20537 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
20538 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
20539 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
20540 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
20541 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
20542 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
20543 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
20544 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
20545 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
20546 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
20547 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
20548 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
20549 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
20550 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
20551 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
20552 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
20553 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
20554 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
20555 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
20556 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
20557 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
20558 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20559 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
20560 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
20561 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
20562 (gdb)
20563 @end smallexample
20564
20565
20566 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
20567 @findex -data-read-memory
20568
20569 @subsubheading Synopsis
20570
20571 @smallexample
20572 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
20573 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
20574 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
20575 @end smallexample
20576
20577 @noindent
20578 where:
20579
20580 @table @samp
20581 @item @var{address}
20582 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
20583 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
20584 quoted using the C convention.
20585
20586 @item @var{word-format}
20587 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
20588 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
20589 ,Output Formats}).
20590
20591 @item @var{word-size}
20592 The size of each memory word in bytes.
20593
20594 @item @var{nr-rows}
20595 The number of rows in the output table.
20596
20597 @item @var{nr-cols}
20598 The number of columns in the output table.
20599
20600 @item @var{aschar}
20601 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
20602 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
20603 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
20604 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
20605
20606 @item @var{byte-offset}
20607 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
20608 @end table
20609
20610 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
20611 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
20612 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
20613 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
20614 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
20615 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
20616 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
20617 @samp{addr}.
20618
20619 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
20620 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
20621 @samp{prev-page}.
20622
20623 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20624
20625 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
20626 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
20627
20628 @subsubheading Example
20629
20630 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
20631 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
20632 word. Display each word in hex.
20633
20634 @smallexample
20635 (gdb)
20636 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
20637 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
20638 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
20639 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
20640 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
20641 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
20642 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
20643 (gdb)
20644 @end smallexample
20645
20646 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
20647 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
20648
20649 @smallexample
20650 (gdb)
20651 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
20652 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
20653 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
20654 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
20655 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
20656 (gdb)
20657 @end smallexample
20658
20659 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
20660 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
20661 used as the non-printable character.
20662
20663 @smallexample
20664 (gdb)
20665 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
20666 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
20667 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
20668 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
20669 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20670 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20671 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20672 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20673 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
20674 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
20675 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
20676 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
20677 (gdb)
20678 @end smallexample
20679
20680 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20681 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
20682 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
20683
20684 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
20685
20686 @c @subheading -trace-actions
20687
20688 @c @subheading -trace-delete
20689
20690 @c @subheading -trace-disable
20691
20692 @c @subheading -trace-dump
20693
20694 @c @subheading -trace-enable
20695
20696 @c @subheading -trace-exists
20697
20698 @c @subheading -trace-find
20699
20700 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
20701
20702 @c @subheading -trace-info
20703
20704 @c @subheading -trace-insert
20705
20706 @c @subheading -trace-list
20707
20708 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
20709
20710 @c @subheading -trace-save
20711
20712 @c @subheading -trace-start
20713
20714 @c @subheading -trace-stop
20715
20716
20717 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20718 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
20719 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
20720
20721
20722 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
20723 @findex -symbol-info-address
20724
20725 @subsubheading Synopsis
20726
20727 @smallexample
20728 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
20729 @end smallexample
20730
20731 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
20732
20733 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20734
20735 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
20736
20737 @subsubheading Example
20738 N.A.
20739
20740
20741 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
20742 @findex -symbol-info-file
20743
20744 @subsubheading Synopsis
20745
20746 @smallexample
20747 -symbol-info-file
20748 @end smallexample
20749
20750 Show the file for the symbol.
20751
20752 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20753
20754 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
20755 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
20756
20757 @subsubheading Example
20758 N.A.
20759
20760
20761 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
20762 @findex -symbol-info-function
20763
20764 @subsubheading Synopsis
20765
20766 @smallexample
20767 -symbol-info-function
20768 @end smallexample
20769
20770 Show which function the symbol lives in.
20771
20772 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20773
20774 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
20775
20776 @subsubheading Example
20777 N.A.
20778
20779
20780 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
20781 @findex -symbol-info-line
20782
20783 @subsubheading Synopsis
20784
20785 @smallexample
20786 -symbol-info-line
20787 @end smallexample
20788
20789 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
20790
20791 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20792
20793 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
20794 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
20795
20796 @subsubheading Example
20797 N.A.
20798
20799
20800 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
20801 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
20802
20803 @subsubheading Synopsis
20804
20805 @smallexample
20806 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
20807 @end smallexample
20808
20809 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
20810
20811 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20812
20813 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
20814
20815 @subsubheading Example
20816 N.A.
20817
20818
20819 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
20820 @findex -symbol-list-functions
20821
20822 @subsubheading Synopsis
20823
20824 @smallexample
20825 -symbol-list-functions
20826 @end smallexample
20827
20828 List the functions in the executable.
20829
20830 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20831
20832 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
20833 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20834
20835 @subsubheading Example
20836 N.A.
20837
20838
20839 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
20840 @findex -symbol-list-lines
20841
20842 @subsubheading Synopsis
20843
20844 @smallexample
20845 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
20846 @end smallexample
20847
20848 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
20849 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
20850 ascending PC order.
20851
20852 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20853
20854 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
20855
20856 @subsubheading Example
20857 @smallexample
20858 (gdb)
20859 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
20860 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
20861 (gdb)
20862 @end smallexample
20863
20864
20865 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
20866 @findex -symbol-list-types
20867
20868 @subsubheading Synopsis
20869
20870 @smallexample
20871 -symbol-list-types
20872 @end smallexample
20873
20874 List all the type names.
20875
20876 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20877
20878 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
20879 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20880
20881 @subsubheading Example
20882 N.A.
20883
20884
20885 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
20886 @findex -symbol-list-variables
20887
20888 @subsubheading Synopsis
20889
20890 @smallexample
20891 -symbol-list-variables
20892 @end smallexample
20893
20894 List all the global and static variable names.
20895
20896 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20897
20898 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20899
20900 @subsubheading Example
20901 N.A.
20902
20903
20904 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
20905 @findex -symbol-locate
20906
20907 @subsubheading Synopsis
20908
20909 @smallexample
20910 -symbol-locate
20911 @end smallexample
20912
20913 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20914
20915 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
20916
20917 @subsubheading Example
20918 N.A.
20919
20920
20921 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
20922 @findex -symbol-type
20923
20924 @subsubheading Synopsis
20925
20926 @smallexample
20927 -symbol-type @var{variable}
20928 @end smallexample
20929
20930 Show type of @var{variable}.
20931
20932 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20933
20934 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
20935 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
20936
20937 @subsubheading Example
20938 N.A.
20939
20940
20941 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20942 @node GDB/MI File Commands
20943 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
20944
20945 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
20946 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
20947
20948 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
20949 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
20950
20951 @subsubheading Synopsis
20952
20953 @smallexample
20954 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
20955 @end smallexample
20956
20957 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
20958 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
20959 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
20960 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
20961 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
20962 notification.
20963
20964 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20965
20966 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
20967
20968 @subsubheading Example
20969
20970 @smallexample
20971 (gdb)
20972 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20973 ^done
20974 (gdb)
20975 @end smallexample
20976
20977
20978 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
20979 @findex -file-exec-file
20980
20981 @subsubheading Synopsis
20982
20983 @smallexample
20984 -file-exec-file @var{file}
20985 @end smallexample
20986
20987 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
20988 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
20989 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
20990 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
20991 notification.
20992
20993 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20994
20995 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
20996
20997 @subsubheading Example
20998
20999 @smallexample
21000 (gdb)
21001 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21002 ^done
21003 (gdb)
21004 @end smallexample
21005
21006
21007 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
21008 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
21009
21010 @subsubheading Synopsis
21011
21012 @smallexample
21013 -file-list-exec-sections
21014 @end smallexample
21015
21016 List the sections of the current executable file.
21017
21018 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21019
21020 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
21021 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
21022 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
21023
21024 @subsubheading Example
21025 N.A.
21026
21027
21028 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
21029 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
21030
21031 @subsubheading Synopsis
21032
21033 @smallexample
21034 -file-list-exec-source-file
21035 @end smallexample
21036
21037 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
21038 to the current source file for the current executable.
21039
21040 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21041
21042 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
21043
21044 @subsubheading Example
21045
21046 @smallexample
21047 (gdb)
21048 123-file-list-exec-source-file
21049 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c"
21050 (gdb)
21051 @end smallexample
21052
21053
21054 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
21055 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
21056
21057 @subsubheading Synopsis
21058
21059 @smallexample
21060 -file-list-exec-source-files
21061 @end smallexample
21062
21063 List the source files for the current executable.
21064
21065 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
21066 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
21067
21068 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21069
21070 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
21071 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
21072
21073 @subsubheading Example
21074 @smallexample
21075 (gdb)
21076 -file-list-exec-source-files
21077 ^done,files=[
21078 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
21079 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
21080 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
21081 (gdb)
21082 @end smallexample
21083
21084 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
21085 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
21086
21087 @subsubheading Synopsis
21088
21089 @smallexample
21090 -file-list-shared-libraries
21091 @end smallexample
21092
21093 List the shared libraries in the program.
21094
21095 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21096
21097 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
21098
21099 @subsubheading Example
21100 N.A.
21101
21102
21103 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
21104 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
21105
21106 @subsubheading Synopsis
21107
21108 @smallexample
21109 -file-list-symbol-files
21110 @end smallexample
21111
21112 List symbol files.
21113
21114 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21115
21116 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
21117
21118 @subsubheading Example
21119 N.A.
21120
21121
21122 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
21123 @findex -file-symbol-file
21124
21125 @subsubheading Synopsis
21126
21127 @smallexample
21128 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
21129 @end smallexample
21130
21131 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
21132 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
21133 produced, except for a completion notification.
21134
21135 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21136
21137 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
21138
21139 @subsubheading Example
21140
21141 @smallexample
21142 (gdb)
21143 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21144 ^done
21145 (gdb)
21146 @end smallexample
21147
21148 @ignore
21149 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21150 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
21151 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
21152
21153 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
21154
21155 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
21156
21157 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
21158
21159 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
21160
21161 @c @subheading -overlay-map
21162
21163 @c @subheading -overlay-off
21164
21165 @c @subheading -overlay-on
21166
21167 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
21168
21169 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21170 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
21171 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
21172
21173 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
21174
21175 @c @subheading -signal-handle
21176
21177 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
21178
21179 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
21180 @end ignore
21181
21182
21183 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21184 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
21185 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
21186
21187
21188 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
21189 @findex -target-attach
21190
21191 @subsubheading Synopsis
21192
21193 @smallexample
21194 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
21195 @end smallexample
21196
21197 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
21198
21199 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21200
21201 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
21202
21203 @subsubheading Example
21204 N.A.
21205
21206
21207 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
21208 @findex -target-compare-sections
21209
21210 @subsubheading Synopsis
21211
21212 @smallexample
21213 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
21214 @end smallexample
21215
21216 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
21217 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
21218
21219 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21220
21221 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
21222
21223 @subsubheading Example
21224 N.A.
21225
21226
21227 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
21228 @findex -target-detach
21229
21230 @subsubheading Synopsis
21231
21232 @smallexample
21233 -target-detach
21234 @end smallexample
21235
21236 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
21237 There's no output.
21238
21239 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21240
21241 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
21242
21243 @subsubheading Example
21244
21245 @smallexample
21246 (gdb)
21247 -target-detach
21248 ^done
21249 (gdb)
21250 @end smallexample
21251
21252
21253 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
21254 @findex -target-disconnect
21255
21256 @subsubheading Synopsis
21257
21258 @smallexample
21259 -target-disconnect
21260 @end smallexample
21261
21262 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
21263 generally not resumed.
21264
21265 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21266
21267 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
21268
21269 @subsubheading Example
21270
21271 @smallexample
21272 (gdb)
21273 -target-disconnect
21274 ^done
21275 (gdb)
21276 @end smallexample
21277
21278
21279 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
21280 @findex -target-download
21281
21282 @subsubheading Synopsis
21283
21284 @smallexample
21285 -target-download
21286 @end smallexample
21287
21288 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
21289 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
21290
21291 @table @samp
21292 @item section
21293 The name of the section.
21294 @item section-sent
21295 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
21296 @item section-size
21297 The size of the section.
21298 @item total-sent
21299 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
21300 @item total-size
21301 The size of the overall executable to download.
21302 @end table
21303
21304 @noindent
21305 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
21306 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
21307
21308 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
21309 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
21310
21311 @table @samp
21312 @item section
21313 The name of the section.
21314 @item section-size
21315 The size of the section.
21316 @item total-size
21317 The size of the overall executable to download.
21318 @end table
21319
21320 @noindent
21321 At the end, a summary is printed.
21322
21323 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21324
21325 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
21326
21327 @subsubheading Example
21328
21329 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
21330 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
21331
21332 @smallexample
21333 (gdb)
21334 -target-download
21335 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
21336 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
21337 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
21338 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
21339 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
21340 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
21341 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
21342 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
21343 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
21344 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
21345 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
21346 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
21347 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
21348 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
21349 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
21350 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
21351 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
21352 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
21353 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
21354 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
21355 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
21356 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
21357 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
21358 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
21359 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
21360 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
21361 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
21362 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21363 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21364 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
21365 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
21366 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
21367 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
21368 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
21369 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
21370 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
21371 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
21372 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
21373 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
21374 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
21375 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
21376 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
21377 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
21378 write-rate="429"
21379 (gdb)
21380 @end smallexample
21381
21382
21383 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
21384 @findex -target-exec-status
21385
21386 @subsubheading Synopsis
21387
21388 @smallexample
21389 -target-exec-status
21390 @end smallexample
21391
21392 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
21393 not, for instance).
21394
21395 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21396
21397 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
21398
21399 @subsubheading Example
21400 N.A.
21401
21402
21403 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
21404 @findex -target-list-available-targets
21405
21406 @subsubheading Synopsis
21407
21408 @smallexample
21409 -target-list-available-targets
21410 @end smallexample
21411
21412 List the possible targets to connect to.
21413
21414 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21415
21416 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
21417
21418 @subsubheading Example
21419 N.A.
21420
21421
21422 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
21423 @findex -target-list-current-targets
21424
21425 @subsubheading Synopsis
21426
21427 @smallexample
21428 -target-list-current-targets
21429 @end smallexample
21430
21431 Describe the current target.
21432
21433 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21434
21435 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
21436 other things).
21437
21438 @subsubheading Example
21439 N.A.
21440
21441
21442 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
21443 @findex -target-list-parameters
21444
21445 @subsubheading Synopsis
21446
21447 @smallexample
21448 -target-list-parameters
21449 @end smallexample
21450
21451 @c ????
21452
21453 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21454
21455 No equivalent.
21456
21457 @subsubheading Example
21458 N.A.
21459
21460
21461 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
21462 @findex -target-select
21463
21464 @subsubheading Synopsis
21465
21466 @smallexample
21467 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
21468 @end smallexample
21469
21470 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
21471
21472 @table @samp
21473 @item @var{type}
21474 The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
21475 @item @var{parameters}
21476 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
21477 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
21478 @end table
21479
21480 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
21481 which the target program is, in the following form:
21482
21483 @smallexample
21484 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
21485 args=[@var{arg list}]
21486 @end smallexample
21487
21488 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21489
21490 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
21491
21492 @subsubheading Example
21493
21494 @smallexample
21495 (gdb)
21496 -target-select async /dev/ttya
21497 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
21498 (gdb)
21499 @end smallexample
21500
21501 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21502 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
21503 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
21504
21505
21506 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
21507 @findex -target-file-put
21508
21509 @subsubheading Synopsis
21510
21511 @smallexample
21512 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
21513 @end smallexample
21514
21515 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
21516 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
21517
21518 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21519
21520 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
21521
21522 @subsubheading Example
21523
21524 @smallexample
21525 (gdb)
21526 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
21527 ^done
21528 (gdb)
21529 @end smallexample
21530
21531
21532 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
21533 @findex -target-file-get
21534
21535 @subsubheading Synopsis
21536
21537 @smallexample
21538 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
21539 @end smallexample
21540
21541 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
21542 on the host system.
21543
21544 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21545
21546 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
21547
21548 @subsubheading Example
21549
21550 @smallexample
21551 (gdb)
21552 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
21553 ^done
21554 (gdb)
21555 @end smallexample
21556
21557
21558 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
21559 @findex -target-file-delete
21560
21561 @subsubheading Synopsis
21562
21563 @smallexample
21564 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
21565 @end smallexample
21566
21567 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
21568
21569 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21570
21571 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
21572
21573 @subsubheading Example
21574
21575 @smallexample
21576 (gdb)
21577 -target-file-delete remotefile
21578 ^done
21579 (gdb)
21580 @end smallexample
21581
21582
21583 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21584 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
21585 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
21586
21587 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
21588
21589 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
21590 @findex -gdb-exit
21591
21592 @subsubheading Synopsis
21593
21594 @smallexample
21595 -gdb-exit
21596 @end smallexample
21597
21598 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
21599
21600 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21601
21602 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
21603
21604 @subsubheading Example
21605
21606 @smallexample
21607 (gdb)
21608 -gdb-exit
21609 ^exit
21610 @end smallexample
21611
21612
21613 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
21614 @findex -exec-abort
21615
21616 @subsubheading Synopsis
21617
21618 @smallexample
21619 -exec-abort
21620 @end smallexample
21621
21622 Kill the inferior running program.
21623
21624 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21625
21626 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
21627
21628 @subsubheading Example
21629 N.A.
21630
21631
21632 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
21633 @findex -gdb-set
21634
21635 @subsubheading Synopsis
21636
21637 @smallexample
21638 -gdb-set
21639 @end smallexample
21640
21641 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
21642 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
21643
21644 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21645
21646 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
21647
21648 @subsubheading Example
21649
21650 @smallexample
21651 (gdb)
21652 -gdb-set $foo=3
21653 ^done
21654 (gdb)
21655 @end smallexample
21656
21657
21658 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
21659 @findex -gdb-show
21660
21661 @subsubheading Synopsis
21662
21663 @smallexample
21664 -gdb-show
21665 @end smallexample
21666
21667 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
21668
21669 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21670
21671 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
21672
21673 @subsubheading Example
21674
21675 @smallexample
21676 (gdb)
21677 -gdb-show annotate
21678 ^done,value="0"
21679 (gdb)
21680 @end smallexample
21681
21682 @c @subheading -gdb-source
21683
21684
21685 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
21686 @findex -gdb-version
21687
21688 @subsubheading Synopsis
21689
21690 @smallexample
21691 -gdb-version
21692 @end smallexample
21693
21694 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
21695
21696 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21697
21698 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
21699 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
21700
21701 @subsubheading Example
21702
21703 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
21704 @c box in TeX.
21705 @smallexample
21706 (gdb)
21707 -gdb-version
21708 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
21709 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21710 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
21711 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
21712 ~ certain conditions.
21713 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21714 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
21715 ~ details.
21716 ~This GDB was configured as
21717 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
21718 ^done
21719 (gdb)
21720 @end smallexample
21721
21722 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
21723 @findex -list-features
21724
21725 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
21726 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
21727 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
21728 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
21729 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
21730 startup.
21731
21732 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
21733 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
21734 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
21735 is given below.
21736
21737 Example output:
21738
21739 @smallexample
21740 (gdb) -list-features
21741 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
21742 @end smallexample
21743
21744 The current list of features is:
21745
21746 @itemize @minus
21747 @item
21748 @samp{frozen-varobjs}---indicates presence of the
21749 @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well as possible presense of the
21750 @code{frozen} field in the output of @code{-varobj-create}.
21751 @item
21752 @samp{pending-breakpoints}---indicates presence of the @code{-f}
21753 option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
21754
21755 @end itemize
21756
21757 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
21758 @findex -interpreter-exec
21759
21760 @subheading Synopsis
21761
21762 @smallexample
21763 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
21764 @end smallexample
21765 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
21766
21767 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
21768
21769 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21770
21771 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
21772
21773 @subheading Example
21774
21775 @smallexample
21776 (gdb)
21777 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
21778 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
21779 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
21780 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
21781 ^done
21782 (gdb)
21783 @end smallexample
21784
21785 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
21786 @findex -inferior-tty-set
21787
21788 @subheading Synopsis
21789
21790 @smallexample
21791 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21792 @end smallexample
21793
21794 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
21795
21796 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21797
21798 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
21799
21800 @subheading Example
21801
21802 @smallexample
21803 (gdb)
21804 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21805 ^done
21806 (gdb)
21807 @end smallexample
21808
21809 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
21810 @findex -inferior-tty-show
21811
21812 @subheading Synopsis
21813
21814 @smallexample
21815 -inferior-tty-show
21816 @end smallexample
21817
21818 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
21819
21820 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21821
21822 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
21823
21824 @subheading Example
21825
21826 @smallexample
21827 (gdb)
21828 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21829 ^done
21830 (gdb)
21831 -inferior-tty-show
21832 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
21833 (gdb)
21834 @end smallexample
21835
21836 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
21837 @findex -enable-timings
21838
21839 @subheading Synopsis
21840
21841 @smallexample
21842 -enable-timings [yes | no]
21843 @end smallexample
21844
21845 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
21846 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
21847 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
21848 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
21849
21850 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21851
21852 No equivalent.
21853
21854 @subheading Example
21855
21856 @smallexample
21857 (gdb)
21858 -enable-timings
21859 ^done
21860 (gdb)
21861 -break-insert main
21862 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
21863 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
21864 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
21865 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
21866 (gdb)
21867 -enable-timings no
21868 ^done
21869 (gdb)
21870 -exec-run
21871 ^running
21872 (gdb)
21873 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
21874 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
21875 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
21876 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
21877 (gdb)
21878 @end smallexample
21879
21880 @node Annotations
21881 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
21882
21883 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
21884 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
21885 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
21886 relatively high level.
21887
21888 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
21889 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
21890
21891 @ignore
21892 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
21893 @end ignore
21894
21895 @menu
21896 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
21897 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
21898 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
21899 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
21900 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
21901 * Annotations for Running::
21902 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
21903 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
21904 @end menu
21905
21906 @node Annotations Overview
21907 @section What is an Annotation?
21908 @cindex annotations
21909
21910 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
21911 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
21912 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
21913 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
21914 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
21915 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
21916 cannot contain newline characters.
21917
21918 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
21919 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
21920 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
21921 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
21922 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
21923 means those three characters as output.
21924
21925 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
21926 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
21927 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
21928 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
21929 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
21930 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
21931 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
21932 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
21933 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
21934
21935 @table @code
21936 @kindex set annotate
21937 @item set annotate @var{level}
21938 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
21939 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
21940
21941 @item show annotate
21942 @kindex show annotate
21943 Show the current annotation level.
21944 @end table
21945
21946 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
21947
21948 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
21949
21950 @smallexample
21951 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
21952 GNU gdb 6.0
21953 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21954 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
21955 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
21956 under certain conditions.
21957 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21958 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
21959 for details.
21960 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
21961
21962 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21963 (@value{GDBP})
21964 ^Z^Zprompt
21965 @kbd{quit}
21966
21967 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21968 $
21969 @end smallexample
21970
21971 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
21972 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
21973 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
21974 output from @value{GDBN}.
21975
21976 @node Server Prefix
21977 @section The Server Prefix
21978 @cindex server prefix
21979
21980 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
21981 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
21982 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
21983 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
21984 a transparent manner.
21985
21986 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
21987 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
21988 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
21989
21990 @node Prompting
21991 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
21992
21993 @cindex annotations for prompts
21994 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
21995 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
21996 over, etc.
21997
21998 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
21999 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
22000 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
22001 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
22002 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
22003 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
22004 features the following annotations:
22005
22006 @smallexample
22007 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
22008 ^Z^Zprompt
22009 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
22010 @end smallexample
22011
22012 The input types are
22013
22014 @table @code
22015 @findex pre-prompt annotation
22016 @findex prompt annotation
22017 @findex post-prompt annotation
22018 @item prompt
22019 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
22020
22021 @findex pre-commands annotation
22022 @findex commands annotation
22023 @findex post-commands annotation
22024 @item commands
22025 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
22026 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
22027
22028 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
22029 @findex overload-choice annotation
22030 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
22031 @item overload-choice
22032 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
22033
22034 @findex pre-query annotation
22035 @findex query annotation
22036 @findex post-query annotation
22037 @item query
22038 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
22039
22040 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
22041 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
22042 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
22043 @item prompt-for-continue
22044 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
22045 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
22046 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
22047 presence of annotations.
22048 @end table
22049
22050 @node Errors
22051 @section Errors
22052 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
22053
22054 @findex quit annotation
22055 @smallexample
22056 ^Z^Zquit
22057 @end smallexample
22058
22059 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
22060
22061 @findex error annotation
22062 @smallexample
22063 ^Z^Zerror
22064 @end smallexample
22065
22066 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
22067
22068 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
22069 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
22070 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
22071 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
22072 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
22073 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
22074 to the top level.
22075
22076 @findex error-begin annotation
22077 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
22078
22079 @smallexample
22080 ^Z^Zerror-begin
22081 @end smallexample
22082
22083 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
22084 message.
22085
22086 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
22087 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
22088 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
22089
22090 @node Invalidation
22091 @section Invalidation Notices
22092
22093 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
22094 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
22095 changed.
22096
22097 @table @code
22098 @findex frames-invalid annotation
22099 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
22100
22101 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
22102 have changed.
22103
22104 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
22105 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
22106
22107 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
22108 deleted a breakpoint.
22109 @end table
22110
22111 @node Annotations for Running
22112 @section Running the Program
22113 @cindex annotations for running programs
22114
22115 @findex starting annotation
22116 @findex stopping annotation
22117 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
22118 @code{step} or @code{continue},
22119
22120 @smallexample
22121 ^Z^Zstarting
22122 @end smallexample
22123
22124 is output. When the program stops,
22125
22126 @smallexample
22127 ^Z^Zstopped
22128 @end smallexample
22129
22130 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
22131 annotations describe how the program stopped.
22132
22133 @table @code
22134 @findex exited annotation
22135 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
22136 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
22137 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
22138
22139 @findex signalled annotation
22140 @findex signal-name annotation
22141 @findex signal-name-end annotation
22142 @findex signal-string annotation
22143 @findex signal-string-end annotation
22144 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
22145 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
22146 annotation continues:
22147
22148 @smallexample
22149 @var{intro-text}
22150 ^Z^Zsignal-name
22151 @var{name}
22152 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
22153 @var{middle-text}
22154 ^Z^Zsignal-string
22155 @var{string}
22156 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
22157 @var{end-text}
22158 @end smallexample
22159
22160 @noindent
22161 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
22162 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
22163 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
22164 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
22165 user's benefit and have no particular format.
22166
22167 @findex signal annotation
22168 @item ^Z^Zsignal
22169 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
22170 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
22171 terminated with it.
22172
22173 @findex breakpoint annotation
22174 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
22175 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
22176
22177 @findex watchpoint annotation
22178 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
22179 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
22180 @end table
22181
22182 @node Source Annotations
22183 @section Displaying Source
22184 @cindex annotations for source display
22185
22186 @findex source annotation
22187 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
22188
22189 @smallexample
22190 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
22191 @end smallexample
22192
22193 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
22194 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
22195 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
22196 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
22197 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
22198 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
22199 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
22200 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
22201 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
22202 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
22203 depend on the language).
22204
22205 @node GDB Bugs
22206 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
22207 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
22208 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
22209
22210 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
22211
22212 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
22213 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
22214 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
22215 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
22216
22217 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
22218 information that enables us to fix the bug.
22219
22220 @menu
22221 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
22222 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
22223 @end menu
22224
22225 @node Bug Criteria
22226 @section Have You Found a Bug?
22227 @cindex bug criteria
22228
22229 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
22230
22231 @itemize @bullet
22232 @cindex fatal signal
22233 @cindex debugger crash
22234 @cindex crash of debugger
22235 @item
22236 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
22237 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
22238
22239 @cindex error on valid input
22240 @item
22241 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
22242 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
22243 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
22244
22245 @cindex invalid input
22246 @item
22247 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
22248 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
22249 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
22250 for traditional practice''.
22251
22252 @item
22253 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
22254 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
22255 @end itemize
22256
22257 @node Bug Reporting
22258 @section How to Report Bugs
22259 @cindex bug reports
22260 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
22261
22262 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
22263 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
22264 contact that organization first.
22265
22266 You can find contact information for many support companies and
22267 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
22268 distribution.
22269 @c should add a web page ref...
22270
22271 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
22272 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
22273 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
22274 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
22275 be used.
22276
22277 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
22278 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
22279 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
22280 @samp{bug-gdb}.
22281
22282 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
22283 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
22284 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
22285 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
22286 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
22287 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
22288 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
22289 bug reports to the mailing list.
22290
22291 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
22292 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
22293 fact or leave it out, state it!
22294
22295 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
22296 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
22297 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
22298 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
22299 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
22300 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
22301 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
22302 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
22303 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
22304
22305 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
22306 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
22307 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
22308 self-contained.
22309
22310 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
22311 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
22312 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
22313 bugs properly.
22314
22315 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
22316
22317 @itemize @bullet
22318 @item
22319 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
22320 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
22321 version}.
22322
22323 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
22324 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
22325
22326 @item
22327 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
22328 version number.
22329
22330 @item
22331 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
22332 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
22333
22334 @item
22335 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
22336 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
22337 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
22338 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
22339 those compilers.
22340
22341 @item
22342 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
22343 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
22344 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
22345 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
22346
22347 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
22348 and then we might not encounter the bug.
22349
22350 @item
22351 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
22352 reproduce the bug.
22353
22354 @item
22355 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
22356 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
22357
22358 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
22359 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
22360 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
22361 a chance to make a mistake.
22362
22363 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
22364 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
22365 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
22366 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
22367 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
22368 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
22369 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
22370 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
22371
22372 @pindex script
22373 @cindex recording a session script
22374 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
22375 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
22376 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
22377 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
22378
22379 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
22380 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
22381
22382 @item
22383 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
22384 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
22385 it by context, not by line number.
22386
22387 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
22388 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
22389
22390 @end itemize
22391
22392 Here are some things that are not necessary:
22393
22394 @itemize @bullet
22395 @item
22396 A description of the envelope of the bug.
22397
22398 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
22399 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
22400 changes will not affect it.
22401
22402 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
22403 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
22404 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
22405 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
22406
22407 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
22408 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
22409 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
22410 less time, and so on.
22411
22412 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
22413 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
22414
22415 @item
22416 A patch for the bug.
22417
22418 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
22419 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
22420 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
22421 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
22422
22423 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
22424 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
22425 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
22426 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
22427
22428 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
22429 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
22430 help us to understand.
22431
22432 @item
22433 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
22434
22435 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
22436 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
22437 @end itemize
22438
22439 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
22440 @c and consists of the two following files:
22441 @c rluser.texinfo
22442 @c inc-hist.texinfo
22443 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
22444 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
22445 @include rluser.texi
22446 @include inc-hist.texinfo
22447
22448
22449 @node Formatting Documentation
22450 @appendix Formatting Documentation
22451
22452 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
22453 @cindex reference card
22454 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
22455 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
22456 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
22457 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
22458 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
22459 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
22460
22461 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
22462 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
22463
22464 @smallexample
22465 make refcard.dvi
22466 @end smallexample
22467
22468 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
22469 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
22470 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
22471 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
22472 your @sc{dvi} output program.
22473
22474 @cindex documentation
22475
22476 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
22477 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
22478 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
22479 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
22480 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
22481 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
22482
22483 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
22484 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
22485 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
22486 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
22487 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
22488 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
22489 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
22490 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
22491
22492 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
22493 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
22494 @code{makeinfo}.
22495
22496 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
22497 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
22498 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
22499
22500 @smallexample
22501 cd gdb
22502 make gdb.info
22503 @end smallexample
22504
22505 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
22506 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
22507 Texinfo definitions file.
22508
22509 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
22510 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
22511 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
22512 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
22513 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
22514 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
22515 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
22516
22517 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
22518 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
22519 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
22520 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
22521 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
22522 directory.
22523
22524 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
22525 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
22526 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
22527 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
22528
22529 @smallexample
22530 make gdb.dvi
22531 @end smallexample
22532
22533 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
22534
22535 @node Installing GDB
22536 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
22537 @cindex installation
22538
22539 @menu
22540 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
22541 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
22542 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
22543 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
22544 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
22545 @end menu
22546
22547 @node Requirements
22548 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
22549 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
22550
22551 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
22552 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
22553
22554 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
22555 @table @asis
22556 @item ISO C90 compiler
22557 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
22558 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
22559
22560 @end table
22561
22562 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
22563 @table @asis
22564 @item Expat
22565 @anchor{Expat}
22566 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
22567 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
22568 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
22569 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
22570 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
22571 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
22572
22573 Expat is used for:
22574
22575 @itemize @bullet
22576 @item
22577 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
22578 @item
22579 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
22580 @item
22581 Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
22582 @item
22583 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
22584 @end itemize
22585
22586 @end table
22587
22588 @node Running Configure
22589 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
22590 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
22591 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
22592 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
22593 build the @code{gdb} program.
22594 @iftex
22595 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
22596 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
22597 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
22598 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
22599 @end iftex
22600
22601 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
22602 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
22603 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
22604
22605 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
22606 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
22607
22608 @table @code
22609 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
22610 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
22611
22612 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
22613 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
22614
22615 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
22616 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
22617
22618 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
22619 @sc{gnu} include files
22620
22621 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
22622 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
22623
22624 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
22625 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
22626
22627 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
22628 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
22629
22630 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
22631 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
22632
22633 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
22634 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
22635 @end table
22636
22637 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
22638 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
22639 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
22640
22641 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
22642 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
22643 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
22644 argument.
22645
22646 For example:
22647
22648 @smallexample
22649 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22650 ./configure @var{host}
22651 make
22652 @end smallexample
22653
22654 @noindent
22655 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
22656 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
22657 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
22658 correct value by examining your system.)
22659
22660 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
22661 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
22662 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
22663 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
22664
22665 @need 750
22666 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
22667 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
22668 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
22669
22670 @smallexample
22671 sh configure @var{host}
22672 @end smallexample
22673
22674 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
22675 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
22676 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
22677 @file{configure}
22678 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
22679 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
22680
22681 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
22682 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
22683 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
22684 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
22685 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
22686 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
22687 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
22688 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
22689 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22690
22691 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
22692 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
22693 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
22694 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
22695 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
22696
22697 @node Separate Objdir
22698 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
22699
22700 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
22701 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
22702 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
22703 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
22704 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
22705 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
22706 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
22707 program specified there.
22708
22709 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
22710 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
22711 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
22712 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
22713 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
22714 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
22715
22716 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
22717 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
22718
22719 @smallexample
22720 @group
22721 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22722 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
22723 cd ../gdb-sun4
22724 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
22725 make
22726 @end group
22727 @end smallexample
22728
22729 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
22730 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
22731 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
22732 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
22733 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
22734 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
22735
22736 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
22737 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
22738 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
22739 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
22740 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22741
22742 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
22743 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
22744 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
22745 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
22746 You specify a cross-debugging target by
22747 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
22748
22749 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
22750 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
22751 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
22752
22753 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
22754 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
22755 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
22756 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
22757 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
22758
22759 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
22760 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
22761 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
22762 with each other.
22763
22764 @node Config Names
22765 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
22766
22767 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
22768 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
22769 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
22770 of information in the following pattern:
22771
22772 @smallexample
22773 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
22774 @end smallexample
22775
22776 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
22777 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
22778 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
22779
22780 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
22781 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
22782 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
22783 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
22784 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
22785 abbreviations---for example:
22786
22787 @smallexample
22788 % sh config.sub i386-linux
22789 i386-pc-linux-gnu
22790 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
22791 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
22792 % sh config.sub hp9k700
22793 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
22794 % sh config.sub sun4
22795 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
22796 % sh config.sub sun3
22797 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
22798 % sh config.sub i986v
22799 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
22800 @end smallexample
22801
22802 @noindent
22803 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
22804 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
22805
22806 @node Configure Options
22807 @section @file{configure} Options
22808
22809 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
22810 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
22811 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
22812 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
22813
22814 @smallexample
22815 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
22816 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22817 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22818 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
22819 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
22820 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
22821 @var{host}
22822 @end smallexample
22823
22824 @noindent
22825 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
22826 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
22827 @samp{--}.
22828
22829 @table @code
22830 @item --help
22831 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
22832
22833 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
22834 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
22835 @file{@var{dir}}.
22836
22837 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
22838 Configure the source to install programs under directory
22839 @file{@var{dir}}.
22840
22841 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
22842 @need 2000
22843 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
22844 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
22845 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
22846 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
22847 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
22848 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
22849 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
22850 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
22851 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
22852 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
22853 @var{dirname}.
22854
22855 @item --norecursion
22856 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
22857 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
22858
22859 @item --target=@var{target}
22860 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
22861 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
22862 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
22863
22864 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
22865
22866 @item @var{host} @dots{}
22867 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
22868
22869 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
22870 @end table
22871
22872 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
22873 needed for special purposes only.
22874
22875 @node Maintenance Commands
22876 @appendix Maintenance Commands
22877 @cindex maintenance commands
22878 @cindex internal commands
22879
22880 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
22881 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
22882 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
22883 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
22884 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
22885
22886 @table @code
22887 @kindex maint agent
22888 @item maint agent @var{expression}
22889 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
22890 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
22891 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
22892
22893 @kindex maint info breakpoints
22894 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
22895 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
22896 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
22897 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
22898 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
22899 is shown:
22900
22901 @table @code
22902 @item breakpoint
22903 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
22904
22905 @item watchpoint
22906 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
22907
22908 @item longjmp
22909 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
22910 @code{longjmp} calls.
22911
22912 @item longjmp resume
22913 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
22914
22915 @item until
22916 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
22917
22918 @item finish
22919 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
22920
22921 @item shlib events
22922 Shared library events.
22923
22924 @end table
22925
22926 @kindex maint check-symtabs
22927 @item maint check-symtabs
22928 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
22929
22930 @kindex maint cplus first_component
22931 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
22932 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
22933
22934 @kindex maint cplus namespace
22935 @item maint cplus namespace
22936 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
22937
22938 @kindex maint demangle
22939 @item maint demangle @var{name}
22940 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
22941
22942 @kindex maint deprecate
22943 @kindex maint undeprecate
22944 @cindex deprecated commands
22945 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
22946 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
22947 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
22948 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
22949 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
22950 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
22951 the replacement as part of the warning.
22952
22953 @kindex maint dump-me
22954 @item maint dump-me
22955 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
22956 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
22957 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
22958 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
22959
22960 @kindex maint internal-error
22961 @kindex maint internal-warning
22962 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22963 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22964 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
22965 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
22966 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
22967 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
22968 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
22969 @value{GDBN} session.
22970
22971 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
22972 used as the text of the error or warning message.
22973
22974 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
22975
22976 @smallexample
22977 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
22978 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
22979 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
22980 debugging may prove unreliable.
22981 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22982 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22983 (@value{GDBP})
22984 @end smallexample
22985
22986 @kindex maint packet
22987 @item maint packet @var{text}
22988 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
22989 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
22990 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
22991 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
22992 checksum.
22993
22994 @kindex maint print architecture
22995 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22996 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
22997 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
22998
22999 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
23000 @item maint print c-tdesc
23001 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
23002 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
23003 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
23004
23005 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
23006 @item maint print dummy-frames
23007 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
23008
23009 @smallexample
23010 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
23011 @dots{}
23012 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
23013 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
23014 58 return (a + b);
23015 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
23016 @dots{}
23017 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
23018 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
23019 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
23020 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
23021 (@value{GDBP})
23022 @end smallexample
23023
23024 Takes an optional file parameter.
23025
23026 @kindex maint print registers
23027 @kindex maint print raw-registers
23028 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
23029 @kindex maint print register-groups
23030 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23031 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23032 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23033 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23034 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
23035
23036 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
23037 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
23038 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
23039 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
23040 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
23041 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
23042
23043 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
23044 write the information.
23045
23046 @kindex maint print reggroups
23047 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
23048 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
23049 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
23050 information.
23051
23052 The register groups info looks like this:
23053
23054 @smallexample
23055 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
23056 Group Type
23057 general user
23058 float user
23059 all user
23060 vector user
23061 system user
23062 save internal
23063 restore internal
23064 @end smallexample
23065
23066 @kindex flushregs
23067 @item flushregs
23068 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
23069
23070 @kindex maint print objfiles
23071 @cindex info for known object files
23072 @item maint print objfiles
23073 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
23074 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
23075 and symtabs.
23076
23077 @kindex maint print statistics
23078 @cindex bcache statistics
23079 @item maint print statistics
23080 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
23081 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
23082 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
23083 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
23084 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
23085 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
23086 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
23087 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
23088 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
23089 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
23090 lengths.
23091
23092 @kindex maint print target-stack
23093 @cindex target stack description
23094 @item maint print target-stack
23095 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
23096 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
23097 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
23098 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
23099 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
23100 address.
23101
23102 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
23103 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
23104
23105 @kindex maint print type
23106 @cindex type chain of a data type
23107 @item maint print type @var{expr}
23108 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
23109 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
23110 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
23111 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
23112 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
23113
23114 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
23115 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
23116 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
23117 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
23118 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
23119
23120 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
23121 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
23122 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
23123 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
23124 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
23125 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
23126 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
23127 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
23128 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
23129
23130 @kindex maint set profile
23131 @kindex maint show profile
23132 @cindex profiling GDB
23133 @item maint set profile
23134 @itemx maint show profile
23135 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
23136
23137 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
23138 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
23139 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
23140 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
23141 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
23142 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
23143 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
23144
23145 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
23146 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
23147
23148 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
23149 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
23150 @item maint show-debug-regs
23151 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
23152 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
23153 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
23154 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
23155 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
23156
23157 @kindex maint space
23158 @cindex memory used by commands
23159 @item maint space
23160 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
23161 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
23162 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
23163 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
23164 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
23165
23166 @kindex maint time
23167 @cindex time of command execution
23168 @item maint time
23169 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
23170 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
23171 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
23172 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
23173 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
23174
23175 @kindex maint translate-address
23176 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
23177 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
23178 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
23179 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
23180 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
23181 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
23182 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
23183
23184 @end table
23185
23186 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
23187 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
23188
23189 @table @code
23190 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
23191 @kindex set watchdog
23192 @cindex watchdog timer
23193 @cindex timeout for commands
23194 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
23195 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
23196 reports and error and the command is aborted.
23197
23198 @item show watchdog
23199 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
23200 @end table
23201
23202 @node Remote Protocol
23203 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
23204
23205 @menu
23206 * Overview::
23207 * Packets::
23208 * Stop Reply Packets::
23209 * General Query Packets::
23210 * Register Packet Format::
23211 * Tracepoint Packets::
23212 * Host I/O Packets::
23213 * Interrupts::
23214 * Examples::
23215 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
23216 * Library List Format::
23217 * Memory Map Format::
23218 @end menu
23219
23220 @node Overview
23221 @section Overview
23222
23223 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
23224 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
23225 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
23226 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
23227
23228 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
23229 transmitted and received data, respectively.
23230
23231 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
23232 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
23233 @cindex remote serial protocol
23234 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
23235 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
23236 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
23237 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
23238
23239 @smallexample
23240 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23241 @end smallexample
23242 @noindent
23243
23244 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
23245 @noindent
23246 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
23247 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
23248 eight bit unsigned checksum).
23249
23250 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
23251 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
23252
23253 @smallexample
23254 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23255 @end smallexample
23256
23257 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
23258 @noindent
23259 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
23260 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
23261 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
23262
23263 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
23264 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
23265 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
23266 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
23267 retransmission):
23268
23269 @smallexample
23270 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23271 <- @code{+}
23272 @end smallexample
23273 @noindent
23274
23275 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
23276 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
23277 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
23278 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
23279
23280 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
23281 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
23282 exceptions).
23283
23284 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
23285 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
23286 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
23287 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
23288
23289 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
23290 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
23291 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
23292
23293 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
23294 @anchor{Binary Data}
23295 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
23296 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
23297 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
23298 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
23299 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
23300 binary data.
23301
23302 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
23303 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
23304 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
23305 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
23306 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
23307 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
23308 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
23309 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
23310 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
23311 (described next).
23312
23313 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
23314 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
23315 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
23316 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
23317 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
23318 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
23319 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
23320 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
23321 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
23322 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
23323 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
23324 3}} more times.
23325
23326 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
23327 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
23328 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
23329 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
23330 @samp{0*"00}.
23331
23332 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
23333 error number. That number is not well defined.
23334
23335 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
23336 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
23337 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
23338 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
23339 on that response.
23340
23341 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
23342 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
23343 optional.
23344
23345 @node Packets
23346 @section Packets
23347
23348 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
23349 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
23350 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
23351 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
23352
23353 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
23354 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
23355 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
23356 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
23357 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
23358 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
23359 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
23360 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
23361 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
23362 @var{baz}.
23363
23364 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
23365 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
23366
23367 Here are the packet descriptions.
23368
23369 @table @samp
23370
23371 @item !
23372 @cindex @samp{!} packet
23373 @anchor{extended mode}
23374 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
23375 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
23376 debugged.
23377
23378 Reply:
23379 @table @samp
23380 @item OK
23381 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
23382 @end table
23383
23384 @item ?
23385 @cindex @samp{?} packet
23386 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
23387 step and continue.
23388
23389 Reply:
23390 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23391
23392 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
23393 @cindex @samp{A} packet
23394 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
23395 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
23396 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
23397
23398 Reply:
23399 @table @samp
23400 @item OK
23401 The arguments were set.
23402 @item E @var{NN}
23403 An error occurred.
23404 @end table
23405
23406 @item b @var{baud}
23407 @cindex @samp{b} packet
23408 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
23409 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
23410
23411 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
23412 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
23413 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
23414
23415 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
23416 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
23417 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
23418 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
23419 of view, nothing actually happened.}
23420
23421 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
23422 @cindex @samp{B} packet
23423 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
23424 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
23425
23426 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
23427 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
23428
23429 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23430 @cindex @samp{c} packet
23431 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
23432 resume at current address.
23433
23434 Reply:
23435 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23436
23437 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23438 @cindex @samp{C} packet
23439 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
23440 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
23441
23442 Reply:
23443 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23444
23445 @item d
23446 @cindex @samp{d} packet
23447 Toggle debug flag.
23448
23449 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
23450 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
23451
23452 @item D
23453 @cindex @samp{D} packet
23454 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
23455 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
23456
23457 Reply:
23458 @table @samp
23459 @item OK
23460 for success
23461 @item E @var{NN}
23462 for an error
23463 @end table
23464
23465 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
23466 @cindex @samp{F} packet
23467 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
23468 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
23469 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
23470
23471 @item g
23472 @anchor{read registers packet}
23473 @cindex @samp{g} packet
23474 Read general registers.
23475
23476 Reply:
23477 @table @samp
23478 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23479 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
23480 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
23481 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
23482 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
23483 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
23484 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
23485 @item E @var{NN}
23486 for an error.
23487 @end table
23488
23489 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
23490 @cindex @samp{G} packet
23491 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
23492 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
23493
23494 Reply:
23495 @table @samp
23496 @item OK
23497 for success
23498 @item E @var{NN}
23499 for an error
23500 @end table
23501
23502 @item H @var{c} @var{t}
23503 @cindex @samp{H} packet
23504 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
23505 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
23506 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
23507 operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
23508 the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
23509
23510 Reply:
23511 @table @samp
23512 @item OK
23513 for success
23514 @item E @var{NN}
23515 for an error
23516 @end table
23517
23518 @c FIXME: JTC:
23519 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
23520 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
23521 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
23522 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
23523 @c described. For example:
23524 @c
23525 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23526 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
23527 @c otherwise returns current registers.
23528 @c
23529 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23530 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
23531 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
23532
23533 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
23534 @anchor{cycle step packet}
23535 @cindex @samp{i} packet
23536 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
23537 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
23538 step starting at that address.
23539
23540 @item I
23541 @cindex @samp{I} packet
23542 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
23543 step packet}.
23544
23545 @item k
23546 @cindex @samp{k} packet
23547 Kill request.
23548
23549 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
23550 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
23551 thread?)}.
23552
23553 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
23554 @cindex @samp{m} packet
23555 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23556 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
23557
23558 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
23559 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
23560 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
23561 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
23562 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
23563 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
23564 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
23565 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
23566
23567 Reply:
23568 @table @samp
23569 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23570 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
23571 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
23572 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
23573 @item E @var{NN}
23574 @var{NN} is errno
23575 @end table
23576
23577 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23578 @cindex @samp{M} packet
23579 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23580 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
23581 hexadecimal number.
23582
23583 Reply:
23584 @table @samp
23585 @item OK
23586 for success
23587 @item E @var{NN}
23588 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
23589 written).
23590 @end table
23591
23592 @item p @var{n}
23593 @cindex @samp{p} packet
23594 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
23595 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
23596 register value is encoded.
23597
23598 Reply:
23599 @table @samp
23600 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23601 the register's value
23602 @item E @var{NN}
23603 for an error
23604 @item
23605 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
23606 @end table
23607
23608 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
23609 @anchor{write register packet}
23610 @cindex @samp{P} packet
23611 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
23612 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
23613 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
23614
23615 Reply:
23616 @table @samp
23617 @item OK
23618 for success
23619 @item E @var{NN}
23620 for an error
23621 @end table
23622
23623 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23624 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23625 @cindex @samp{q} packet
23626 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
23627 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
23628 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
23629
23630 @item r
23631 @cindex @samp{r} packet
23632 Reset the entire system.
23633
23634 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
23635
23636 @item R @var{XX}
23637 @cindex @samp{R} packet
23638 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
23639 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
23640
23641 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
23642
23643 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23644 @cindex @samp{s} packet
23645 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
23646 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
23647
23648 Reply:
23649 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23650
23651 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23652 @anchor{step with signal packet}
23653 @cindex @samp{S} packet
23654 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
23655 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
23656
23657 Reply:
23658 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23659
23660 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
23661 @cindex @samp{t} packet
23662 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
23663 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
23664 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
23665
23666 @item T @var{XX}
23667 @cindex @samp{T} packet
23668 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
23669
23670 Reply:
23671 @table @samp
23672 @item OK
23673 thread is still alive
23674 @item E @var{NN}
23675 thread is dead
23676 @end table
23677
23678 @item v
23679 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
23680 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
23681
23682 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
23683 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
23684 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
23685 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. If the stub is currently
23686 controlling a process, it is killed. The attached process is stopped.
23687
23688 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
23689
23690 Reply:
23691 @table @samp
23692 @item E @var{nn}
23693 for an error
23694 @item @r{Any stop packet}
23695 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
23696 @end table
23697
23698 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
23699 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
23700 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
23701 If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
23702 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
23703 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
23704 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
23705 Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
23706
23707 @table @samp
23708 @item c
23709 Continue.
23710 @item C @var{sig}
23711 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23712 @item s
23713 Step.
23714 @item S @var{sig}
23715 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23716 @end table
23717
23718 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
23719 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
23720
23721 Reply:
23722 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23723
23724 @item vCont?
23725 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
23726 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
23727
23728 Reply:
23729 @table @samp
23730 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
23731 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
23732 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
23733 @item
23734 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
23735 @end table
23736
23737 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
23738 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
23739 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
23740 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
23741
23742 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
23743 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
23744 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
23745 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
23746 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
23747 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
23748 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
23749 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
23750 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23751 packet is received.
23752
23753 Reply:
23754 @table @samp
23755 @item OK
23756 for success
23757 @item E @var{NN}
23758 for an error
23759 @end table
23760
23761 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23762 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
23763 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
23764 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
23765 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
23766 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
23767 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
23768 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
23769 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
23770 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
23771 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
23772 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
23773
23774
23775 Reply:
23776 @table @samp
23777 @item OK
23778 for success
23779 @item E.memtype
23780 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
23781 @item E @var{NN}
23782 for an error
23783 @end table
23784
23785 @item vFlashDone
23786 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
23787 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
23788 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
23789 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
23790 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
23791 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23792 request is completed.
23793
23794 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
23795 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
23796 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
23797 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
23798 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
23799 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
23800 state. If the stub is currently controlling a process, it is killed.
23801
23802 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
23803
23804 Reply:
23805 @table @samp
23806 @item E @var{nn}
23807 for an error
23808 @item @r{Any stop packet}
23809 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
23810 @end table
23811
23812 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23813 @anchor{X packet}
23814 @cindex @samp{X} packet
23815 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
23816 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
23817 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
23818
23819 Reply:
23820 @table @samp
23821 @item OK
23822 for success
23823 @item E @var{NN}
23824 for an error
23825 @end table
23826
23827 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23828 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23829 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
23830 @cindex @samp{z} packet
23831 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
23832 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
23833 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
23834 @var{length} bytes.
23835
23836 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
23837 separately.
23838
23839 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
23840 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
23841 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
23842 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
23843 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
23844 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
23845
23846 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23847 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23848 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
23849 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
23850 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
23851 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23852
23853 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
23854 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
23855 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
23856 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
23857 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
23858
23859 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
23860 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
23861 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
23862 target, is not defined.}
23863
23864 Reply:
23865 @table @samp
23866 @item OK
23867 success
23868 @item
23869 not supported
23870 @item E @var{NN}
23871 for an error
23872 @end table
23873
23874 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23875 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23876 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
23877 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
23878 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
23879 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23880
23881 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
23882 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
23883
23884 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
23885 movement.}
23886
23887 Reply:
23888 @table @samp
23889 @item OK
23890 success
23891 @item
23892 not supported
23893 @item E @var{NN}
23894 for an error
23895 @end table
23896
23897 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23898 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23899 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
23900 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
23901 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
23902
23903 Reply:
23904 @table @samp
23905 @item OK
23906 success
23907 @item
23908 not supported
23909 @item E @var{NN}
23910 for an error
23911 @end table
23912
23913 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23914 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23915 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
23916 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
23917 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
23918
23919 Reply:
23920 @table @samp
23921 @item OK
23922 success
23923 @item
23924 not supported
23925 @item E @var{NN}
23926 for an error
23927 @end table
23928
23929 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23930 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23931 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
23932 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
23933 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
23934
23935 Reply:
23936 @table @samp
23937 @item OK
23938 success
23939 @item
23940 not supported
23941 @item E @var{NN}
23942 for an error
23943 @end table
23944
23945 @end table
23946
23947 @node Stop Reply Packets
23948 @section Stop Reply Packets
23949 @cindex stop reply packets
23950
23951 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
23952 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
23953 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
23954 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
23955 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
23956 @value{GDBN} source code.
23957
23958 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
23959 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
23960 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
23961 components.
23962
23963 @table @samp
23964
23965 @item S @var{AA}
23966 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23967 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
23968 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
23969
23970 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
23971 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
23972 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23973 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
23974 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
23975 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
23976 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
23977 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
23978
23979 @itemize @bullet
23980 @item
23981 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
23982 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
23983 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
23984 two-digit hex number.
23985
23986 @item
23987 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
23988 hex.
23989
23990 @item
23991 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
23992 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
23993 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
23994 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
23995
23996 @item
23997 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
23998 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
23999 future.
24000 @end itemize
24001
24002 The currently defined stop reasons are:
24003
24004 @table @samp
24005 @item watch
24006 @itemx rwatch
24007 @itemx awatch
24008 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
24009 hex.
24010
24011 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
24012 @item library
24013 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
24014 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
24015 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
24016 @end table
24017
24018 @item W @var{AA}
24019 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
24020 applicable to certain targets.
24021
24022 @item X @var{AA}
24023 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
24024
24025 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
24026 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
24027 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
24028 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
24029 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
24030
24031 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
24032 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
24033 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
24034 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
24035 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
24036 system calls.
24037
24038 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
24039 this very system call.
24040
24041 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
24042 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
24043 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
24044 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
24045 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
24046 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
24047
24048 @end table
24049
24050 @node General Query Packets
24051 @section General Query Packets
24052 @cindex remote query requests
24053
24054 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
24055 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
24056 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
24057 sending information to and from the stub.
24058
24059 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
24060 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
24061 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
24062 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
24063 conventions:
24064
24065 @itemize @bullet
24066 @item
24067 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
24068 @item
24069 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
24070 letter.
24071 @item
24072 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
24073 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
24074 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
24075 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
24076 @end itemize
24077
24078 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
24079 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
24080 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
24081 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
24082 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
24083 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
24084 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
24085 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
24086 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
24087 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
24088 packet.}.
24089
24090 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
24091 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
24092 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
24093 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
24094 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
24095
24096 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
24097
24098 @table @samp
24099
24100 @item qC
24101 @cindex current thread, remote request
24102 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
24103 Return the current thread id.
24104
24105 Reply:
24106 @table @samp
24107 @item QC @var{pid}
24108 Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexadecimal process id.
24109 @item @r{(anything else)}
24110 Any other reply implies the old pid.
24111 @end table
24112
24113 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
24114 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
24115 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
24116 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
24117 Reply:
24118 @table @samp
24119 @item E @var{NN}
24120 An error (such as memory fault)
24121 @item C @var{crc32}
24122 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
24123 @end table
24124
24125 @item qfThreadInfo
24126 @itemx qsThreadInfo
24127 @cindex list active threads, remote request
24128 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
24129 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
24130 Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
24131 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
24132 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
24133 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
24134 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
24135 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
24136
24137 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
24138
24139 Reply:
24140 @table @samp
24141 @item m @var{id}
24142 A single thread id
24143 @item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
24144 a comma-separated list of thread ids
24145 @item l
24146 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
24147 @end table
24148
24149 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
24150 more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
24151 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
24152 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
24153 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
24154
24155 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
24156 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
24157 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
24158 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
24159 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
24160
24161 @var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
24162 thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
24163
24164 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
24165 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
24166 information associated with the variable.)
24167
24168 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
24169 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
24170 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
24171 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
24172 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
24173 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
24174
24175 Reply:
24176 @table @samp
24177 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
24178 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
24179 local storage requested.
24180
24181 @item E @var{nn}
24182 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
24183
24184 @item
24185 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
24186 @end table
24187
24188 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
24189 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
24190 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
24191 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
24192 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
24193 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
24194 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
24195
24196 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
24197
24198 Reply:
24199 @table @samp
24200 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
24201 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
24202 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
24203 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
24204 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
24205 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
24206 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
24207 @end table
24208
24209 @item qOffsets
24210 @cindex section offsets, remote request
24211 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
24212 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
24213 image.
24214
24215 Reply:
24216 @table @samp
24217 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
24218 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
24219 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
24220 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
24221 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
24222 segments by the supplied offsets.
24223
24224 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
24225 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
24226 to the @code{Bss} section.}
24227
24228 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
24229 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
24230 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
24231 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
24232 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
24233 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
24234 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
24235 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
24236 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
24237 @end table
24238
24239 @item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
24240 @cindex thread information, remote request
24241 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
24242 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
24243 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
24244
24245 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
24246 (see below).
24247
24248 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
24249
24250 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
24251 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
24252 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
24253 @anchor{QPassSignals}
24254 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
24255 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
24256 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
24257 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
24258 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
24259 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
24260 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
24261 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
24262 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
24263
24264 Reply:
24265 @table @samp
24266 @item OK
24267 The request succeeded.
24268
24269 @item E @var{nn}
24270 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
24271
24272 @item
24273 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
24274 the stub.
24275 @end table
24276
24277 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
24278 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
24279 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24280 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24281
24282 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
24283 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
24284 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
24285 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
24286 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
24287 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
24288 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
24289 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
24290 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
24291
24292 Reply:
24293 @table @samp
24294 @item OK
24295 A command response with no output.
24296 @item @var{OUTPUT}
24297 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
24298 @item E @var{NN}
24299 Indicate a badly formed request.
24300 @item
24301 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
24302 @end table
24303
24304 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
24305 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
24306 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
24307 packets.)
24308
24309 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
24310 @cindex supported packets, remote query
24311 @cindex features of the remote protocol
24312 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
24313 @anchor{qSupported}
24314 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
24315 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
24316 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
24317 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
24318 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
24319 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
24320 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
24321 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
24322 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
24323 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
24324 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
24325 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
24326 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
24327 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
24328
24329 Reply:
24330 @table @samp
24331 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
24332 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
24333 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
24334 possible forms).
24335 @item
24336 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
24337 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
24338 @end table
24339
24340 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
24341 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
24342 are:
24343
24344 @table @samp
24345 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
24346 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
24347 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
24348 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
24349 @item @var{name}+
24350 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
24351 need an associated value.
24352 @item @var{name}-
24353 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
24354 @item @var{name}?
24355 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
24356 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
24357 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
24358 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
24359 @end table
24360
24361 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
24362 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
24363 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
24364 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
24365 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
24366
24367 No values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
24368 are defined yet. Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
24369 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
24370 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
24371 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Values
24372 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
24373 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
24374 improvements in the remote protocol---support for unlimited length
24375 responses would be a @var{gdbfeature} example, if it were not implied by
24376 the @samp{qSupported} query. The stub's reply should be independent
24377 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
24378 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
24379 all the features it supports.
24380
24381 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
24382 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
24383
24384 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
24385 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
24386 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
24387 form response.
24388
24389 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
24390 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
24391 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
24392 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
24393
24394 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
24395 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
24396 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
24397 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
24398 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
24399
24400 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
24401
24402 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
24403 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
24404 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
24405 @item Feature Name
24406 @tab Value Required
24407 @tab Default
24408 @tab Probe Allowed
24409
24410 @item @samp{PacketSize}
24411 @tab Yes
24412 @tab @samp{-}
24413 @tab No
24414
24415 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
24416 @tab No
24417 @tab @samp{-}
24418 @tab Yes
24419
24420 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
24421 @tab No
24422 @tab @samp{-}
24423 @tab Yes
24424
24425 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
24426 @tab No
24427 @tab @samp{-}
24428 @tab Yes
24429
24430 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
24431 @tab No
24432 @tab @samp{-}
24433 @tab Yes
24434
24435 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
24436 @tab No
24437 @tab @samp{-}
24438 @tab Yes
24439
24440 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
24441 @tab No
24442 @tab @samp{-}
24443 @tab Yes
24444
24445 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
24446 @tab No
24447 @tab @samp{-}
24448 @tab Yes
24449
24450 @end multitable
24451
24452 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
24453
24454 @table @samp
24455 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
24456 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
24457 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
24458 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
24459 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
24460 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
24461 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
24462 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
24463 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
24464 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
24465
24466 @item qXfer:auxv:read
24467 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
24468 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
24469
24470 @item qXfer:features:read
24471 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
24472 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
24473
24474 @item qXfer:libraries:read
24475 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
24476 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
24477
24478 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
24479 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
24480 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
24481
24482 @item qXfer:spu:read
24483 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
24484 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
24485
24486 @item qXfer:spu:write
24487 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
24488 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
24489
24490 @item QPassSignals
24491 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
24492 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
24493
24494 @end table
24495
24496 @item qSymbol::
24497 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
24498 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
24499 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
24500 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
24501
24502 Reply:
24503 @table @samp
24504 @item OK
24505 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
24506 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
24507 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
24508 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
24509 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
24510 below.
24511 @end table
24512
24513 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
24514 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
24515
24516 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
24517 target has previously requested.
24518
24519 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
24520 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
24521 will be empty.
24522
24523 Reply:
24524 @table @samp
24525 @item OK
24526 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
24527 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
24528 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
24529 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
24530 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
24531 @end table
24532
24533 @item QTDP
24534 @itemx QTFrame
24535 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
24536
24537 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
24538 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
24539 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
24540 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
24541 the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
24542 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
24543 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
24544 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
24545 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
24546 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
24547
24548 Reply:
24549 @table @samp
24550 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
24551 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
24552 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
24553 the thread's attributes.
24554 @end table
24555
24556 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
24557 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
24558 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
24559 packets.)
24560
24561 @item QTStart
24562 @itemx QTStop
24563 @itemx QTinit
24564 @itemx QTro
24565 @itemx qTStatus
24566 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
24567
24568 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24569 @cindex read special object, remote request
24570 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
24571 @anchor{qXfer read}
24572 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
24573 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
24574 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
24575 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
24576 additional details about what data to access.
24577
24578 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
24579 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
24580 formats, listed below.
24581
24582 @table @samp
24583 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
24584 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
24585 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
24586 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
24587
24588 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24589 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24590
24591 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24592 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
24593 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
24594 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
24595 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
24596
24597 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24598 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24599
24600 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24601 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
24602 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
24603 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
24604 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
24605
24606 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
24607 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
24608 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
24609
24610 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24611 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24612
24613 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
24614 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
24615 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
24616 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
24617 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
24618
24619 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24620 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24621
24622 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24623 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
24624 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
24625 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
24626 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
24627 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
24628 in that context to be accessed.
24629
24630 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24631 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24632 @end table
24633
24634 Reply:
24635 @table @samp
24636 @item m @var{data}
24637 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
24638 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
24639 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
24640 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
24641 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
24642 request.
24643
24644 @item l @var{data}
24645 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
24646 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
24647 than the @var{length} in the request.
24648
24649 @item l
24650 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
24651 There is no more data to be read.
24652
24653 @item E00
24654 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
24655
24656 @item E @var{nn}
24657 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
24658 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
24659
24660 @item
24661 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
24662 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
24663 @end table
24664
24665 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
24666 @cindex write data into object, remote request
24667 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
24668 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
24669 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
24670 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
24671 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
24672 to access.
24673
24674 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
24675 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
24676 formats, listed below.
24677
24678 @table @samp
24679 @item qXfer:@var{spu}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
24680 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
24681 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
24682 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
24683 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
24684 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
24685 in that context to be accessed.
24686
24687 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24688 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24689 @end table
24690
24691 Reply:
24692 @table @samp
24693 @item @var{nn}
24694 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
24695 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
24696
24697 @item E00
24698 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
24699
24700 @item E @var{nn}
24701 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
24702 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
24703
24704 @item
24705 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
24706 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
24707 @end table
24708
24709 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
24710 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
24711 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
24712 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
24713 must respond with an empty packet.
24714
24715 @end table
24716
24717 @node Register Packet Format
24718 @section Register Packet Format
24719
24720 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
24721 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
24722 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
24723 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
24724 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
24725 most-significant - least-significant.
24726
24727 @table @r
24728
24729 @item MIPS32
24730
24731 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
24732 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
24733 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
24734
24735 @item MIPS64
24736
24737 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
24738 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
24739 as @code{MIPS32}.
24740
24741 @end table
24742
24743 @node Tracepoint Packets
24744 @section Tracepoint Packets
24745 @cindex tracepoint packets
24746 @cindex packets, tracepoint
24747
24748 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
24749 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
24750
24751 @table @samp
24752
24753 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
24754 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
24755 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
24756 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
24757 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
24758 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
24759 tracepoint's actions.
24760
24761 Replies:
24762 @table @samp
24763 @item OK
24764 The packet was understood and carried out.
24765 @item
24766 The packet was not recognized.
24767 @end table
24768
24769 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
24770 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
24771 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
24772 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
24773 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
24774 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
24775 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
24776
24777 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
24778 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
24779 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
24780 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
24781 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
24782 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
24783 tracepoint actions.
24784
24785 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
24786 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
24787 following forms:
24788
24789 @table @samp
24790
24791 @item R @var{mask}
24792 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
24793 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
24794 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
24795 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
24796 not fit in a 32-bit word.
24797
24798 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
24799 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
24800 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
24801 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
24802 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
24803 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
24804 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
24805
24806 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
24807 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
24808 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
24809 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
24810 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
24811 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
24812 packet).
24813
24814 @end table
24815
24816 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
24817 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
24818 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
24819 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
24820 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
24821 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
24822 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
24823 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
24824
24825 Replies:
24826 @table @samp
24827 @item OK
24828 The packet was understood and carried out.
24829 @item
24830 The packet was not recognized.
24831 @end table
24832
24833 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
24834 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
24835 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
24836 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
24837
24838 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
24839 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
24840 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
24841 one of the following forms:
24842
24843 @table @samp
24844 @item F @var{f}
24845 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
24846 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
24847 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
24848
24849 @item T @var{t}
24850 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
24851 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
24852
24853 @end table
24854
24855 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
24856 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24857 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
24858 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
24859
24860 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
24861 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24862 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
24863 is a hexadecimal number.
24864
24865 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
24866 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24867 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
24868 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
24869 numbers.
24870
24871 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
24872 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
24873 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
24874
24875 @item QTStart
24876 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
24877 hits in the trace frame buffer.
24878
24879 @item QTStop
24880 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
24881
24882 @item QTinit
24883 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
24884
24885 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
24886 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
24887 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
24888 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
24889
24890 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
24891 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
24892 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
24893 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
24894
24895 @item qTStatus
24896 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
24897
24898 Replies:
24899 @table @samp
24900 @item T0
24901 There is no trace experiment running.
24902 @item T1
24903 There is a trace experiment running.
24904 @end table
24905
24906 @end table
24907
24908
24909 @node Host I/O Packets
24910 @section Host I/O Packets
24911 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
24912 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
24913
24914 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
24915 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
24916 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
24917 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
24918 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
24919 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
24920 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
24921 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
24922 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
24923 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
24924
24925 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
24926 its arguments. They have this format:
24927
24928 @table @samp
24929
24930 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
24931 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
24932 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
24933 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
24934 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
24935 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
24936 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
24937 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
24938 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
24939
24940 @end table
24941
24942 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
24943
24944 @table @samp
24945
24946 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
24947 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
24948 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
24949 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
24950 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
24951 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
24952 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
24953 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
24954 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
24955 @var{attachment}.
24956
24957 @item
24958 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
24959
24960 @end table
24961
24962 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
24963
24964 @table @samp
24965 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
24966 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
24967 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
24968 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
24969 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
24970 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
24971 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
24972
24973 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
24974 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
24975 -1 if an error occurs.
24976
24977 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
24978 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
24979 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
24980 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
24981 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
24982 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
24983 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
24984 @var{count} was zero.
24985
24986 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
24987 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
24988 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
24989 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
24990 some characters were escaped.
24991
24992 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
24993 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
24994 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
24995 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
24996 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
24997 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
24998 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
24999 error occurred.
25000
25001 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
25002 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
25003 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
25004
25005 @end table
25006
25007 @node Interrupts
25008 @section Interrupts
25009 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
25010
25011 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
25012 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
25013 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
25014 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
25015
25016 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
25017 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does
25018 not currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
25019 interfaces.
25020
25021 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
25022 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
25023 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
25024 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
25025 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
25026 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
25027 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
25028 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
25029
25030 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
25031 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
25032 implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
25033 running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
25034 Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
25035 of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
25036 program is stopped will be discarded.
25037
25038 @node Examples
25039 @section Examples
25040
25041 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
25042 does not get any direct output:
25043
25044 @smallexample
25045 -> @code{R00}
25046 <- @code{+}
25047 @emph{target restarts}
25048 -> @code{?}
25049 <- @code{+}
25050 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
25051 -> @code{+}
25052 @end smallexample
25053
25054 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
25055
25056 @smallexample
25057 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
25058 <- @code{+}
25059 -> @code{s}
25060 <- @code{+}
25061 @emph{time passes}
25062 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
25063 -> @code{+}
25064 -> @code{g}
25065 <- @code{+}
25066 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
25067 -> @code{+}
25068 @end smallexample
25069
25070 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
25071 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
25072 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
25073
25074 @menu
25075 * File-I/O Overview::
25076 * Protocol Basics::
25077 * The F Request Packet::
25078 * The F Reply Packet::
25079 * The Ctrl-C Message::
25080 * Console I/O::
25081 * List of Supported Calls::
25082 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
25083 * Constants::
25084 * File-I/O Examples::
25085 @end menu
25086
25087 @node File-I/O Overview
25088 @subsection File-I/O Overview
25089 @cindex file-i/o overview
25090
25091 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
25092 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
25093 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
25094 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
25095 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
25096 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
25097
25098 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
25099 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
25100 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
25101 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
25102 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
25103
25104 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
25105 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
25106 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
25107 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
25108 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
25109 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
25110 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
25111
25112 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
25113 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
25114 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
25115 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
25116 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
25117
25118 @smallexample
25119 (@value{GDBP}) continue
25120 <- target requests 'system call X'
25121 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
25122 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
25123 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
25124 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
25125 @end smallexample
25126
25127 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
25128 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
25129 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
25130 system are not supported by this protocol.
25131
25132 @node Protocol Basics
25133 @subsection Protocol Basics
25134 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
25135
25136 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
25137 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
25138 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
25139 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
25140 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
25141 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
25142 to call the appropriate host system call:
25143
25144 @itemize @bullet
25145 @item
25146 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
25147
25148 @item
25149 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
25150 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
25151 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
25152 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
25153
25154 @end itemize
25155
25156 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
25157
25158 @itemize @bullet
25159 @item
25160 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
25161 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
25162 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
25163 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
25164 packet.
25165
25166 @item
25167 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
25168 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
25169
25170 @item
25171 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
25172
25173 @item
25174 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
25175
25176 @item
25177 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
25178 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
25179 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
25180 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
25181 packet.
25182
25183 @end itemize
25184
25185 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
25186 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
25187
25188 @itemize @bullet
25189 @item
25190 Return value.
25191
25192 @item
25193 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
25194
25195 @item
25196 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
25197
25198 @end itemize
25199
25200 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
25201 the latest continue or step action.
25202
25203 @node The F Request Packet
25204 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
25205 @cindex file-i/o request packet
25206 @cindex @code{F} request packet
25207
25208 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
25209
25210 @table @samp
25211 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
25212
25213 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
25214 This is just the name of the function.
25215
25216 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
25217 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
25218 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
25219 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
25220 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
25221 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
25222 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
25223
25224 @end table
25225
25226
25227
25228 @node The F Reply Packet
25229 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
25230 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
25231 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
25232
25233 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
25234
25235 @table @samp
25236
25237 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
25238
25239 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
25240
25241 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
25242 representation.
25243 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
25244
25245 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
25246 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
25247 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
25248
25249 @smallexample
25250 F0,0,C
25251 @end smallexample
25252
25253 @noindent
25254 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
25255
25256 @smallexample
25257 F-1,4,C
25258 @end smallexample
25259
25260 @noindent
25261 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
25262
25263 @end table
25264
25265
25266 @node The Ctrl-C Message
25267 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
25268 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
25269
25270 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
25271 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
25272 the target should behave as if it had
25273 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
25274 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
25275 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
25276 packet.
25277
25278 It's important for the target to know in which
25279 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
25280
25281 @itemize @bullet
25282 @item
25283 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
25284
25285 @item
25286 The system call on the host has been finished.
25287
25288 @end itemize
25289
25290 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
25291 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
25292 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
25293 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
25294 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
25295 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
25296
25297 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
25298 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
25299 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
25300 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
25301 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
25302 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
25303 or the full action has been completed.
25304
25305 @node Console I/O
25306 @subsection Console I/O
25307 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
25308
25309 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
25310 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
25311 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
25312 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
25313 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
25314 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
25315 conditions is met:
25316
25317 @itemize @bullet
25318 @item
25319 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
25320 @code{read}
25321 system call is treated as finished.
25322
25323 @item
25324 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
25325 newline.
25326
25327 @item
25328 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
25329 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
25330
25331 @end itemize
25332
25333 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
25334 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
25335 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
25336 is stopped at the user's request.
25337
25338
25339 @node List of Supported Calls
25340 @subsection List of Supported Calls
25341 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
25342
25343 @menu
25344 * open::
25345 * close::
25346 * read::
25347 * write::
25348 * lseek::
25349 * rename::
25350 * unlink::
25351 * stat/fstat::
25352 * gettimeofday::
25353 * isatty::
25354 * system::
25355 @end menu
25356
25357 @node open
25358 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
25359 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
25360
25361 @table @asis
25362 @item Synopsis:
25363 @smallexample
25364 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
25365 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
25366 @end smallexample
25367
25368 @item Request:
25369 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
25370
25371 @noindent
25372 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
25373
25374 @table @code
25375 @item O_CREAT
25376 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
25377 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
25378 are concerned.
25379
25380 @item O_EXCL
25381 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
25382 an error and open() fails.
25383
25384 @item O_TRUNC
25385 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
25386 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
25387 truncated to zero length.
25388
25389 @item O_APPEND
25390 The file is opened in append mode.
25391
25392 @item O_RDONLY
25393 The file is opened for reading only.
25394
25395 @item O_WRONLY
25396 The file is opened for writing only.
25397
25398 @item O_RDWR
25399 The file is opened for reading and writing.
25400 @end table
25401
25402 @noindent
25403 Other bits are silently ignored.
25404
25405
25406 @noindent
25407 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
25408
25409 @table @code
25410 @item S_IRUSR
25411 User has read permission.
25412
25413 @item S_IWUSR
25414 User has write permission.
25415
25416 @item S_IRGRP
25417 Group has read permission.
25418
25419 @item S_IWGRP
25420 Group has write permission.
25421
25422 @item S_IROTH
25423 Others have read permission.
25424
25425 @item S_IWOTH
25426 Others have write permission.
25427 @end table
25428
25429 @noindent
25430 Other bits are silently ignored.
25431
25432
25433 @item Return value:
25434 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
25435 occurred.
25436
25437 @item Errors:
25438
25439 @table @code
25440 @item EEXIST
25441 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
25442
25443 @item EISDIR
25444 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
25445
25446 @item EACCES
25447 The requested access is not allowed.
25448
25449 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25450 @var{pathname} was too long.
25451
25452 @item ENOENT
25453 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
25454
25455 @item ENODEV
25456 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
25457
25458 @item EROFS
25459 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
25460 write access was requested.
25461
25462 @item EFAULT
25463 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
25464
25465 @item ENOSPC
25466 No space on device to create the file.
25467
25468 @item EMFILE
25469 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
25470
25471 @item ENFILE
25472 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
25473 has been reached.
25474
25475 @item EINTR
25476 The call was interrupted by the user.
25477 @end table
25478
25479 @end table
25480
25481 @node close
25482 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
25483 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
25484
25485 @table @asis
25486 @item Synopsis:
25487 @smallexample
25488 int close(int fd);
25489 @end smallexample
25490
25491 @item Request:
25492 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
25493
25494 @item Return value:
25495 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
25496
25497 @item Errors:
25498
25499 @table @code
25500 @item EBADF
25501 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
25502
25503 @item EINTR
25504 The call was interrupted by the user.
25505 @end table
25506
25507 @end table
25508
25509 @node read
25510 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
25511 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
25512
25513 @table @asis
25514 @item Synopsis:
25515 @smallexample
25516 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
25517 @end smallexample
25518
25519 @item Request:
25520 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
25521
25522 @item Return value:
25523 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
25524 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
25525 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
25526
25527 @item Errors:
25528
25529 @table @code
25530 @item EBADF
25531 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
25532 reading.
25533
25534 @item EFAULT
25535 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25536
25537 @item EINTR
25538 The call was interrupted by the user.
25539 @end table
25540
25541 @end table
25542
25543 @node write
25544 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
25545 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
25546
25547 @table @asis
25548 @item Synopsis:
25549 @smallexample
25550 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
25551 @end smallexample
25552
25553 @item Request:
25554 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
25555
25556 @item Return value:
25557 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
25558 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
25559 is returned.
25560
25561 @item Errors:
25562
25563 @table @code
25564 @item EBADF
25565 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
25566 writing.
25567
25568 @item EFAULT
25569 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25570
25571 @item EFBIG
25572 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
25573 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
25574
25575 @item ENOSPC
25576 No space on device to write the data.
25577
25578 @item EINTR
25579 The call was interrupted by the user.
25580 @end table
25581
25582 @end table
25583
25584 @node lseek
25585 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
25586 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
25587
25588 @table @asis
25589 @item Synopsis:
25590 @smallexample
25591 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
25592 @end smallexample
25593
25594 @item Request:
25595 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
25596
25597 @var{flag} is one of:
25598
25599 @table @code
25600 @item SEEK_SET
25601 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
25602
25603 @item SEEK_CUR
25604 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
25605 bytes.
25606
25607 @item SEEK_END
25608 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
25609 bytes.
25610 @end table
25611
25612 @item Return value:
25613 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
25614 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
25615 value of -1 is returned.
25616
25617 @item Errors:
25618
25619 @table @code
25620 @item EBADF
25621 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
25622
25623 @item ESPIPE
25624 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
25625
25626 @item EINVAL
25627 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
25628
25629 @item EINTR
25630 The call was interrupted by the user.
25631 @end table
25632
25633 @end table
25634
25635 @node rename
25636 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
25637 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
25638
25639 @table @asis
25640 @item Synopsis:
25641 @smallexample
25642 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
25643 @end smallexample
25644
25645 @item Request:
25646 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
25647
25648 @item Return value:
25649 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25650
25651 @item Errors:
25652
25653 @table @code
25654 @item EISDIR
25655 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
25656 directory.
25657
25658 @item EEXIST
25659 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
25660
25661 @item EBUSY
25662 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
25663 process.
25664
25665 @item EINVAL
25666 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
25667 of itself.
25668
25669 @item ENOTDIR
25670 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
25671 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
25672 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
25673
25674 @item EFAULT
25675 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
25676
25677 @item EACCES
25678 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25679
25680 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25681
25682 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
25683
25684 @item ENOENT
25685 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
25686
25687 @item EROFS
25688 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
25689
25690 @item ENOSPC
25691 The device containing the file has no room for the new
25692 directory entry.
25693
25694 @item EINTR
25695 The call was interrupted by the user.
25696 @end table
25697
25698 @end table
25699
25700 @node unlink
25701 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
25702 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
25703
25704 @table @asis
25705 @item Synopsis:
25706 @smallexample
25707 int unlink(const char *pathname);
25708 @end smallexample
25709
25710 @item Request:
25711 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
25712
25713 @item Return value:
25714 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25715
25716 @item Errors:
25717
25718 @table @code
25719 @item EACCES
25720 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25721
25722 @item EPERM
25723 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
25724
25725 @item EBUSY
25726 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
25727 being used by another process.
25728
25729 @item EFAULT
25730 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25731
25732 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25733 @var{pathname} was too long.
25734
25735 @item ENOENT
25736 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
25737
25738 @item ENOTDIR
25739 A component of the path is not a directory.
25740
25741 @item EROFS
25742 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
25743
25744 @item EINTR
25745 The call was interrupted by the user.
25746 @end table
25747
25748 @end table
25749
25750 @node stat/fstat
25751 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
25752 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
25753 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
25754
25755 @table @asis
25756 @item Synopsis:
25757 @smallexample
25758 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
25759 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
25760 @end smallexample
25761
25762 @item Request:
25763 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
25764 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
25765
25766 @item Return value:
25767 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25768
25769 @item Errors:
25770
25771 @table @code
25772 @item EBADF
25773 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
25774
25775 @item ENOENT
25776 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
25777 path is an empty string.
25778
25779 @item ENOTDIR
25780 A component of the path is not a directory.
25781
25782 @item EFAULT
25783 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25784
25785 @item EACCES
25786 No access to the file or the path of the file.
25787
25788 @item ENAMETOOLONG
25789 @var{pathname} was too long.
25790
25791 @item EINTR
25792 The call was interrupted by the user.
25793 @end table
25794
25795 @end table
25796
25797 @node gettimeofday
25798 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
25799 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
25800
25801 @table @asis
25802 @item Synopsis:
25803 @smallexample
25804 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
25805 @end smallexample
25806
25807 @item Request:
25808 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
25809
25810 @item Return value:
25811 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
25812
25813 @item Errors:
25814
25815 @table @code
25816 @item EINVAL
25817 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
25818
25819 @item EFAULT
25820 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25821 @end table
25822
25823 @end table
25824
25825 @node isatty
25826 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
25827 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
25828
25829 @table @asis
25830 @item Synopsis:
25831 @smallexample
25832 int isatty(int fd);
25833 @end smallexample
25834
25835 @item Request:
25836 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
25837
25838 @item Return value:
25839 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
25840
25841 @item Errors:
25842
25843 @table @code
25844 @item EINTR
25845 The call was interrupted by the user.
25846 @end table
25847
25848 @end table
25849
25850 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
25851 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
25852 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
25853 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
25854 needed.
25855
25856
25857 @node system
25858 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
25859 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
25860
25861 @table @asis
25862 @item Synopsis:
25863 @smallexample
25864 int system(const char *command);
25865 @end smallexample
25866
25867 @item Request:
25868 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
25869
25870 @item Return value:
25871 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
25872 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
25873 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
25874 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
25875 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
25876 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
25877 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
25878
25879 @item Errors:
25880
25881 @table @code
25882 @item EINTR
25883 The call was interrupted by the user.
25884 @end table
25885
25886 @end table
25887
25888 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
25889 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
25890 the host is simplified before it's returned
25891 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
25892 is discarded, and the return value consists
25893 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
25894
25895 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
25896 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
25897 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
25898
25899 @table @code
25900 @item set remote system-call-allowed
25901 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
25902 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
25903 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
25904
25905 @item show remote system-call-allowed
25906 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
25907 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
25908 protocol.
25909 @end table
25910
25911 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
25912 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
25913 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25914
25915 @menu
25916 * Integral Datatypes::
25917 * Pointer Values::
25918 * Memory Transfer::
25919 * struct stat::
25920 * struct timeval::
25921 @end menu
25922
25923 @node Integral Datatypes
25924 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
25925 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25926
25927 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
25928 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
25929 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
25930
25931 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
25932 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
25933
25934 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
25935
25936 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
25937 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
25938
25939 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
25940
25941 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
25942 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
25943 byte order.
25944
25945 @node Pointer Values
25946 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
25947 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
25948
25949 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
25950 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
25951 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
25952 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
25953
25954 @smallexample
25955 @code{1aaf/12}
25956 @end smallexample
25957
25958 @noindent
25959 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
25960 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
25961 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
25962 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
25963
25964 @smallexample
25965 @code{123456/d}
25966 @end smallexample
25967
25968 @node Memory Transfer
25969 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
25970 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
25971
25972 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
25973 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
25974 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
25975 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
25976 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
25977 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
25978 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
25979
25980
25981 @node struct stat
25982 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
25983 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
25984
25985 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
25986 is defined as follows:
25987
25988 @smallexample
25989 struct stat @{
25990 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
25991 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
25992 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
25993 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
25994 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
25995 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
25996 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
25997 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
25998 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
25999 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
26000 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
26001 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
26002 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
26003 @};
26004 @end smallexample
26005
26006 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
26007 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
26008 structure is of size 64 bytes.
26009
26010 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
26011 range of values.
26012
26013 @table @code
26014
26015 @item st_dev
26016 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
26017
26018 @item st_ino
26019 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
26020
26021 @item st_mode
26022 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
26023 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
26024
26025 @item st_uid
26026 @itemx st_gid
26027 @itemx st_rdev
26028 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
26029
26030 @item st_atime
26031 @itemx st_mtime
26032 @itemx st_ctime
26033 These values have a host and file system dependent
26034 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
26035 support exact timing values.
26036 @end table
26037
26038 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
26039 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
26040 continuing.
26041
26042 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
26043 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
26044 get truncated on the target.
26045
26046 @node struct timeval
26047 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
26048 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
26049
26050 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
26051 is defined as follows:
26052
26053 @smallexample
26054 struct timeval @{
26055 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
26056 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
26057 @};
26058 @end smallexample
26059
26060 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
26061 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
26062 structure is of size 8 bytes.
26063
26064 @node Constants
26065 @subsection Constants
26066 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
26067
26068 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
26069 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
26070 values before and after the call as needed.
26071
26072 @menu
26073 * Open Flags::
26074 * mode_t Values::
26075 * Errno Values::
26076 * Lseek Flags::
26077 * Limits::
26078 @end menu
26079
26080 @node Open Flags
26081 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
26082 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
26083
26084 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
26085
26086 @smallexample
26087 O_RDONLY 0x0
26088 O_WRONLY 0x1
26089 O_RDWR 0x2
26090 O_APPEND 0x8
26091 O_CREAT 0x200
26092 O_TRUNC 0x400
26093 O_EXCL 0x800
26094 @end smallexample
26095
26096 @node mode_t Values
26097 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
26098 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
26099
26100 All values are given in octal representation.
26101
26102 @smallexample
26103 S_IFREG 0100000
26104 S_IFDIR 040000
26105 S_IRUSR 0400
26106 S_IWUSR 0200
26107 S_IXUSR 0100
26108 S_IRGRP 040
26109 S_IWGRP 020
26110 S_IXGRP 010
26111 S_IROTH 04
26112 S_IWOTH 02
26113 S_IXOTH 01
26114 @end smallexample
26115
26116 @node Errno Values
26117 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
26118 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
26119
26120 All values are given in decimal representation.
26121
26122 @smallexample
26123 EPERM 1
26124 ENOENT 2
26125 EINTR 4
26126 EBADF 9
26127 EACCES 13
26128 EFAULT 14
26129 EBUSY 16
26130 EEXIST 17
26131 ENODEV 19
26132 ENOTDIR 20
26133 EISDIR 21
26134 EINVAL 22
26135 ENFILE 23
26136 EMFILE 24
26137 EFBIG 27
26138 ENOSPC 28
26139 ESPIPE 29
26140 EROFS 30
26141 ENAMETOOLONG 91
26142 EUNKNOWN 9999
26143 @end smallexample
26144
26145 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
26146 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
26147
26148 @node Lseek Flags
26149 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
26150 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
26151
26152 @smallexample
26153 SEEK_SET 0
26154 SEEK_CUR 1
26155 SEEK_END 2
26156 @end smallexample
26157
26158 @node Limits
26159 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
26160 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
26161
26162 All values are given in decimal representation.
26163
26164 @smallexample
26165 INT_MIN -2147483648
26166 INT_MAX 2147483647
26167 UINT_MAX 4294967295
26168 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
26169 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
26170 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
26171 @end smallexample
26172
26173 @node File-I/O Examples
26174 @subsection File-I/O Examples
26175 @cindex file-i/o examples
26176
26177 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
26178 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
26179
26180 @smallexample
26181 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
26182 @emph{request memory read from target}
26183 -> @code{m1234,6}
26184 <- XXXXXX
26185 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
26186 -> @code{F6}
26187 @end smallexample
26188
26189 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
26190 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
26191
26192 @smallexample
26193 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26194 @emph{request memory write to target}
26195 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
26196 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
26197 -> @code{F6}
26198 @end smallexample
26199
26200 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
26201 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
26202
26203 @smallexample
26204 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26205 -> @code{F-1,9}
26206 @end smallexample
26207
26208 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
26209 host is called:
26210
26211 @smallexample
26212 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26213 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
26214 <- @code{T02}
26215 @end smallexample
26216
26217 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
26218 host is called:
26219
26220 @smallexample
26221 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26222 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
26223 <- @code{T02}
26224 @end smallexample
26225
26226 @node Library List Format
26227 @section Library List Format
26228 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
26229
26230 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
26231 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
26232 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
26233 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
26234 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
26235 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
26236 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
26237 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
26238 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
26239 are loaded.
26240
26241 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
26242 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
26243 associated name and one or more segment base addresses, which report
26244 where the library was loaded in memory. The segment bases are start
26245 addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not depend on the library's
26246 link-time base addresses.
26247
26248 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26249 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
26250
26251 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
26252 offset, looks like this:
26253
26254 @smallexample
26255 <library-list>
26256 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
26257 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
26258 </library>
26259 </library-list>
26260 @end smallexample
26261
26262 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
26263
26264 @smallexample
26265 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
26266 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
26267 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
26268 <!ELEMENT library (segment)*>
26269 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
26270 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
26271 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
26272 @end smallexample
26273
26274 @node Memory Map Format
26275 @section Memory Map Format
26276 @cindex memory map format
26277
26278 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
26279 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
26280 memory map.
26281
26282 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
26283 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
26284 lists memory regions.
26285
26286 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26287 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
26288
26289 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
26290
26291 @smallexample
26292 <?xml version="1.0"?>
26293 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
26294 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
26295 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
26296 <memory-map>
26297 region...
26298 </memory-map>
26299 @end smallexample
26300
26301 Each region can be either:
26302
26303 @itemize
26304
26305 @item
26306 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
26307 bytes from there:
26308
26309 @smallexample
26310 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
26311 @end smallexample
26312
26313
26314 @item
26315 A region of read-only memory:
26316
26317 @smallexample
26318 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
26319 @end smallexample
26320
26321
26322 @item
26323 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
26324 bytes in length:
26325
26326 @smallexample
26327 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
26328 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
26329 </memory>
26330 @end smallexample
26331
26332 @end itemize
26333
26334 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
26335 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
26336 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
26337
26338 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
26339
26340 @smallexample
26341 <!-- ................................................... -->
26342 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
26343 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
26344 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
26345 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
26346 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
26347 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
26348 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
26349 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
26350 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
26351 and its type, or device. -->
26352 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
26353 start CDATA #REQUIRED
26354 length CDATA #REQUIRED
26355 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
26356 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
26357 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
26358 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
26359 @end smallexample
26360
26361 @include agentexpr.texi
26362
26363 @node Target Descriptions
26364 @appendix Target Descriptions
26365 @cindex target descriptions
26366
26367 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
26368 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
26369 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
26370
26371 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
26372 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
26373 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
26374 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
26375 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
26376 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
26377 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
26378
26379 @itemize @bullet
26380 @item
26381 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
26382 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
26383 @item
26384 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
26385 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
26386 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
26387 @item
26388 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
26389 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
26390 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
26391 @end itemize
26392
26393 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
26394 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
26395 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
26396 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
26397 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
26398
26399 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26400 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
26401
26402 @menu
26403 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
26404 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
26405 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
26406 descriptions.
26407 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
26408 @end menu
26409
26410 @node Retrieving Descriptions
26411 @section Retrieving Descriptions
26412
26413 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
26414 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
26415 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
26416 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
26417 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
26418 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
26419 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
26420 Format}.
26421
26422 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
26423 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
26424 specify a file are:
26425
26426 @table @code
26427 @cindex set tdesc filename
26428 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
26429 Read the target description from @var{path}.
26430
26431 @cindex unset tdesc filename
26432 @item unset tdesc filename
26433 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
26434 will use the description supplied by the current target.
26435
26436 @cindex show tdesc filename
26437 @item show tdesc filename
26438 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
26439 @end table
26440
26441
26442 @node Target Description Format
26443 @section Target Description Format
26444 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
26445
26446 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
26447 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
26448 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
26449 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
26450 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
26451 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
26452 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
26453
26454 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
26455 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
26456 sets. @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
26457 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
26458
26459 Here is a simple target description:
26460
26461 @smallexample
26462 <target version="1.0">
26463 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
26464 </target>
26465 @end smallexample
26466
26467 @noindent
26468 This minimal description only says that the target uses
26469 the x86-64 architecture.
26470
26471 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
26472 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
26473 are explained further below.
26474
26475 @smallexample
26476 <?xml version="1.0"?>
26477 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
26478 <target version="1.0">
26479 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
26480 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
26481 </target>
26482 @end smallexample
26483
26484 @noindent
26485 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
26486 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
26487 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
26488 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
26489 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
26490 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
26491 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
26492 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
26493 the version mismatch.
26494
26495 @subsection Inclusion
26496 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
26497 @cindex XInclude
26498 @ifnotinfo
26499 @cindex <xi:include>
26500 @end ifnotinfo
26501
26502 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
26503 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
26504 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
26505 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
26506 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
26507
26508 @smallexample
26509 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
26510 @end smallexample
26511
26512 @noindent
26513 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
26514 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
26515 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
26516 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
26517 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
26518 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
26519 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
26520 original description.
26521
26522 @subsection Architecture
26523 @cindex <architecture>
26524
26525 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
26526
26527 @smallexample
26528 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
26529 @end smallexample
26530
26531 @var{arch} is an architecture name from the same selection
26532 accepted by @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a
26533 Debugging Target}).
26534
26535 @subsection Features
26536 @cindex <feature>
26537
26538 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
26539 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
26540 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
26541 has this form:
26542
26543 @smallexample
26544 <feature name="@var{name}">
26545 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
26546 @var{reg}@dots{}
26547 </feature>
26548 @end smallexample
26549
26550 @noindent
26551 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
26552 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
26553 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
26554 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
26555
26556 @subsection Types
26557
26558 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
26559 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
26560 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
26561 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
26562 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
26563
26564 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
26565 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
26566 Types must be defined before they are used.
26567
26568 @cindex <vector>
26569 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
26570 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
26571 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
26572 @var{count}:
26573
26574 @smallexample
26575 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
26576 @end smallexample
26577
26578 @cindex <union>
26579 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
26580 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
26581 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
26582 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
26583
26584 @smallexample
26585 <union id="@var{id}">
26586 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
26587 @dots{}
26588 </union>
26589 @end smallexample
26590
26591 @subsection Registers
26592 @cindex <reg>
26593
26594 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
26595
26596 @smallexample
26597 <reg name="@var{name}"
26598 bitsize="@var{size}"
26599 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
26600 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
26601 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
26602 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
26603 @end smallexample
26604
26605 @noindent
26606 The components are as follows:
26607
26608 @table @var
26609
26610 @item name
26611 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
26612
26613 @item bitsize
26614 The register's size, in bits.
26615
26616 @item regnum
26617 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
26618 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
26619 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
26620 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
26621 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
26622 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
26623 in order of increasing register number.
26624
26625 @item save-restore
26626 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
26627 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
26628 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
26629 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
26630 ABI.
26631
26632 @item type
26633 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
26634 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
26635 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
26636 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
26637 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
26638 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
26639
26640 @item group
26641 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
26642 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
26643 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
26644 in @code{info registers}.
26645
26646 @end table
26647
26648 @node Predefined Target Types
26649 @section Predefined Target Types
26650 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
26651
26652 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
26653 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
26654 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
26655 types. The currently supported types are:
26656
26657 @table @code
26658
26659 @item int8
26660 @itemx int16
26661 @itemx int32
26662 @itemx int64
26663 @itemx int128
26664 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
26665
26666 @item uint8
26667 @itemx uint16
26668 @itemx uint32
26669 @itemx uint64
26670 @itemx uint128
26671 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
26672
26673 @item code_ptr
26674 @itemx data_ptr
26675 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
26676 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
26677 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
26678 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
26679 may be marked as data pointers.
26680
26681 @item ieee_single
26682 Single precision IEEE floating point.
26683
26684 @item ieee_double
26685 Double precision IEEE floating point.
26686
26687 @item arm_fpa_ext
26688 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
26689
26690 @end table
26691
26692 @node Standard Target Features
26693 @section Standard Target Features
26694 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
26695
26696 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
26697 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
26698 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
26699 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
26700 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
26701 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
26702 can recognize them.
26703
26704 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
26705 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
26706 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
26707 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
26708 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
26709 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
26710 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
26711 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
26712
26713 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
26714 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
26715 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
26716
26717 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
26718 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
26719 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
26720 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
26721
26722 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
26723 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
26724 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
26725
26726 @menu
26727 * ARM Features::
26728 * M68K Features::
26729 @end menu
26730
26731
26732 @node ARM Features
26733 @subsection ARM Features
26734 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
26735
26736 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
26737 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
26738 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
26739
26740 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
26741 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
26742
26743 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
26744 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
26745 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
26746 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
26747
26748 @subsection MIPS Features
26749 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
26750
26751 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
26752 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
26753 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
26754 on the target.
26755
26756 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
26757 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
26758 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
26759
26760 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
26761 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
26762 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
26763 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
26764
26765 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
26766 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
26767 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
26768
26769 @node M68K Features
26770 @subsection M68K Features
26771 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
26772
26773 @table @code
26774 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
26775 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
26776 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
26777 One of those features must be always present.
26778 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m86k is
26779 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
26780 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
26781 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
26782
26783 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
26784 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
26785 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
26786 @samp{fpiaddr}.
26787 @end table
26788
26789 @subsection PowerPC Features
26790 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
26791
26792 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
26793 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
26794 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
26795 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
26796
26797 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
26798 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
26799
26800 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
26801 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
26802 and @samp{vrsave}.
26803
26804 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
26805 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
26806 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
26807 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
26808 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
26809 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
26810 user.
26811
26812 @include gpl.texi
26813
26814 @raisesections
26815 @include fdl.texi
26816 @lowersections
26817
26818 @node Index
26819 @unnumbered Index
26820
26821 @printindex cp
26822
26823 @tex
26824 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
26825 % meantime:
26826 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
26827 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
26828 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
26829 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
26830 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
26831 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
26832 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
26833 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
26834 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
26835 \page\colophon
26836 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
26837 @end tex
26838
26839 @bye
This page took 0.570091 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.